Prepared and filed by St Ives Burrups

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 27, 2003

  UNITED STATES  
  SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION  
  WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549  
  FORM 20-F  
                      (Mark One)
   
                      
REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b)  
OR 12(g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934  
OR  
                       
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF  
THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934  
For the fiscal year ended 31 DECEMBER 2002  
OR  
                       
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF  
THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934  
For the transition period from ______________ to ______________  

Commission file number 1-4547

UNILEVER N.V.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

THE NETHERLANDS
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

WEENA 455, 3013 AL, ROTTERDAM, THE NETHERLANDS
(Address of principal executive offices)

  Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:    
 

 
  Title of each class Name of each exchange on which
registered
 
 

 
  Ordinary shares of the nominal amount of 0.51 euro (€0.51) each*
New York Stock Exchange
 
 

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
None
(Title of class)

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:
None
(Title of class)

 
 
  The total number of outstanding shares of the Registrant’s capital at the close of the period covered by the Annual Report was 571 575 900 ordinary shares  
 
 
  Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 of 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  

Yes  
         No 

  Indicate by check mark which financial statement item the Registrant has elected to follow.  

Item 17  
Item 18  
 
 
  * For Unilever N.V. share capital, the euro amounts shown above and in the Unilever Annual Report & Accounts 2002 and Form 20-F and other official documents are representations in euros on the basis of Article 67c of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, rounded to two decimal places, of underlying share capital in Dutch guilders, which have not been converted into euros in Unilever N.V.’s Articles of Association. Until conversion formally takes place by amendment of the Articles of Association the entitlements to dividends and voting rights are based on the underlying Dutch guilder amounts.  



Back to Contents

 

A truly multi-local multinational

Unilever is dedicated to meeting the everyday needs of people everywhere. Around the world our Foods and Home & Personal Care brands are chosen by many millions of individual consumers each day. Earning their trust, anticipating their aspirations and meeting their daily needs are the tasks of our local companies. They bring to the service of their consumers the best in brands and both our international and local expertise.






Unilever’s Corporate Purpose

Our purpose in Unilever is to meet the everyday needs of people everywhere – to anticipate the aspirations of our consumers and customers and to respond creatively and competitively with branded products and services which raise the quality of life.

Our deep roots in local cultures and markets around the world are our unparalleled inheritance and the foundation for our future growth. We will bring our wealth of knowledge and international expertise to the service of local consumers – a truly multi-local multinational.

Our long-term success requires a total commitment to exceptional standards of performance and productivity, to working together effectively and to a willingness to embrace new ideas and learn continuously.

We believe that to succeed requires the highest standards of corporate behaviour towards our employees, consumers and the societies and world in which we live.

This is Unilever’s road to sustainable, profitable growth for our business and long-term value creation for our shareholders and employees.

 


1

Contents

   Report of the Directors  
   
General information 2
Financial highlights 3
Chairmen’s statement 5
Our code of business principles 7
About Unilever 9
      Description of business 9
      Business structure 9
      Foods 9
            Savoury and dressings 9
            Spreads and cooking products 9
            Health & wellness 9
            Beverages 9
            Ice cream and frozen foods 9
      Home & Personal Care 10
            Home care and professional cleaning 10
            Personal care 10
      Other operations 10
      Corporate venture activities 10
      Technology and innovation 10
      Information technology 11
      Environmental responsibility 11
      Responsible corporate behaviour 12
      Competition 12
      Exports 12
      Seasonality 13
      People 13
      Related party transactions 13
      Intellectual property 13
      Description of our properties 14
      Legal and arbitration proceedings and regulatory
         matters 14
      Government regulation 14
Operating review – highlights 15
Operating review by region 18
      Europe 18
      North America 19
      Africa, Middle East and Turkey 20
      Asia and Pacific 21
      Latin America 22
Operating review by category – Foods 24
      Savoury and dressings 24
      Spreads and cooking products 26
      Health & wellness and beverages 27
      Ice cream and frozen foods 28
Operating review by category – Home & Personal Care 31
      Home care and professional cleaning 31
      Personal care 33
Financial review 35
      Critical accounting policies 35
      Results – 2002 compared with 2001 35
      Results – 2001 compared with 2000 36
      Dividends and market capitalisation 37
      Balance sheet 37
      Cash flow 37
      Finance and liquidity 37
      Treasury and hedging policies 38
      Risk management 39
      Total Shareholder Return (TSR) 40
      Unilever’s position relative to the TSR reference group 41
      Significant changes 41
Corporate governance 42
      Organisational structure of Unilever 42
      Legal structure of the Group 42
      Directors 42
      Advisory Directors 43
   Report of the Directors (continued)  
   
Corporate governance (continued)
      Board Committees
43
44
      Auditors
45
45
45
               Directors
46
               Advisory Directors
46
               Business Presidents
47
               Corporate Officers
48
      Board changes
48
48
Remuneration report 49
49
49
49
50
            equity indices
52
52
54
55
55
56
56
57
            the TSR Long-Term Incentive Plan
59
      Advisory Directors
59
60
Report of the Audit Committee 61
   
   Financial Statements  
   
Contents listing for financial statements 62
   
   Shareholder information  
   
Control of Unilever 138
      Share capital 138
      Unity of management 138
      Equalisation Agreement 138
      More information about our constitutional
            documents 139
      General Meetings and voting rights 139
      Directors 140
      Mutual guarantee of borrowings 140
      Combined earnings per share 140
      Leverhulme Trust 141
      N.V. Nederlandsch Administratie- en
            Trustkantoor (Nedamtrust) 141
      Material modifications to the rights
            of security holders 141
Analysis of shareholding 142
Information about exchange controls
      affecting security holders 143
Nature of the trading market 143
Taxation for US residents 145
Dividends 147
Cross reference to Form 20-F 148
Glossary 149
Financial calendar and addresses 150
Website 151
Publications 151
Share registration 151

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

2 General information

 

The Unilever Group
Unilever N.V. (NV) is a public limited company registered in the Netherlands, which has listings of shares or certificates (depositary receipts) of NV on the stock exchanges in Amsterdam, London and New York and in France, Germany and Switzerland.

Unilever PLC (PLC) is a public limited company registered in England which has shares listed on the London Stock Exchange and, as American Depositary Receipts, on the New York Stock Exchange.

The two parent companies NV and PLC, together with their group companies, operate as nearly as is practicable as a single entity (the Unilever Group, also referred to as Unilever or the Group). NV and PLC and their group companies constitute a single group under Netherlands and United Kingdom legislation for the purposes of presenting consolidated accounts. Accordingly, the accounts of the Unilever Group are presented by both NV and PLC as their respective consolidated accounts.

Publications
This publication is produced in both Dutch and English and comprises the full Annual Report and Accounts for 2002 of NV and PLC. This document complies with the Netherlands and the United Kingdom regulations. It also forms the NV and PLC Annual Reports on Form 20-F to the Securities and Exchange Commission in the United States for the year ended 31 December 2002, and cross references to Form 20-F are set out on page 148. It is made available to all shareholders who request or elect to receive it, and on the website at www.unilever.com.

The separate publication, Unilever Annual Review 2002, containing a Summary Financial Statement with figures expressed in euros, with translations into pounds sterling and US dollars, is also published in Dutch and English. It is a short form document that is prepared in accordance with the United Kingdom regulations for Summary Financial Statements. The Unilever Annual Review 2002 is mailed to all registered shareholders and to other shareholders who are either entitled or have asked to receive it, and is also made available on the website at www.unilever.com.

Reporting currency and exchange rates
Details of key exchange rates used in preparation of these accounts are given on page 117, together with Noon Buying Rates in New York for the equivalent dates.

Abbreviations
Wherever used in this report, the abbreviation
BEIA refers to profit measures before exceptional items and amortisation of goodwill and intangibles. Unilever believes that reporting profit measures before exceptional items and amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (BEIA) provides additional information on underlying earnings trends to shareholders. Unilever uses BEIA measures primarily for internal performance analysis, performance targeting and incentive awards. The term BEIA is not a defined term under Netherlands, UK, or US Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP), and may not therefore be comparable with similarly titled profit measurements reported by other companies. It is not intended to be a substitute for or superior to GAAP measurements of profit.
   
 is used in this report to denote amounts in euros.
 
£ and p are used in this report to denote amounts in pounds and pence sterling respectively.
 
Fl. is used in this report to denote amounts in Dutch guilders.
 
$ is used in this report to denote amounts in United States dollars, except where specifically stated otherwise.
 
The brand names shown in italics in this report are trade marks owned by or licensed to companies within the Unilever Group.
 
Cautionary Statement
This Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002 contains forward-looking statements (within the meaning of the US Private Securities Litigation Reform Act 1995) based on our best current information and what we believe to be reasonable assumptions about anticipated developments. Words such as
expects, anticipates, intends and other similar expressions are intended to identify such forward-looking statements. Because of the risks and uncertainties that always exist in any operating environment or business, we cannot give any assurance that the expectations reflected in these statements will prove correct. Actual results and developments may differ materially depending upon, among other factors, currency values, competitive pricing, consumption levels, costs, environmental risks, physical risks, risks related to the integration of acquisitions, legislative, fiscal and regulatory developments and political and social conditions in the economies and environments where Unilever operates. You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements.
 
Risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to vary from those described in our forward-looking statements include those given under the sections entitled ‘About Unilever’ on pages 9 to 14, ‘Operating review’ on pages 15 to 34, ‘Financial review’ on pages 35 to 41, and ‘Risk management’ on pages 39 and 40, to which you should refer.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Financial highlights
3

Financial highlights


Global highlights


Progress against targets

(1) Turnover growth per annum excluding the year-on-year impact of
acquisitions and disposals in all years.


The figures shown in the Global highlights above are at current rates of exchange. The figures shown in the Progress against targets are at constant rates of exchange, i.e. translated at the average rates of exchange for the earlier year.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

4 Financial highlights
at current rates of exchange

Combined earnings per share and dividends

       
Ordinary 0.51 shares of NV(a)
       
Ordinary 1.4p shares of PLC
 
   
2000
2001
2002
 
2000
2001
2002















Basic earnings per share   €1.07   €1.82 €2.14     €0.16   €0.27   €0.32  
                  9.79 p 16.96 p 20.13 p















Basic earnings per share (BEIA)   €3.21   €3.55 €4.06     €0.48   €0.53   €0.61  
                  29.34 p 33.15 p 38.22 p















Diluted earnings per share   €1.05   €1.77 €2.07     €0.16   €0.27   €0.31  
                  9.55 p 16.51 p 19.53 p















Dividend per share   €1.43   €1.56 €1.70     13.07 p 14.54 p 16.04 p















Combined earnings per share and dividends for shares traded on the New York Stock Exchange (on a UK GAAP basis) in US dollars

       
New York0.51 shares of NV(a)
   
5.6p American Depositary Receipts of PLC
 
    2000   2001   2002     2000   2001   2002  















Basic earnings per share   $0.99   $1.63   $2.01     $0.59   $0.98   $1.21  















Basic earnings per share (BEIA)   $2.96   $3.18   $3.81     $1.77   $1.91   $2.29  















Diluted earnings per share   $0.96   $1.58   $1.95     $0.58   $0.95   $1.17  















Dividend per share(b)(c)   $1.25   $1.42   $1.77     $0.76   $0.85   $1.03  















 
(a) For NV share capital, the euro amounts shown above and elsewhere in this document are representations in euros on the basis of Article 67c of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, rounded to two decimal places, of underlying share capital in Dutch guilders, which have not been converted into euros in NVs Articles of Association. Until conversion formally takes place by amendment of the Articles of Association the entitlements to dividends and voting rights are based on the underlying Dutch guilder amounts.
(b) Rounded to two decimal places.
(c) Actual dividends payable for 2002 on NV New York shares and American Depositary Receipts of PLC may differ from those shown above, which include final dividend values calculated using the rates of exchange ruling on 12 February 2003 (1.00 = $1.0735, £1.00 = $1.6173).

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Chairmens statement
5

Report of the Directors

Continued growth
   
   Leading brands grow by 5.4%
   
   Operating margin BEIA of 14.9% is a new record
   
   Cash flow from operations increases to 7.9 billion
   
   Earnings per share (BEIA) grows 21%
   

Sustaining the momentum
We are delighted to report a further year of sustained growth towards the targets set in our Path to Growth strategy. Leading brands grew by 5.4% and, with the build up of our innovation programmes and marketplace activity, we have gained momentum through the year and have finished strongly.

Operating margin BEIA rose to 14.9%, a gain of 1% over 2001. Another record high. The impact of devaluing currencies this year means that whilst turnover is at the same level as 2001 at constant rates of exchange, it has declined by 7% at current rates. Similarly operating profit BEIA increased by 0.5 billion at constant rates but was flat at current rates of exchange. Figures in this statement are at constant exchange rates.

In 2002 the global economy grew slowly and it was a tougher environment in which to operate. Slower growth and the uncertain economic and political context caused turbulence in financial markets. Once again, our business showed its resilience in tough times. Our people used their skill, experience and total determination to deliver a robust business performance.

Earnings per share (BEIA) grew by 21% and for the second year running our Total Shareholder Return (TSR) over one year was in the top third of our peer group. Our challenge is to sustain this over a three-year period and beyond.

We continued to generate a healthy cash flow from operations. In addition, net proceeds from divestment of non-core activities included1.0 billion cash from DiverseyLever, our institutional and industrial cleaning business, with a minority interest retained in the merged business of JohnsonDiversey. Other divestments included Mazola in North America and Loders Croklaan, our industrial speciality oils and fats business. In total, our cashflow enabled us to reduce net indebtedness and, with the benefit of lower interest rates, interest costs were 22% lower than in 2001.

Meeting Path to Growth targets
We continued on track towards our Path to Growth targets of 5-6% sustained top-line growth and operating margin BEIA of 16% by 2004. Leading brands grew by over 5% for the second year running. Innovation was key to this success. Advertising was entirely focused on our leading brands which constituted 89% of total turnover at the end of the year.

A further healthy increase in operating margin has been achieved whilst progressively increasing investment behind our brands. Our restructuring programmes continue to deliver on plan and the target of1.6 billion procurement savings was passed ahead of schedule. Furthermore, by the end of the year we had reached the full Bestfoods integration savings target of0.8 billion, again ahead of plan.

Energising our people
We can only meet and sustain the objectives of our Path to Growth strategy if our people have a passion for winning and a culture that encourages and rewards enterprise. The development of Leaders into Action programmes and the days we spend with our young leaders of tomorrow are part of an overall programme to drive change. The results are evident in the enthusiasm to win we see throughout the business and the examples of innovation that are driving faster growth and improved results. To recognise their efforts we extended our long-term reward schemes and variable pay to more employees.

The energy with which our colleagues throughout the business have responded to the Enterprise agenda is exceptional. They have risen to the challenge with great determination as is clear from the results.

Brands and regions
In Home & Personal Care we have sustained the leading brand growth in excess of 6%. In particular our personal care brands continue to perform well and home care margins increased sharply.

The extension of Dove from skin care to hair care contributed to the spectacular performance of this brand, which grew by over 25% for the fourth year running and is now achieving sales of over 2 billion. Dove shampoo and conditioners were rolled out across 31 more countries. In deodorants Rexona, and particularly Rexona for Men, grew strongly.

In Foods, the focus in the first half of the year was on completing the Bestfoods integration, providing the firm platform on which to leverage innovation and marketplace activity in the second half. This has delivered accelerating leading brand growth and for the full year it was 4.4%.

Knorr is proving a powerhouse of ideas for savoury products and is being extended well beyond its original concept of bouillon cubes. Bertolli is being extended to support products which have an Italian heritage. Consumers


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

6 Chairmens statement

 

responded strongly to our health & wellness brands, including the soy-based health drink AdeS in Brazil and Mexico.

Overall we now have 14 global brands with a turnover of €1 billion or more. Ten years ago we had one.

In Europe, underlying sales grew 3% with a continuing significant contribution from Central and Eastern Europe. Foods sales in Western Europe grew at 3% including an increasing contribution from UBF Foodsolutions, our food service business. There has been sustained progress in branded spreads and cooking products, especially in Flora/Becel which grew by over 10%. In Home & Personal Care in Western Europe, there were strong performances through innovation and range extension in Dove, Rexona and Axe.

Underlying sales in North America grew 1% with a stronger performance in the second half as marketplace activity built through the year. In Foods, underlying sales grew 2% and our market shares remained firm. SlimFast continued to expand, passing the1 billion sales mark globally. Ice cream again grew at well over 5% and Wishbone, Becel and Knorr also moved ahead. In Home & Personal Care, after a slow start, the successful launches of Axe deodorant and all fabric conditioner and the relaunch of Dove body wash contributed to a strong finish to the year.

In Africa, Middle East and Turkey, underlying sales grew by 7%. Including the increase in our holding in the Bestfoods Robertsons business, turnover was ahead by 9%. Growth was broad based across categories.

Underlying sales in Asia and Pacific grew by 5%. Home & Personal Care grew across both categories and countries. Indonesia, Philippines and Vietnam performed particularly well and skin, hair and deodorants all grew at over 10% across the region. In Foods, there was good growth in South East Asia as the Bestfoods brands benefited from the Unilever distribution system.

In Latin America, underlying sales grew by 12% driven by pricing action to recover devaluation-led cost increases. In laundry, market shares have held firm against our nearest competitor and personal care continued to perform strongly. Sedal shampoo grew exceptionally well across the region. Dove shampoo has been launched in Brazil, Chile, Mexico and Peru and is making good progress. In Foods, ice cream grew by over 10%, mostly volume.

A responsible enterprise
Clear values and committed social responsibility are essential to how Unilever conducts itself. At a time when the way businesses behave is coming under greater scrutiny, Unilevers corporate reputation has become an even more important asset.

In 2001, we revised our Code of Business Principles and, during 2002, we rolled it out across the business, engaging

our people in a dialogue to ensure that everyone in Unilever understands what is expected of them. We also published our second Social Review, which gives an insight into our day-to-day practices and our relationships with the societies in which we live. We continue to look at all aspects of our corporate governance to ensure that we stay at the forefront of best practice.

Unilever is deeply rooted in the communities in which it operates and in 2002 we supported many community projects around the world, mainly by sharing our skills and expertise.

During 2002, we continued to reduce our impact on the environment. We bought more than a third of our fish from sustainable sources and completed protocols for the sustainable management of five key crops. Our efforts to improve the quality of water in rivers and lakes and the sustainability of agriculture and fishing were recognised externally. For the fourth year running we have led our sector in the Dow Jones Sustainability Indexes.

Looking forward
We are confident that the strength of our brands, the dedication of our people and the geographical spread of our business will enable Unilever to continue to progress and prosper in 2003. We have sound and clearly understood strategies, brands that serve peoples basic needs and aspirations and generate dependable cash flow. These are the essential elements, together with a proud corporate reputation, which will enable us to maintain the momentum of our Path to Growth, even in the difficult times that may lie ahead. We thank all our employees for their commitment and exceptional teamwork throughout the year.

Antony Burgmans Niall FitzGerald

Chairmen of Unilever




Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Our code of business principles
7

 

Report of the Directors


Chairmen
s introduction
Unilever has earned a reputation for conducting its business with integrity and with respect for the interests of those our activities can affect. This reputation is an asset, just as real as our people and brands.

Our first priority is to be a successful business and that means investing for growth and balancing short-term and long-term interests. It also means caring about our consumers, employees and shareholders, our business partners and the world in which we live.

To succeed requires the highest standards of behaviour from all of us. The general principles contained in this Code set out those standards. More detailed guidance tailored to the needs of different countries and companies will build on these principles as appropriate, but will not include any standards less rigorous than those contained in this Code.

We want this Code to be more than a collection of high-sounding statements. It must have practical value in our day-to-day business and each one of us must follow these principles in the spirit as well as the letter.

Antony Burgmans
Niall FitzGerald










In this Code the expressions
‘Unilever andUnilever companies are used for convenience and mean the Unilever Group of companies comprising Unilever N.V., Unilever PLC and their respective subsidiary companies. The Board of Unilever means the Directors of Unilever N.V. and Unilever PLC.


Standard of conduct

We conduct our operations with honesty, integrity and openness, and with respect for the human rights and interests of our employees. We shall similarly respect the legitimate interests of those with whom we have relationships.

Obeying the law
Unilever companies and our employees are required to comply with the laws and regulations of the countries in which we operate.

Employees
Unilever is committed to diversity in a working environment where there is mutual trust and respect and where everyone feels responsible for the performance and reputation of our company.

We will recruit, employ and promote employees on the sole basis of the qualifications and abilities needed for the work to be performed. We are committed to safe and healthy working conditions for all employees. We will not use any form of forced, compulsory or child labour. We are committed to working with employees to develop and enhance each individuals skills and capabilities. We respect the dignity of the individual and the right of employees to freedom of association. We will maintain good communications with employees through company-based information and consultation procedures.

Consumers
Unilever is committed to providing branded products and services which consistently offer value in terms of price and quality, and which are safe for their intended use. Products and services will be accurately and properly labelled, advertised and communicated.

Shareholders
Unilever will conduct its operations in accordance with internationally accepted principles of good corporate governance. We will provide timely, regular and reliable information on our activities, structure, financial situation and performance to all shareholders.

Business partners
Unilever is committed to establishing mutually beneficial relations with our suppliers, customers and business partners. In our business dealings we expect our partners to adhere to business principles consistent with our own.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

8 Our code of business principles

 


Community involvement
Unilever strives to be a trusted corporate citizen and, as an integral part of society, to fulfil our responsibilities to the societies and communities in which we operate.

Public activities
Unilever companies are encouraged to promote and defend their legitimate business interests. Unilever will co-operate with governments and other organisations, both directly and through bodies such as trade associations, in the development of proposed legislation and other regulations which may affect legitimate business interests. Unilever neither supports political parties nor contributes to the funds of groups whose activities are calculated to promote party interests.

The environment
Unilever is committed to making continuous improvements in the management of our environmental impact and to the longer-term goal of developing a sustainable business. Unilever will work in partnership with others to promote environmental care, increase understanding of environmental issues and disseminate good practice.

Innovation
In our scientific innovation to meet consumer needs we will respect the concerns of our consumers and of society. We will work on the basis of sound science, applying rigorous standards of product safety.

Competition
Unilever believes in vigorous yet fair competition and supports the development of appropriate competition laws. Unilever companies and employees will conduct their operations in accordance with the principles of fair competition and all applicable regulations.

Business integrity
Unilever does not give or receive, whether directly or indirectly, bribes or other improper advantages for business or financial gain. No employee may offer, give or receive any gift or payment which is, or may be construed as being, a bribe. Any demand for, or offer of, a bribe must be rejected immediately and reported to management.

Unilever accounting records and supporting documents must accurately describe and reflect the nature of the underlying transactions. No undisclosed or unrecorded account, fund or asset will be established or maintained.

 

Conflicts of interests
All Unilever employees are expected to avoid personal activities and financial interests which could conflict with their responsibilities to the company. Unilever employees must not seek gain for themselves or others through misuse of their positions.

Compliance monitoring reporting
Compliance with these principles is an essential element in our business success. The Unilever Board is responsible for ensuring these principles are communicated to, and understood and observed by, all employees.

Day-to-day responsibility is delegated to the senior management of the regions and operating companies. They are responsible for implementing these principles, if necessary through more detailed guidance tailored to local needs.

Assurance of compliance is given and monitored each year. Compliance with the Code is subject to review by the Board supported by the Audit Committee of the Board and the Corporate Risk Committee.

Any breaches of the Code must be reported in accordance with the procedures specified by the Joint Secretaries. The Board of Unilever will not criticise management for any loss of business resulting from adherence to these principles and other mandatory policies and instructions.

The Board of Unilever expects employees to bring to their attention, or to that of senior management, any breach or suspected breach of these principles.

Provision has been made for employees to be able to report in confidence and no employee will suffer as a consequence of doing so.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

About Unilever
9

 

Report of the Directors

Description of business
Unilever is one of the worlds leading suppliers of fast moving consumer goods in foods, household care and personal product categories.

Business structure
Our operations are organised into two global divisions Foods and Home & Personal Care (HPC) headed by Division Directors. This structure allows the requisite focus on foods and home & personal care activities at both the regional and global levels.

These divisions operations are organised into businesses on a regional basis, with the exception of the global businesses of Prestige, our fragrance business within HPC and, within Foods, ice cream and frozen foods, SlimFast Worldwide and Foodsolutions, which provides solutions for professional chefs and caterers. The regional and global businesses are headed by Business Presidents who are responsible for their profitability. These businesses remain the driving force behind Unilever, comprising the operating companies which provide the key interface with customers and consumers, allowing quick response to the needs of local markets.

Full details of significant acquisitions and disposals can be found on pages 16 and 17. Only those with particular relevance to our business structure are reported below.

Foods
For an explanation of the new category structure within Foods see page 24.

Savoury and dressings
We are the global leader in savoury and dressings.

Our leading savoury brand, Knorr, is Unilevers biggest brand, with over3.3 billion of sales in over 100 markets. Its product range includes soups, bouillons, sauces, snacks, noodles, frozen food and meal solutions. Our wider savoury product range is currently marketed around the world under a variety of brand names.

Hellmann’s is the worlds number one mayonnaise brand. With other major brands in the portfolio including Amora, Calvé and Wishbone, we have the biggest dressings business in the world. We continue to extend our dressings product range rapidly to appeal to consumers growing appetite for new tastes, flavours and textures, healthier options and snacks.

With Bertolli, which began as a leading Italian olive oil brand, we are building on the qualities associated with Italian food to extend the brand into spreads, dressings and pasta sauces. Bertolli is now sold in more than 30 countries.

Spreads and cooking products
We are the market leader in spreads in Europe and North America. Our combined spreads and cooking products have a turnover of more than6 billion in more than 100 countries.

Spreads marketed under Becel and Flora contain ingredients that are proven to reduce cholesterol. New cooking aids including Rama/Blue Band’s Culinesse, a liquid margarine, provide healthier alternatives to traditional oils and fats.

Health & wellness
Consumers are increasingly demanding healthier options in their food and drinks. We respond to their needs with products and brands across our portfolio including SlimFast, which answers consumers need to manage their weight with healthy food that fits in to contemporary lifestyles. From its origins in North America, SlimFast is expanding across Europe, Asia and Latin America with a range including meal replacement drinks, soups and breakfast bars and now has sales of more than1 billion.

In Asia and Africa we meet consumers needs for nutritionally-enhanced staples in affordable formats with Annapurna and, under AdeS in Latin America, we market a range of tasty, nutritional, soy-based drinks.

Beverages
We are the largest seller of branded packet tea in the world through our Lipton and Brooke Bond brands. Lipton is the worlds leading brand in tea and ice tea. We recently launched a successful soft drinks innovation with Lipton Brisk in North America. Our joint venture with PepsiCo Inc. helps us to extend the reach of our brands through a distribution network complementary to our own supply chain.

Ice cream and frozen foods
We are the worlds leading producer of ice cream, with sales in more than 40 countries worldwide. Ice cream products under the Heart logo’, including Cornetto, Magnum, Carte d’Or and Solero, are sold internationally. Breyers, Ben & Jerry’s, Klondike and Popsicle are leading North American-based brands. Ben & Jerry’s is also sold in Europe.

We are the leading producer of frozen foods in Europe, under the Findus brand in Italy, Birds Eye brand in the United Kingdom and Iglo brand in most other European countries.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

10 About Unilever

 

Home & Personal Care
Home care and professional cleaning
We are one of the global leaders in the domestic home care market. Our products have been developed to meet the diverse requirements of consumers to clean and care for their homes and clothes. In laundry, they include tablets for convenience, traditional powders and liquids for soaking, washing by hand and by machine. In developing and emerging markets, tailored products, including soap bars, are available for lower income consumers. In household care our products are designed to tackle most cleaning and hygiene needs around the home.

Our home care brands are available in over 100 countries, many of them holding leading market positions. These brands include Omo, Surf, Looks Great, Snuggle, Comfort, Cif and Domestos.

In May 2002, we sold DiverseyLever, our institutional and industrial cleaning business, to Johnson Professional. Unilever retains a one-third equity stake in the combined JohnsonDiversey business, with an option to exit the business from 2007.

Personal care
We are one of the world leaders in skin and hair care, deodorants and anti-perspirants. In skin care our global brands include Lux, Dove and Pond’s. Rexona, Axe and Dove are the key brands in deodorants and anti-perspirants. Hair products are available under the Sunsilk, Dove and Suave brands.

We also have an important market share in oral care, with products sold widely, predominantly under the Signal brand.

Our Prestige fragrance business is one of the worlds largest. We sell a number of fragrances under the Calvin Klein name, including Obsession, Eternity and Truth. In addition, in recent years cK one and Crave have been introduced to appeal to the youth market. The designer fragrance brands Cerruti, Lagerfeld, Chloé and Valentino, together with Nautica, Vera Wang and BCBG fragrance, complete our extensive portfolio.

Other operations
To support our consumer brands, we own both tea plantations in India, Kenya and Tanzania and palm oil plantations in the Democratic Republic of Congo, Côte dIvoire and Ghana.

Corporate venture activities
As announced on 30 September 2002, we are to invest €170 million in building business opportunities that fit our core business interests in Foods and Home & Personal Care. Of this, as sponsor and lead investor, we have committed €100 million to the newly created Langholm Capital Partners Fund. This fund will focus on acquiring majority or influential minority stakes in private UK and continental European companies valued between 20 million and €200 million and demonstrating above-average medium-term growth prospects. In addition, up to70 million will


be invested over three years in two newly developed venture funds of our own, Unilever Ventures and Unilever Technology Ventures. The former will act as an early stage business development fund; the latter, based in California, will invest in technology-based funds and start-up companies.

Technology and innovation
To support our Path to Growth strategy we continued to focus research and development on fewer, global projects to reinforce our leading brands. We established a network of Global Innovation Centres to develop the brands and to accelerate their growth across sectors and regions.

In 2002, we spent1 166 million (2001:1 178 million; 2000: 1 187 million) on research and development 2.4% of our turnover. We introduced new ways of working to further align research and development with business needs and improve the quality and speed of innovation. For example, we linked our R&D strategy more closely with divisional strategic plans and R&D was represented on new global brand teams.

These changes led to some significant developments as we focused on fewer global projects. In Home & Personal Care, these included a single fabric conditioner ingredient for Comfort and Snuggle, giving us greater purchasing power for raw materials and reducing manufacturing costs. We also developed the Dove ultra moisturising bar and rolled out Dove Moisturising Shampoo and Conditioner in Europe, Asia and Latin America. The division also launched a new Axe formulation, providing superior odour protection and, in the anti-ageing market, we launched the clinically superior Pond’s Dramatic Results.

Foods also delivered a series of new innovations. A Knorr snack range was introduced in Latin America, providing affordable, nutritious products for low-income consumers. In the UK, a Knorr healthy eating range was brought to the consumer under the name Knorr Vie. Lipton launched a new, refreshing lemonade in the US and a new tea drink, called Sparkle, in Japan. SlimFast introduced cereal bars in the US, while under the Bertolli brand new liquid margarines and pasta sauces were launched in Europe.

In total, Unilever filed 450 new patent applications. While some innovations made a significant contribution in 2002 the benefits of others will be felt during 2003.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

About Unilever
11

Report of the Directors

Information technology
In 2002, we continued to direct our IT towards achieving Unilevers strategic objectives.

We further simplified business processes and core transaction systems, building on our global partnership with SAP. Through common information, processes and systems, we are accelerating the move to regional businesses and fully exploiting Unilevers scale. With a light but disciplined touch to what is made common at a global level, we are making global synergies, while sharpening our focus on customers and consumers both locally and regionally. The simplification of our IT infrastructure enabled these changes while reaping further benefits in cost savings, including the signing of our largest ever telecommunications deal, with BT. This telecommunications services contract sees us reducing the number of suppliers around the world from 400 to one.

Our global data warehouse, successfully established this year, is key to achieving common information across Unilever and supporting our regional businesses. On this foundation, we have built information systems to track and manage Path to Growth achievement, with strategic applications for the supply chain and brand and customer development. In the financial arena, our financial, management and brand reporting are being consolidated into the same data warehouse, for completion in 2003. These systems are providing Unilever with more comprehensive, consistent and immediate information than ever before.

We successfully piloted our global e-business gateway, the Unilever Private Exchange. The gateway, which becomes fully operational in 2003, strengthens our e-business capability by providing secure links between our operating companies and our suppliers and customers systems and to external electronic marketplaces. The success of these marketplaces and gateways is, of course, dependent on industry standards for electronic information exchange.

Unilever demonstrated its commitment to industry standards by co-chairing the Global Commerce Initiative, the worlds largest advisory group for voluntary data standards. We are working on an electronic catalogue of our products, based on these standards, which will simplify ordering for retailers.

Some good examples of our exploitation of e-business technology, building on the foundations established, include:

   branded websites and direct e-mail formed a fundamental part of new relationship marketing programmes targeting our most valuable consumers and supporting our global brands;
   
   our Ariba online buying system enables purchases of non-production items to be made at volume-negotiated prices from selected suppliers. Almost 2 000 Unilever people are now using Ariba in 24 countries;
   
   in our European Foods business, we linked our factory systems with our strategic suppliers. This enables suppliers to manage Unilever stock by looking into our systems to check current stock levels;
   
   in India, we connected more than 1 000 stockists to our systems, providing them with better stock control and easier replenishment. This led to higher sales growth and inventory savings for customers.

Environmental responsibility
Productive farmland, thriving fish stocks and clean water are essential to our success. Our desire to protect them goes hand in hand with a growing determination in society to conserve the planets resources.

In 2002, we continued to work on reducing our environmental impact while increasing production, and measuring our performance against targets. The latest data (for 2001) is available at www.unilever.com/environmentsociety. We also reviewed and updated our environmental strategy to achieve continued long-term improvement in our environmental impact.

Around the world more and more people enjoy our foods. We need to make our agricultural supply chain more sustainable. Our sustainable agriculture programme achieved its first target by completing the protocols for sustainable management of all five key crops palm oil, tea, peas, spinach and tomatoes. All the protocols were agreed in 2002 with the Sustainable Agriculture Advisory Board. They will shortly be published on www.growingforthefuture.com. For the benefit of the environment, we are sharing this knowledge of good agricultural practice and we have jointly established an industry Sustainable Agriculture Initiative.

Our progress in agriculture is matched by our commitment to sustainable fisheries. We bought more than a third of our fish from sustainable sources, of which 6% was certified to Marine Stewardship Council standards, including New Zealand hoki. This represents good progress towards our target of buying all fish from sustainable sources by 2005. In Europe we continued to support the need for a more sustainable fisheries policy.

Consumers need water to use our products, agriculture needs it for irrigation and it is used by our factories. As part of our global sustainability initiative, we extended our partnership with Rhodes University in South Africa. The Unilever Centre for Environmental Water Quality will focus on improving water management and ensuring the availability of clean, freshwater resources.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

12  About Unilever

We reduced the impact of many of our key performance indicators, such as energy and water use. However, we did not meet all of the stretching targets that we set ourselves.

For the fourth year running we have led our sector in the Dow Jones Sustainability Indexes. We also won the best overall Environmental Reporting Award, in the Association of Chartered Certified Accountants (ACCA) UK Awards for Sustainable Reporting.

Responsible corporate behaviour
Corporate social responsibility is integral to the way we run our business and has been part of our operating tradition from our earliest days. Our corporate purpose and Code of Business Principles commit us to the highest standards of corporate behaviour as we seek to meet the everyday needs of people everywhere.

The Code of Business Principles sets a framework for operational standards of behaviour, such as ensuring the safety of products or reducing the environmental impact of our manufacturing operations. Following revision in 2001, the Code was rolled out around our business in 2002 to help all our employees understand its implications. The roll-out included global and regional workshops, supported by an intranet site and an online learning tool. The Code has been translated into more than 35 languages.

Our director for corporate development leads our work on corporate social responsibility. Over recent years this programme has focused on increasing our understanding and explaining the impact of our business on society.

We regard the very business of doing business in a responsible and sustainable way as the core of our corporate social responsibility: selling products that meet local consumers needs, investing in productive capacity, spreading our technical know-how, working in partnerships through the value chain and in local communities, and making environmental responsibility a central business practice.

In late 2002 we published a second Social Review (available online at www.unilever.com/environmentsociety). The Review explores what it means for us to be a responsible corporate citizen. It gives an insight into the day-to-day practice of our business around the world and our relationships with consumers, customers and those who work in our companies, as well as with our wider community of stakeholders.

In 2002, our companies spent approximately 69 million on community projects. These ranged from commercial marketing initiatives that contributed to communities such as Signal toothpastes dental care programme in Saudi Arabia and Bushells tea road safety campaign in Australia, to social investments such as our uniquely ME! self-esteem programme for underpriviledged children run with the Girl Scouts in the USA.

Often it is in our direct involvement, in the sharing of our skills and expertise, that we can make the most difference. For example, in China, Mexico and South Africa, Unilever actively participates in local schools, not only through donations but also through employees giving their time to teach and to renovate buildings. At the end of 2001, our company in Brazil handed over to the local community a redundant ice cream factory it had helped to renovate. The factory is now used as a technical school for 21 000 low-income students on courses as diverse as computing, hotel management and tourism.

Our brands are active too. Building on its long-standing promotion of heart health in Canada, Becel supported Stroke Month and World Heart Day by donating 25 cents from each Becel spread or oil sold in several provinces. This raised Canadian $200 000 (136 000) for heart health research and hospital programmes. In Europe and Chile our Domestos brand has been working in a five-year alliance with the Red Cross movement to promote initiatives on health and hygiene, a relationship now evolving to include other Home & Personal Care brands. It is by focusing on the areas in which we have particular business expertise that we can make the most effective contribution to society.

Competition
We have a wide and diverse set of competitors in our consumer goods businesses. Many of our competitors also operate on an international scale, but others have a narrower regional or local focus.

Competition is intense and challenging. We aim to compete and give value to our consumers and customers in three ways:
   
   by continually developing new and improved products;
   
   by sharing our innovations and concepts with our businesses all around the world;
   
   by striving to lower the cost of our sourcing, manufacturing and distribution processes whilst still maintaining, and improving, the quality of our products.

We support efforts to create a more open competitive environment through the liberalisation of international trade. We also support the fuller implementation of the Single European Market and inclusion of other European countries in the European Union.

Exports
We sell our products in nearly all countries throughout the world and manufacture in many of them. Inside the European Union we make many of our products in only a few member countries, for sale in all of them.

We also export a wide range of products to countries where we do not make them. We often use this export trade to develop new markets, usually through our facilities in neighbouring countries, before building local manufacturing facilities.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

About Unilever
13

Report of the Directors

Seasonality
Certain of our businesses, such as ice creams and prestige fragrances, are subject to significant seasonal fluctuations in sales. However, Unilever operates globally in many different markets and product categories. No individual element of seasonality is likely to be material to the results of the Group as a whole.

People

Year end in thousands 2002   2001   2000   1999   1998  











Europe 60   71   80   74   80  











North America 21   22   39   22   23  











Africa, Middle East and Turkey 52   49   48   50   59  











Asia and Pacific 82   85   84   71   72  











Latin America 32   38   44   29   31  











Total 247   265   295   246   265  











Establishing an Enterprise Culture, to inspire a passion for winning among our people is an essential ingredient of our Path to Growth strategy. In 2002, we made further progress in making this culture into an integral part of Unilever.

One example of Enterprise Culture in action was the turnaround achieved at our previously slow-growing operation in Australia and New Zealand. This followed the creation of a single Australasian business that challenged employees to do things differently and to connect more closely with consumers. Their energy and drive are indicative of similar initiatives around the world.

To further motivate our people towards sustained business growth, we surveyed over 100 000 Unilever people from 110 countries, giving us invaluable insights into our Path to Growth progress. The results will help further develop our human resources strategy.

Career development at Unilever, as befitting our Enterprise Culture, is a shared responsibility between leaders and their teams.

In 2002, we pursued several diverse development initiatives. We became more exacting in measuring performance, through more rigorous application of Leadership for Growth Profiles a move which also allows managers to become better coaches. Originally designed for top management, profiles have now been expanded for use across all levels.

Unilevers future depends on developing its up and coming managers. In July, some 80 managers from 35 countries spent five days together as part of the young leaders of tomorrow programme, which is part of our comprehensive management development strategy. This event, which was attended by both Unilever Chairmen, helped participants to consider how their personal goals complement Unilevers strategic objectives.

 

We continued to adopt new ways to foster team spirit and encourage commitment to Unilever values. For example, we brought together 120 Latin American Home & Personal Care managers in a team project to refurbish a number of community facilities in São Paulo, Brazil.

Our new divisional structure empowers our people to take decisions quickly and seize opportunities. Amongst others, we built on the momentum of early Dove hair successes in Asia by rolling out the range in 31 more countries in 2002, in a vastly accelerated timeframe.

To conclude the reorganisation that accompanies Path to Growth we are streamlining the corporate centre, making services more responsive to Unilevers changing needs.

As part of our strategy to encourage managers to take more control of their careers, we rolled out open job posting in 2002. Under the initiative most Unilever vacancies are advertised internally on a new intranet site. This helps us to identify existing employees who could fill these positions and to retain talented people.

Externally, the roll-out of our new Employer Brand across 55 countries has made our approach to potential employees more attractive and effective.

Unilever is one of the most diverse organisations in the world: our top 200 leaders are drawn from 33 nationalities. Over a quarter of our managers are women. In 2002, as a step towards developing our diversity vision and strategy, we conducted a global diversity assessment. Future initiatives include steps to improve our top leaders understanding of the barriers faced by people from diverse backgrounds.

We are keen to recognise and reward success. We extended our long-term incentive programme to a further 4 000 employees and variable pay to 15 000 more employees.

Related party transactions
Transactions with related parties are conducted in accordance with the transfer pricing policies described on page 68 and consist primarily of sales to joint ventures and associates. Other than those disclosed in this report, there were no related party transactions that were material to the Group or to the related parties concerned that require to be reported in 2002 or the preceding two years.

In approximately 40 countries, our associated company, JohnsonDiversey Inc., acts as Unilever’s sole and exclusive sales agent for professional channels, in return for which it receives an agency fee. Information concerning guarantees given by the Group is stated in note 24 on page 99 and under ‘Mutual guarantee of borrowings’ on page 140. Guarantees are also given within the Group by the parent companies, as described on pages 133 and 136.

Intellectual property
We have a large portfolio of patents and trademarks, and we conduct some of our operations under licences which are based on patents or trademarks owned or controlled by others. We are not dependent on any one patent or group of patents. We use our best efforts to protect our brands and technology.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

14 About Unilever

Description of our properties
We have interests in properties in most of the countries where there are Unilever operations. However, none is material in the context of the Group as a whole. The properties are used predominantly to house production and distribution activities and as offices. There is a mixture of leased and owned property throughout the Group. There are no environmental issues affecting the properties which would have a material impact upon the Group. The directors take the view that any difference between the market value of properties held by the Group and the amount at which they are included in the balance sheet is not significant. See the schedule of principal group companies and fixed investments on page 128 and details of tangible fixed assets in note 10 on page 81.

Legal and arbitration proceedings and regulatory matters
We are not involved in any legal or arbitration proceedings and do not have any obligations under environmental legislation which we expect to lead to a material loss in the context of the Group results. None of our directors or officers are involved in any such material legal proceedings.

Unilever has businesses in many countries and, from time to time, these are subject to investigation by competition and other regulatory authorities. The most significant of these in recent years concerns ice cream distribution in Europe, notably the issues of outlet and cabinet exclusivity. The decision of the European Court of First Instance in the matter of our appeal against the European Commissions negative decision on cabinet exclusivity in Ireland is expected in the first half of 2003. In the event that our appeal fails, among the consequences will be the need to institute changes to the manner in which we offer impulse ice cream at the point of sale, initially in the Republic of Ireland and subsequently elsewhere in Europe.

Government regulation
Unilever businesses are governed, in particular, by national laws designed to ensure that their products may be safely used for their intended purpose and that their labelling and advertising complies in all respects with relevant regulations. The introduction of new products and ingredients and processes is, specifically, subject to rigorous controls.

Unilever businesses are further regulated by data protection and anti-trust legislation. Important regulatory bodies include the European Commission and the US Food and Drug Administration.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents


Operating review highlights
15

Report of the Directors


Basis of reporting and discussion

Our accounting policies are based on United Kingdom generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) and UK and Netherlands law which differ in certain respects from United States GAAP. The principal differences are described on page 119. We have shown reconciliations to net income and capital and reserves under US GAAP on pages 118 and 119.

The commentary throughout this operating review is, unless otherwise indicated, based on the results of the Group including acquisitions made each year, at constant rates of exchange (see below) and before exceptional items and amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (BEIA). In our reporting, turnover means Group turnover plus our share of turnover of joint ventures, net of our share of any sales to the joint ventures already included in the Group figures. Operating profit means Group operating profit plus our share of operating profit of joint ventures. These measures do not include our share of the turnover or operating profit of associates. References to sales growth are made on an underlying basis, excluding the effects of acquisitions and disposals. References to turnover growth include the effects of acquisitions and disposals.

Reporting currency and exchange rates
Foreign currency amounts for results and cash flows are translated from underlying local currencies into euros using annual average exchange rates; balance sheet amounts are translated at year-end rates except for the ordinary capital of the two parent companies. These are translated at the rate prescribed by the Equalisation Agreement of £1 = Fl. 12, and thence to euros at the official rate of 1.00 = Fl. 2.20371 (see Control of Unilever on page 138).

The discussion of performance included in this operating review is based on constant rates of exchange. This removes the distorting impact of currency movements and more clearly portrays the underlying progress of the operations themselves. The rate used is the annual average rate for the prior year. For each two-year period, the year-on-year trends in euros are the same as those which would arise if the results were shown in sterling or US dollars at constant exchange rates.

For the reporting of 2000 at current exchange rates, the results of the Bestfoods business acquired on 4 October of that year were translated at the average rates of exchange for the last quarter of 2000. In the constant rate comparisons for 2001 included in the Operating review on pages 18 to 34, the results for all parts of the Group have been translated at average rates of exchange for the full year to 31 December 2000. This means that the 2000 results in these comparative tables will differ in some cases from the values translated at current rates of exchange.

Details of exchange rates used in preparation of these accounts and of the Noon Buying Rates against the US dollar are given on page 117.


2002 results compared with 2001

Including the impact of acquisitions and disposals, turnover for the year of 52 020 million was in line with 2001 levels. Excluding the effect of acquisitions and disposals, underlying growth was 4.2%. The net effect of acquisition and disposal activity was a reduction of 4.4%.

Operating profit BEIA increased by 6.5% to 7 739 million and operating margin BEIA moved ahead to 14.9% from 13.9% in 2001. The improvement in margin is primarily due to business restructuring and procurement savings under the Path to Growth strategy combined with continued success in the integration of Bestfoods, partially offset by higher advertising and promotions expenditure.

Operating profit increased by 3.4% to 5 436 million. This includes a higher net charge for exceptional items than the prior year, which included higher profits on the sale of brands.

Exceptional items
Operating profit for the year includes net exceptional charges of 939 million, an increase of 59.7% on 2001. Restructuring investment was 1 298 million, which was offset by the release of provisions following settlement of certain legal claims in our favour and profits on disposals totalling 359 million.

The exceptional items incurred in the year primarily relate to the Path to Growth strategy we announced on 22 February 2000 to accelerate growth and expand margins, and to restructuring arising from the integration of Bestfoods. The aggregate cost of these programmes over 5 years is estimated to be 6.2 billion, the majority of which is expected to be exceptional. An 828 million profit recognised in 2001 on the sale of brands to secure regulatory approval for the acquisition of Bestfoods is not included in this estimate.

Details of movements in restructuring and other provisions are given in note 19 on page 95.

Under US GAAP, some of the restructuring charges in each year would not have been recognised until certain additional criteria had been met, and would then have been included as a charge in subsequent years. Details of the US GAAP adjustments relating to the restructuring charges are given on pages 118 to 120.

Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles
The amortisation charge for the year was 1 364 million, a decrease of 4.1% on 2001. 2002 includes 1 110 million (2001: 1 170 million) in respect of goodwill recognised on the acquisition of Bestfoods.

Under US GAAP, there is no amortisation charge with effect from 1 January 2002 for goodwill or for intangible assets having indefinite lives. Further details are given on pages 118 to 120.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents


16  Operating review highlights

2001 results compared with 2000
Turnover increased by 11% to 53 400 million. This increase was the result of an acquisition impact of 12%, a disposal impact of (5)% and underlying growth of 4%.

Operating profit BEIA increased by 28% to 7 416 million, and operating margin BEIA rose to an historic high of 13.9% from 12.0% in 2000. The improvement in margin primarily reflects the ongoing contribution from Path to Growth restructuring and procurement savings and the successful integration of Bestfoods.

Operating profit increased by 66% to 5 360 million, being primarily the net impact of acquisitions and disposals offset by an increase in the amortisation charge.

Exceptional items
Exceptional items for 2001 were 620 million, which included 1 564 million of restructuring investment and profits on disposals of 944 million. Of the latter, 828 million related to the profit on the sale of the brands to secure regulatory approval for our acquisition of Bestfoods and 114 million related to profit on the sale of Unipath. Associated costs included in operating profit were 393 million.

Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles
The amortisation charge in 2001 was 1 436 million. This included 1 186 million for Bestfoods.

Acquisitions and disposals
In 2002, we increased our holding in the Robertsons business in South Africa and Israel to 59%, and took a one-third equity share in JohnsonDiversey Holdings Inc. (see below).

No significant acquisitions were made during 2001.

On 18 February 2003, Unilever announced an agreement to acquire the remaining unheld shares in CPC/Aji Asia, a joint venture with activities in six countries, from Ajinomoto Co. Inc, Japan. The acquisition will be in two parts with approximately one half of Ajinomotos holding being transferred on 25 March 2003 and the balance scheduled for transfer in March 2004. Unilever will pay US $381 million (approximately 360 million) for Ajinomotos equity holding. Unilever will have full management control of the entire business from 25 March 2003. The deal is subject to approval by regulatory authorities.

In 2002 we disposed of 35 businesses for a total consideration of approximately 1 993 million.

Significant disposals in 2002 were as follows:

On 8 January 2002, we completed the sale of our Unimills refinery business at Zwijndrecht, the Netherlands, to Golden Hope Plantations Berhad of Malaysia, for approximately €60 million in cash. This business had annual sales to third parties of approximately €130 million in 2001.

In January and February 2002, we completed the sale of the Mafer snacks business to Sabritas and the Clemente Jacques culinary business to La Costeña, both in Mexico. Together, these businesses had sales in 2001 of approximately €40 million.

On 3 May 2002, we completed the sale of our DiverseyLever institutional and industrial cleaning business to Johnson Professional for some US $0.9 billion (1.0 billion) in cash and a loan note of US $241 million (270 million). We also took a one-third equity share in the combined business (JohnsonDiversey), with an option to exit the business from 2007. A valuation of around US $300 million (330 million) for this one-third equity share brought the total worth of the transaction to Unilever to approximately US $1.5 billion (1.6 billion). Turnover of DiverseyLever for the 12 months to December 2001, excluding sales of the consumer brands which JohnsonDiversey distribute for Unilever under a separate sales agency agreement, was approximately US $1.5 billion (1.7 billion).

On 11 June 2002, we completed the sale of the Nocilla chocolate spreads business in Spain to Nutrexpa. The business had sales in 2001 of approximately 36 million.

On 2 July 2002, the sale of 19 food brands to ACH Food Companies, Inc., a subsidiary of Associated British Foods plc, was completed for a total of approximately US $360 million (383 million) in cash. These brands and related assets, acquired by Unilever in connection with the October 2000 acquisition of Bestfoods, had combined sales of US $310 million (350 million) in 2001.

On 16 July 2002, we completed the sale of Atkinsons, a fragrance business based in Italy, to Wella AG for €44 million. The business had sales in 2001 of approximately 35 million.

On 30 November 2002, we completed the sale of Loders Croklaan Group, an international speciality oils and fats business, to IOI Corporation Berhad of Malaysia for €217 million in cash. This business had sales of €267 million in 2001.

On 31 December 2002, we completed the sale of our Iberia Foods business to an affiliate of the Brooklyn Bottling Group of Brooklyn, New York. In 2002 the business had sales of approximately US $43 million (48 million).

On 2 December 2002, we announced an agreement to sell our holdings in Unipamol Malaysia Sdn. Bhd. and Pamol Plantations Sdn. Bhd. to Palmco of Malaysia, a subsidiary of IOI Corporation. The sale was completed on 17 January 2003, for a cash consideration of 138 million. In 2002 these businesses had combined sales of approximately €51 million.

In 2001 we disposed of 34 businesses for a total consideration of approximately 3 621 million. Disposals included Unipath; the Elizabeth Arden business; the



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Operating review highlights
17

Report of the Directors


Bestfoods Baking Company; European dry soups and sauces businesses; North American seafood business; and various other smaller businesses and brands.

Public takeover offers made by Unilever during 2002 related to the following:

On 14 August 2002, Unilever Overseas Holdings Limited and other members of the Unilever Group were obliged to make an agreed public tender offer on the Cairo and Alexandria Stock Exchange in Egypt for 2 938 000 shares (49%) of El Rashidi El Mizan Confectionery SAE at a price of 31.22 Egyptian pounds per share. All the shares were acquired. The purchase and price had been agreed by Bestfoods in 2000 at the time of their acquisition of the other 51% of the company.

Subsequently on 22 December 2002, Middle East Food and Trade Company SAE made an agreed public tender offer on the Cairo and Alexandria Stock Exchange in Egypt for the 6 000 000 shares (100%) of the company held by members of the Unilever Group at a price of 15.33 Egyptian pounds per share. The transaction was completed on 6 January 2003 and all the shares were sold. Since control was considered to have passed at 31 December 2002, the disposal is reflected in these accounts.

Public takeover offers made by Unilever during 2001 related to the following:

On 23 January 2001, following an offer, made in November 2000, through its subsidiary, Hindustan Lever Limited (HLL), for the 24.62% of the shares in International Bestfoods Limited India not already owned by Bestfoods, Unilever acquired 7.99% of the shares for a consideration of €2 million.

On 31 January 2001, following an offer made in October 2000 by Unilever through its Tunisian subsidiary, Société de Cosmetiques Détergent et Parfumerie, for the 9.21% of the shares in Société de Produits Chimiques Détergents not already owned by Unilever, 8.1% of the shares were acquired for a consideration of 4 million.

On 4 December 2001, following a joint offer by Unilever and its subsidiary, Hindustan Lever Limited, for the remaining 10.38% of the shares in Rossell Industries Limited, India, not acquired in March 2000, Lipton India Exports Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of HLL acquired a further 6.27% of the shares for a consideration of €1.8 million, which brings the Groups aggregate holding in Rossell Industries to 95.89%.

For further information on the impact of acquisitions and disposals please refer also to the Cash flow section of the Financial review on page 37 and note 25 to the consolidated accounts on page 99.




Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

18 Operating review by region


Europe

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

 
€ million
2002
 
million
2001
 
%
Change
 









Turnover
19 657
 
20 220
 
(3)%
 
Operating profit
1 772
 
2 710
 
(35)%
 









Group turnover
19 573
 
20 119
 
(3)%
 
Group operating profit
1 750
 
2 689
 
(35)%
 









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

 
€ million
2002
 
€ million
2001
 
%
Change
 









Turnover
19 700
 
20 220
 
(3)%
 









Operating profit BEIA
3 006
 
2 967
 
1%
 
Exceptional items
(741
)
 
254
 
 
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles
(511
)
 
(511
)
   









Operating profit
1 754
 
2 710
 
(35)%
 









Operating margin
8.9%
 
13.4%
 
 
Operating margin BEIA
15.3%
 
14.7%
 
 









Underlying sales grew 3% with a continuing significant contribution from Central and Eastern Europe. Turnover was 3% lower than last year through the impact of disposals.

Operating margin BEIA increased by 0.6% to 15.3%. This reflected the benefits from our savings programmes including the integration of Bestfoods and strong growth in ice cream profitability driven by mix improvements and cost reductions. These gains were partly reinvested in additional support for the leading brands.

Western Europe
In Foods, underlying sales grew by 3% including an increasing contribution from UBF Foodsolutions, our food service business. There has been sustained progress in branded spreads and cooking products which grew 5% due to the continuing impact of innovations, especially in

 


Flora/Becel
which grew by over 10%. Savoury and dressings grew 4% with marketplace activity behind Amora, Hellmanns, Bertolli, Knorr and Pot Noodle and the launches of soup makers, chilled soups and Bertolli pasta sauces towards the end of the year. SlimFast also grew well as we continued its roll-out. Ice cream showed great resilience with innovations such as Cornetto Soft and snack-size ice creams helping to offset the impact of poorer weather than the prior year to give growth of 1%.

In Home & Personal Care in Western Europe, good growth in skin, deodorants and hair included particularly strong performances through innovation and range extension in Dove, Rexona and Axe. Laundry volumes grew by 4%, which was partly offset by pricing in a competitive environment to give an underlying sales growth of 1%, with market share being maintained.

Central and Eastern Europe
Underlying sales grew by 9% with particular strength in dressings, tea, household care and personal care. We made further good progress in Russia.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

 
€ million
2001
 
€ million
2000
 
%
Change
 









Turnover
20 220
 
19 075
 
6%
 
Operating profit
2 710
 
1 711
 
58%
 









Group turnover
20 119
 
18 967
 
6%
 
Group operating profit
2 689
 
1 693
 
59%
 









2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

 
€ million
2001
 
€ million
2000
 
%
Change
 









Turnover
20 233
 
19 071
 
6%
 









Operating profit BEIA
2 978
 
2 419
 
23%
 
Exceptional items
270
 
(565
)
 
 
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles
(511
)
 
(143
)
 









Operating profit
2 737
 
1 711
 
60%
 









Operating margin
13.5%
 
9.0%
 
 
Operating margin BEIA
14.7%
 
12.7%
 
 









Turnover was ahead in 2001 by 6% with an underlying sales growth of 4%. Growth was broad based and included a strong contribution from Central and Eastern Europe.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Operating review by region
19

Report of the Directors


Operating margin BEIA increased to 14.7% in Europe due to restructuring, buying and marketing-support efficiencies, and portfolio improvement.

Western Europe
The success of proactiv, Culinesse and Bertolli in spreads and cooking products, the 4 Salti in Padella range of high-quality frozen ready meals and the expansion of SlimFast, led to a step-up in the growth rate for Foods. Cornetto and Carte d’Or both grew strongly through innovation, whilst in savoury and dressings there was continued momentum in Amora Maille and we started to see the strength of the Knorr brand.

In personal care, the leading brands maintained their good rate of growth, led by range extensions in Dove and Signal and by Rexona. Dove shampoo was launched in eight countries by the end of the year and the initial response was very positive. The success of the Vaporesse ironing aid in fabric conditioners together with a solid response to a more competitive environment in fabric wash helped laundry to grow. We continued to enjoy good rates of growth in Domestos and Cif through the success of easy-to-use wipes and the launch of Domestos Bi-Actif and Domestos WC Active Mousse.

Central and Eastern Europe
We saw strong growth, most notably leaf tea and Delmy mayonnaise in Russia, the launch of instant soups and broad based progress in Home & Personal Care.

North America

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 12 568     13 880  
(9)%  
Operating profit 1 467     1 124     31%  









Group turnover 12 446     13 767     (10)%  
Group operating profit 1 435     1 092     31%  









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 13 205     13 880     (5)%  









Operating profit BEIA 2 130     1 973     8%  
Exceptional items (70 )   (285 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (519 )   (564 )      









Operating profit 1 541     1 124     37%  









Operating margin 11.7%     8.1%        
Operating margin BEIA 16.1%   14.2%        









Underlying sales grew 1% with a stronger performance in the second half as marketplace activity built through the year. Turnover declined 5% through the impact of disposals, notably DiverseyLever and Mazola.

In Foods, underlying sales grew 2% and our market shares remained firm. SlimFast continued to expand, passing the €1 billion sales mark globally. Ice cream again grew at over 5% and Wishbone, Becel and Knorr also moved ahead well. In addition to an active programme behind these brands, innovations including Lipton Brisk lemonade and Ragú Rich and Meaty sauces led growth in the second half of the year. Overall, sales growth in the year was held back by promotional price competition in mayonnaise, the exit from Hellmann’s pourable dressings and the impact of lower butter prices on the margarine market.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

20 Operating review by region

In Home & Personal Care, underlying sales were flat for the full year with an improved performance in the latter part offsetting a slow start to the year. This reflects both the timing of the overall innovation plan and the steps taken to improve profitability in laundry to give the base for a more active programme from the fourth quarter. The successful launches of Axe deodorant and all fabric conditioner and the re-launch of Dove body wash contributed to a strong finish to the year.

Operating margin BEIA increased by 1.9% to 16.1%. This was driven particularly by improvements in laundry profitability but also widespread benefits from savings programmes partly reinvested in additional advertising and promotion.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 13 880     11 708     19%  
Operating profit 1 124     72        









Group turnover 13 767     11 631     18%  
Group operating profit 1 092     48        









2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 13 543     11 679     16%  









Operating profit BEIA 1 923     1 494     29%  
Exceptional items (281 )   (1 249 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (549 )   (179 )      









Operating profit 1 093     66        









Operating margin 8.1%     0.6%        
Operating margin BEIA 14.2%     12.8%        









Turnover was ahead by 16% with an underlying growth of 2%. In our Home & Personal Care mass business underlying sales growth was 2.5%, skewed towards the first half of the year, due to the phasing of innovation. There were good performances by our brands across the skin, hair and deodorant categories, notably Dove and Suave.

In Prestige fragrance our sales declined, reflecting both the sale of Elizabeth Arden and weaknesses in department stores and travel retail following the tragic events of 11 September. The decline in underlying sales reduced the overall North American growth rate by nearly 1%.

Our Foods business recorded an underlying sales growth of just over 3% for the year.

The integration of Ben & Jerrys proceeded well and sales grew 8% in the year. This, together with strong sales of Breyers, Popsicle, Klondike and Good Humor, further strengthened our market leadership. SlimFast continued to expand and approached 1 billion sales globally. Spreads grew with the introduction of calcium variants of the Shedds and I Cant Believe Its Not Butter! ranges. In culinary products, sales were flat due to competitive activity and our focus on integration. In tea, sales declined as we focused on brand convergence and transition to our common global positioning.

Operating margin BEIA of 14.2% in North America reflected the benefits of portfolio change, restructuring, global procurement and marketing-support efficiencies.

Africa, Middle East and Turkey

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 3 225     3 455     (7)%  
Operating profit 295     215     37%  









Group turnover 3 139     3 191     (2)%  
Group operating profit 286     203     41%  









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 3 754     3 455     9%  









Operating profit BEIA 426     380     12%  
Exceptional items (45 )   (139 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles  (23 )     (26 )        









Operating profit 358     215     67%  









Operating margin 9.5%   6.2%        
Operating margin BEIA 11.3%   11.0%        









Underlying sales grew by 7% with turnover ahead by 9% as we now consolidate all of the Bestfoods Robertsons business following the increase in our holding.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Operating review by region
21

Report of the Directors


Growth was broad based across categories with the major contributions from marketing activities behind Knorr, Lipton, Lux, Dove and laundry brands. South Africa performed particularly well with good sales growth especially in Omo, Sunsilk, Rama, Axe and Lux in Home & Personal Care and Knorr, Lipton and Flora proactiv in Foods. In Turkey, the weak economy has led to consumer downtrading and market contraction and our sales have declined as a result. Elsewhere in the region we have strengthened our market position, particularly in Algeria, Arabia, Egypt, Morocco and West Africa.

Operating margin BEIA increased to 11.3% after an increase in investment behind the leading brands.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 3 455     3 512     (2)%  
Operating profit 215     329     (35)%  









Group turnover 3 191     3 296     (3)%  
Group operating profit 203     321     (37)%  









2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 3 843     3 499     10%  









Operating profit BEIA 422     352     20%  
Exceptional items (160 )   (16 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (28 )   (6 )      









Operating profit 234     330     (29)%  









Operating margin 6.1%     9.4%        
Operating margin BEIA 11.0%     10.0%        









Turnover grew by 10% with an underlying sales growth of 7%. Price increases had priority to protect margins in countries where there had been devaluation, in particular South Africa and Turkey. Growth was broad based across our brands, with the strongest country contributions coming from South Africa, Nigeria, Ghana and Morocco. There were good performances by Omo, relaunched with an improved formulation, Close-up in West Africa, where we continued to strengthen our position in oral care, and by Dove.

Operating margin BEIA at 11.0% in Africa, Middle East and Turkey was ahead of 2000, reflecting focused management in challenging economic conditions.

Asia and Pacific

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 7 865     8 046     (2)%  
Operating profit 1 098     880     25%  









Group turnover 7 679     7 846     (2)%  
Group operating profit 1 077     862     25%  









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 8 242     8 046     2%  









Operating profit BEIA 1 166     1 077     8%  
Exceptional items 13     (157 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (32 )   (40 )      









Operating profit 1 147     880     30%  









Operating margin 13.9%   10.9%        
Operating margin BEIA 14.1%   13.4%        









Underlying sales grew by 5%. Including the impact of disposals, turnover grew by 2%.

Home & Personal Care grew well across both categories and countries. Indonesia, Philippines and Vietnam performed particularly well and skin, hair and deodorants all grew at over 10% across the region through innovations and support behind Dove, Lifebuoy and Ponds. Underlying sales growth in India accelerated through the year to reach 3% for the full year despite the planned harvesting of non-leading brands. The stronger second half in India has been led by Fair and Lovely with the launch of a herbal variant, Ponds with new small packs, the launch of a new Vaseline variant for treating damaged skin and good growth in laundry.

In Foods, good growth in South East Asia reflects the Bestfoods brands benefiting from the Unilever distribution system, innovation in Knorr, and a strengthening of the


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

22 Operating review by region

Bango soy sauce and Sariwangi tea brands in Indonesia. This performance was partly offset by declines in tea in Central Asia as prices are adjusted to reflect lower commodity prices and a focus on improving profitability as we exit from low-value, low-growth commoditised teas. In Japan the successful alliance with Suntory in ready-to-drink tea has doubled the market share of Lipton to over 25%.

Operating margin BEIA increased to 14.1% with gains from our savings programmes partly reinvested in increased advertising and promotions.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 8 046     8 091     (1)%  
Operating profit 880     781     13%  









Group turnover 7 846     8 038     (2)%  
Group operating profit 862     776     11%  









2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 8 558     8 091     6%  









Operating profit BEIA 1 154     908     27%  
Exceptional items (166 )   (109 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (41 )   (19 )      









Operating profit 947     780     21%  









Operating margin 11.1%     9.6%        
Operating margin BEIA 13.5%     11.2%        









Turnover grew by 6% with underlying sales ahead by the same amount.

In South East Asia and Japan, sales growth exceeded 10%. Notable were: a strong performance in Japan with the successful launch of Dove shampoo; Lipton ready-to-drink tea through the alliance with Suntory; and our skin business through Dove. In South East Asia our personal care brands powered ahead in all countries led by new variants of Sunsilk, and in Indonesia there was increased market penetration for Rexona and excellent performances from Citra and Pepsodent following its relaunch.

In India, the more focused brand portfolio delivered improved growth and profitability. There were particularly strong performances by Sunsilk and Clinic in hair, Rin and Wheel in laundry, and Fair and Lovely range extensions in skin care. In Foods, sales were flat as we aggressively improved margins and eliminated poor-performing brands.

In China, there was substantial progress towards profitability.

Operating margin BEIA for 2001 advanced to 13.5% in Asia and Pacific reflecting the benefits of global procurement, improved Foods profitability and a stronger mix through the growth in personal care.

Latin America

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 5 445     6 605     (18)%  
Operating profit 493     329     50%  









Group turnover 5 433     6 591     (18)%  
Group operating profit 493     328     50%  









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 7 119     6 605     8%  









Operating profit BEIA 1 011     872     16%  
Exceptional items (96 )   (261 )      
Amortisation of goodwill                
and intangibles (279 )   (282 )      









Operating profit 636     329     93%  









Operating margin 8.9%   5.0%        
Operating margin BEIA 14.2%   13.2%        









Underlying sales grew by 12% driven by pricing action to recover devaluation-led cost increases, particularly in Argentina. Outside Argentina, volumes grew by 2% with price ahead by 9%. Including the impact of disposals, turnover in the region grew by 8%. At current exchange rates turnover fell by 18%. Weaker currencies in Argentina and Brazil contributed 9.5% and 4.7% respectively to this decline. Excluding the impact of acquisitions and disposals, sales were 14% below 2001 levels. Operating profit BEIA fell by 13% at current exchange rates.

Personal care continued to perform very strongly. Sedal shampoo grew well across the region. Dove shampoo has been launched in Brazil, Chile, Mexico and Peru and is making very good progress. In deodorants, Rexona has been successfully launched in Venezuela and relaunched in Colombia and we have taken clear market leadership in Mexico. In laundry, market shares have held firm against our



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Operating review by region
23

Report of the Directors


nearest competitor and we have responded to changed economic conditions with packs which speci
fically address the reduced spending power of consumers.

In Foods, ice cream grew by over 10%, mostly volume, with the main contributions from Brazil and Mexico. Good performances were led by the launch of Knorr noodle cups in Mexico, an energised Hellmanns campaign in Chile and significant growth in Arisco in Brazil. In spreads, Becel de Capullo was launched in Mexico, introducing the Becel brand to that country. Lipton ready-to-drink tea continued to grow well in Brazil and the soy-based beverage AdeS made very good progress in both Brazil and Mexico.

In Argentina consumer demand is considerably down and volumes have been affected as a result. We continue to hold strong market shares and our experienced local management are managing the business in a way which preserves its long-term health. Gross margins are being protected and new products have been launched in both Foods and Home & Personal Care to respond to reduced disposable incomes.

Operating margin BEIA increased by 1% to 14.2%, after an increase in investment behind the leading brands.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

 
€ million
2001
€ million
2000
 
%
Change








Turnover 6 605   5 680     16 %
Operating profit 329   345     (5) %








Group turnover 6 591   5 650     17 %
Group operating profit 328   343     (4) %








2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

 
million
2001
million
2000
 
%
Change








Turnover 7 223   5 667     27 %








Operating profit BEIA 939   612     53 %
Exceptional items (283 ) (173 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (307 ) (96 )      








Operating profit 349   343     2 %








Operating margin 4.8 % 6.1 %      
Operating margin BEIA 13.0 % 10.8 %      








Turnover moved ahead by 27% with an underlying sales growth of 5%.

A key feature of the year was our determination to move prices to recover devaluation-driven cost increases and so protect our margin structure.

Mexico sustained strong growth throughout the year. The key drivers were: Sedal, which reached an 8% share


in the hair care market in its first year since launch; further progress in spreads, deodorants and skin care; and a successful expansion of
Holanda ice cream.

In Argentina, markets declined as consumer income reduced, however, our market shares remained strong. In Brazil, overall volumes were impacted by energy restrictions and devaluation-related price increases but continuing innovation in hair and deodorant delivered volume growth.

Operating margin BEIA for the year at 13.0% in Latin America was ahead of 2000 reflecting the benefits of portfolio change, global procurement, savings from Bestfoods integration and improved ice cream profitability.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

24  Operating review by category Foods


Financial overview

 
billion
2002 at
2002
rates
billion
2002 at
2001
rates
billion
2001 at
2001
rates
%
Change at
2001
rates
*









Turnover 27.4   28.7   28.8   0%  









Operating profit 2.3   2.3   2.4   (2)%  









Operating profit BEIA 4.0   4.2   4.1   2%  









Operating margin* 8.3 % 8.1 % 8.3%      
Operating margin BEIA* 14.8 % 14.8 % 14.4%      









   
* Calculated using unrounded numbers
 
Foods categories have changed with effect from 1 January 2002 to:
   
   Savoury and dressings
   Spreads and cooking products
   Health & wellness and beverages
   Ice cream and frozen foods

This reflects the evolution in the organisation of our Foods division. Prior year results have been reclassified under the new categories.

Pages 24 to 30 present a review of performance in each major product category. Included in the figures for each category are the results of our food service business, which we profile briefly below:

Foodsolutions
UBF Foodsolutions is one of the worlds largest food service businesses. It operates in more than 60 countries around the world.

The business is focused on delivering innovative, relevant solutions to the professional chef and caterer, leveraging our consumer brands already 85% of product sales and our technology. In 2002, UBF Foodsolutions delivered 5% underlying sales growth, with momentum growing throughout the year.

Foods
Our Foods portfolio focuses increasingly on brands with the potential to grow across borders and categories, in markets that are growing rapidly as consumers demand more choice, great taste, convenience, vitality, fun and indulgence.

Since the creation of Unilever Bestfoods in 2000, we have accelerated growth and increased profits, while successfully integrating several businesses and undertaking an ambitious programme of disposals.

During 2002, our brands were enjoyed by millions of people around the world, as we increased the momentum of profitable growth. Our leading brands grew by 4.4% and we delivered underlying sales growth of 3.4%. Due to disposals, turnover remained in line with prior year. Overall, operating profit BEIA rose by 2% with margins reaching 14.8%.


Savoury and dressings

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

  € million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 9 503     9 999     (5)%  
Operating profit 450     814     (45)%  









Group turnover 9 272     9 597     (3)%  
Group operating profit 422     793     (47)%  









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates


  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 10 138     9 999     1%  









Operating profit BEIA 1 658     1 685     (2)%  
Exceptional items (37 )   347        
Amortisation of goodwilland intangibles  (1 155 )      (1 218 )          









Operating profit 466     814     (43)%  









Operating margin 4.6%     8.1%        
Operating margin BEIA 16.4%     16.9%        









We are world leaders in both the savoury and dressings foods categories. Knorr, Unilevers biggest brand, grew by 7.3% across 100 markets with products as diverse as seasonings and meal kits, snacks and frozen food. There was a clear acceleration in the pace of growth as the year progressed.

Innovation met the needs of consumers with a love of good food but little time to cook: for example, we introduced Knorr soupy snacks, Knax noodle cups, a snack launched in Latin America, and Knorr Vie, a healthy eating range in Europe. Bertollis growing international appeal delivered sales growth for the brand of 8.5%. Once solely an Italian olive oil, the Bertolli portfolio now ranges from pasta sauces and meal solutions to spreads and snacks.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Operating review by category Foods
25

Report of the Directors


The enduring popularity of mayonnaise drove good growth in
Hellmanns in Europe and Latin America, but competitive pressure in North America and our withdrawal from liquid salad dressings affected the brands overall performance, leaving sales flat year on year. Australia was welcomed to the world of Hellmanns with the launch of dressings and mayonnaise.

Calvé and Wishbone also delivered strong results. Growth was fuelled by innovations that took our key dressings brands beyond mayonnaise into new tastes and flavours, dips and sauces, many inspired by Amora and Maille.

Underlying sales growth was 4% and, allowing for disposals, turnover increased 1% in 2002. Operating margin BEIA was slightly below 2001 at 16.4%, after an increase in advertising and promotions.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

  million   million   %  
2001 2000 Change







Turnover 9 999   6 074   65%  
Operating profit 814   309   163%  







Group turnover 9 597   5 950   61%  
Group operating profit 793   296   168%  







2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

  million   million   %  
2001 2000 Change







Turnover 10 154   6 034   68%  







Operating profit BEIA 1 693   803   111%  
Exceptional items 344   (169)      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles  (1 233)     (326)         







Operating profit 804   308   161%  







Operating margin 7.9 % 5.1%      
Operating margin BEIA 16.7 % 13.3%      







Following the acquisition of Bestfoods, Knorr became our biggest brand and, during its first full year under Unilever stewardship, grew by over 4% worldwide. We drove its strong performance with innovations such as Knorr Exotic Meal Kits, which we continued to extend in Europe; Knorr Cup Pasta, which we launched in Taiwan; Knorr Quick Soups in Switzerland and Knorr Sazonisimo, which we introduced in Mexico.

The Hellmanns brand also did well considering difficult market conditions in Latin America and fierce competition in the US. It enjoyed sales growth of over 10% in some national markets, including Greece, Ireland, the Philippines and Thailand. As part of the integration, we withdrew Hellmanns pourable sauces in the US to concentrate on the larger Wishbone brand.

 


Our
Amora brand also had a successful year with increased sales and profits. Innovations, such as Amora Clip-Sauce in France and extensions into the chilled cabinet, helped drive growth.

Turnover in olive oil declined mainly due to the disposal of the unprofitable La Masia business in Spain but profitability increased significantly. This was mainly driven by the continued success of Bertolli, which again enjoyed good volume growth, especially in Western Europe. Recognising the consumer appeal of healthy Mediterranean-style food, we introduced Bertolli dressings in the Netherlands and brought Five Brothers pasta sauce in the UK and US, and Olivio spreads in the UK, under the Bertolli umbrella.

We disposed of several European dry soups and sauces businesses, following undertakings given to the European Commission in connection with the Bestfoods acquisition. These disposals included Batchelors and Oxo in the UK, Royco and the Lesieur range in France, Heisse Tasse in Germany and Blå Band in Denmark, Sweden and Finland.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

26 Operating review by category – Foods

 

Spreads and cooking products

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

 
million
2002
million
2001
 
%
Change








Turnover 6 216   6 771     (8 )%
Operating profit 812   817     (1 )%








Group turnover 6 145   6 681     (8 )%
Group operating profit 793   797     (1 )%








2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

 
million
2002
million
2001
 
%
Change








Turnover 6 474   6 771     (4 )%








Operating profit BEIA 1 029   1 086     (5 )%
Exceptional items (183 ) (260 )      
Amortisation of goodwill              
and intangibles (22 ) (9 )      








Operating profit 824   817     1 %








Operating margin 12.7 % 12.1 %      
Operating margin BEIA 15.9 % 16.0 %      








In 2002, we built on our position as the market leader in branded margarine and spreads. In this sector, as elsewhere, the strength of our local roots and understanding of regional tastes and cultures helped deliver growth.

Innovation was key to our strong performance. The sustained success of proactiv, an innovation that is proven to reduce cholesterol, continued to drive rapid growth in our leading spreads brands, Flora/Becel, which grew by 11.6%. Healthier, more convenient cooking products, including Rama and Culinesse and family oriented spreads, such as Blue Band, all contributed towards our good performance.

 

An important driver of success has been increasing support from key opinion formers, such as health care professionals. During the year, we complemented our alliances with national heart associations with the worldwide sponsorship of the World Heart Federations World Heart Day.

Including the impact of disposing of several oil businesses, turnover fell 4% compared with 2001, whilst underlying sales grew by over 2%. Operating margin BEIA was slightly lower than in 2001 at 15.9%, after increased advertising and promotions investment.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

 
million
2001
million
2000
 
%
Change








Turnover 6 771   16 749     0 %
Operating profit 817   839     (3 )%








Group turnover 6 681   6 670     0 %
Group operating profit 797   823     (3 )%








2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

 
€ million
2001
million
2000
 
%
Change








Turnover 6 917   6 732     3 %








Operating profit BEIA 1 095   921     19 %
Exceptional items (269 ) (23 )      
Amortisation of goodwill              
and intangibles (9 ) (64 )      








Operating profit 817   834     (2 )%








Operating margin 11.8 % 12.4 %      








Operating margin BEIA 15.8 % 13.7 %      








In 2001, consumer focused innovations made our spreads turnover grow again and our total market share improved by about 1%. Operating profit BEIA increased by 19%.

Our ability to satisfy consumer demand for healthy foods was key to our success. Proactiv, which includes ingredients that can help to reduce levels ofbad cholesterol, showed very impressive growth across Europe. Culinesse, a high-performance, easy-to-use, liquid cooking product, was successfully launched in 11 European countries.

In the US, an enterprising, cross-functional initiative that looked at all aspects of margarine marketing captured the imagination of consumers and boosted sales. I Cant Believe Its Not Butter! grew particularly strongly.

Our European dairy spreads, marketed under Brunch, Boursin and Crème Bonjour, continued to grow. Spreads in most Eastern European countries recovered well, although the Russian market remained difficult.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Operating review by category Foods
27

 

Report of the Directors

Health & wellness and beverages

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

 
million
2002
   
million
2001
   
%
Change









Turnover 4 215     4 299     (2
)%
Operating profit 390     308     27
%









Group turnover 4 064     4 150     (2 )%
Group operating profit 354     267     33 %









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

 
million
2002
   
€ million
2001
   
%
Change









Turnover 4 467   4 299     4 %









Operating profit BEIA 654     572     14 %
Exceptional items (111 )   (128 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles  (127 )    (136
)
       









Operating profit 416     308     35 %









Operating margin 9.3 %   7.2 %      
Operating margin BEIA 14.7 %   13.3 %      









Turnover increased by 4% and operating margin BEIA improved by 1.4% to 14.7%, through the benefits of our savings programmes and the exit from less profitable tea businesses in India.

Health & wellness
In 2002, we continued to meet the growing consumer demand for healthy food products, in both industrialised and developing markets.

New additions to the SlimFast range helped consumers to manage their weight healthily with food that fits into their daily lives.SlimFast sales grew 10.8%, with a range extending from meal replacement drinks and bars to soups. It continued to expand beyond its US heartland, in the UK, Germany and the Netherlands. SlimFast continues to focus

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002

on the health & wellness consumer hotspot and is well positioned in relation to emerging concerns about obesity.

AdeS, our nutritious, healthy drink continued to grow strongly in Brazil, while we expanded Telma, a cereal brand from Israel, into snacking with the launch of childrens cereal bars.

Beverages
Lipton grew by 3.8% with sales in more than 100 countries. The Lipton product range is inspired by the healthy, refreshing qualities of tea and includes ready-to-drink Lipton Ice Tea, new concepts such as Lipton Brisk lemonade and a wide range of leaf tea offerings.

Ready-to-drink beverages continue to perform strongly. In leaf tea, an area which is critical for the overall health of our beverage business, we continued to focus on improving profitability and innovation. We continued to drive growth around the world through our LiptonPaint the World Yellow campaign. This enabled us to position Lipton as a contemporary brand and to perform strongly in the growing out-of-home sector. As around a third of beverages are consumed outside the home, this sector is important for continued growth.

We maintained leadership positions in key traditional tea markets such as the UK and India.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

 
million
2001
   
million
2000
   
%
Change









Turnover 4 299     3 625     19
%
Operating profit 308     419     (27
)%









Group turnover 4 150     3 430     21
%
Group operating profit 267     391     (32
)%









2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

 
million
2001
   
million
2000
   
%
Change









Turnover 4 367     3 626     20 %









Operating profit BEIA 578     442     31 %
Exceptional items (131 )   (18 )      
Amortisation of goodwill                
and intangibles (133 )   (3 )      









Operating profit 314     421     (25 )%









Operating margin 7.2 %   11.6 %      
Operating margin BEIA 13.2 %   12.2 %      









Health & wellness
Consumers are increasingly demanding healthy food products. In 2001, our brands grew by meeting such needs, in both industrialised and developing markets.

 



Back to Contents

28 Operating review by category Foods

 

The US-based SlimFast range, which we market as a nutritionally responsible way to achieve and maintain a healthy weight, delivered excellent growth. We successfully extended the brand beyond its US heartland, with launches in Australia and the Netherlands and relaunches in Canada and the UK. We also extended the range into soups.

A profitable year for Annapurna in India and a successful African roll-out from Ghana to Cote dIvoire showed how we can meet a very different consumer need: for nutritionally-enhanced staples at an affordable price. Sales of AdeS soy-based beverages in Latin America were hit, however, by the economic difficulties in the region.

Beverages
Our Lipton global core brand grew by 6%, led by double-digit growth in ready-to-drink tea delivering a system salesgrowth of 10% worldwide. This growth was again boosted by our innovative Paint the World Yellow programme.

In Japan, underlying sales of Lipton ready-to-drink tea grew strongly due to our partnership with drinks manufacturer Suntory. Our recent innovation, Lipton Cold Brew cold infusion teabags, grew well and was rolled out across most of the US. However, turnover and profits declined in that country.

The traditional tea market in Central Asia declined in value. Fierce competition from loose-leaf tea competitors in India made our beverage sales decline, but a major cost effectiveness drive resulted in higher profits. In Poland and Russia, underlying sales showed double-digit growth as we continued to drive the consumer migration from loose-leaf to tea bags.

Turnover grew by 20%. Operating profit BEIA and operating margin BEIA increased due to significant savings in supply chain costs.

 

Ice cream and frozen foods

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

 
million
2002
   
million
2001
   
%
Change









Turnover 7 456     7 727     (4
)%
Operating profit 616     446     38
%









Group turnover 7 456     7 727     (4
)%
Group operating profit 616     446     38
%









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

 
million
2002
   
million
2001
   
%
Change









Turnover 7 646 7 727   (1
)%









Operating profit BEIA 896     797     12
%
Exceptional items (244 )   (322 )      
Amortisation of goodwill                
and intangibles (28 )   (29 )      









Operating profit 624     446     40
%









Operating margin 8.2 %   5.8 %      
Operating margin BEIA 11.7 %   10.3 %      









Underlying sales growth for the year was 3%, but after the impact of disposals, turnover fell 1%. Operating margin BEIA improved 1.4% to 11.7% after restructuring gains and higher brand investment.

Ice cream
Unilever is the world’s leading producer of ice cream. In 2002, innovations under the Heart brand, including Cornetto Soft, Magnum 7 Sins, and others under Paddle Pop and Carte d’Or, delivered strong growth as they gave a new twist to a traditional favourite. North American ice cream brands Breyers and Ben & Jerry’s also delivered good results.

 


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002

Back to Contents

Operating review by category Foods
29

 

Report of the Directors

 

We are determined to remain the worlds number one ice cream company. We have transformed the cost structure of the business and focused on profitable countries and are now able to concentrate on innovation and growth. For example, we took brands like Cornetto out of the static freezer box and into the growing soft-serve out-of-home sector, while continuing to target the in-home sector with innovations such as mini multi-packs and Cornetto snack-size ice cream, both of which made good progress.

We continued to widen the appeal of our ice creams to consumers who want fun, novelty and freshness. For example, we targeted consumers desire for indulgence (Magnum), refreshment (Solero) and kids fun (Paddle Pop).

We made good progress in Latin America and North America and, in the context of a poor summer, performed well in Europe.

In October 2002, the European Court of First Instance heard our appeal against the European Commissions negative decision in the matter of cabinet exclusivity in Ireland. That decision remains suspended, while we await the ruling of the Court.

Frozen foods
Convenience combined with fresh-tasting, high quality ingredients drove the success of our Iglo, Birds Eye and Findus frozen ready meal solutions, which grew by 11%. Our overall frozen foods turnover fell by 8%, primarily due to disposals. A strong fourth quarter driven by quality innovations and brand support resulted in an underlying sales growth of 1% for the year.

Sales growth in ready meals was offset by the implications of the end of the BSE crisis, which last year drove stronger demand for fish, especially in the UK. Our frozen foods capability is a valuable asset across the portfolio, which we are now starting to test with other brands.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

 
million
2001
   
million
2000
   
%
Change









Turnover 7 727     7 869     (2
)%
Operating profit 446     227     97
%





Group turnover 7 727     7 848     (2
)%
Group operating profit 446     225     98
%









2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

 
million
2001
   
million
2000
   
%
Change









Turnover 7 748     7 866     (2
)%









Operating profit BEIA 800     637     26
%
Exceptional items (331 )   (394 )      
Amortisation of goodwill                
and intangibles (29 )   (17 )      









Operating profit 440     226     95
%









Operating margin 5.7 %   2.9 %      
Operating margin BEIA 10.3 %   8.1 %      









Ice cream
Our major ice cream brands performed well during 2001 and underlying sales grew by almost 3%. Progress was driven by innovations, such as Magnum snack-sizes, Cornetto miniature and multi-packs and Cornetto-branded soft ice cream.

A positive overall picture was affected by declining wrapped impulse sales in Germany and the UK. In North America our Canadian and US businesses delivered excellent underlying sales growth and much improved profits. The strength of our portfolio was demonstrated by the success of Ben & Jerrys in the US super-premium market during its first full year as a Unilever business.

In line with our commitment to a world-class supply chain, we closed eight factories that were of limited long-term value and introduced more efficient ways of buying raw materials and packaging. We also eliminated certain poorly performing products and withdrew from nine countries where our ice cream business was unprofitable, including Colombia, Russia and Saudi Arabia.

 


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002

Back to Contents

 

30 Operating review by category Foods

 

Frozen foods
Our ongoing businesses in frozen foods achieved good profitable growth due to innovation and tight business focus.

The key growth drivers were products that met the demand for healthy and convenient foods. We successfully rolled out frozen high-quality meal ranges based on the Italian concept 4 Salti in Padella, including Birds Eye enjoy! in the UK. Our frozen snacks also performed well.

In 2001, we began successfully extending frozen food brands and products into our Foodsolutions business.

We disposed of our Gortons frozen seafood business in North America and the Frudesa business in Spain, but retained limited rights to use the Frudesa brand name. We also withdrew from frozen foods in Argentina.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002

 



Back to Contents

Operating review by category Home & Personal Care
31

Report of the Directors


Financial overview

  billion   billion   billion   %  
2002 at 2002 at 2001 at Change at
2002 2001 2001 2001
rates rates rates rates*












Turnover 20.8     22.7     22.8     0%  












Operating profit 2.8     3.1     2.8     8%  












Operating profit BEIA 3.2     3.5     3.1     11%  












Operating margin* 13.5%     13.5%     12.4%        
Operating margin BEIA* 15.3%     15.2%     13.6%        












*   Calculated using unrounded numbers

Home & Personal Care
In 2002, we continued to focus resources behind the leading brands that are driving growth in our Home & Personal Care (HPC) division. They grew rapidly by meeting the differing everyday needs of people around the world.

In line with our Path to Growth strategy, these leading brands surged ahead with sales growth of 6.7%, while underlying sales increased by 5.2%. Turnover was flat, including the disposal of DiverseyLever. Operating profit BEIA rose by 11% and operating margin BEIA reached 15.2%.

Our global brand teams, who are responsible for major innovations, ensured focus and delivery in every region, with support from our new network of Global Technology Centres. Critical to this success was our continued research and development focus on fewer, global projects. For example, new innovations helped Dove achieve over 25% growth for the fourth successive year, led by the roll-out of the Dove hair range.

We continued to dispose of our non-core businesses, including the completion of the sale of DiverseyLever, our institutional and industrial cleaning business, and Atkinsons, our Italian fragrance and personal care business.

Home care and professional cleaning

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 8 579     10 467     (18)%  
Operating profit 754     667     13%  









Group turnover 8 565     10 432     (18)%  
Group operating profit 755     666     13%  









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 9 436     10 467     (10)%  









Operating profit BEIA 1 027     886     16%  
Exceptional items (200 )   (201 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (17 )   (18 )      









Operating profit 810     667     21%  









Operating margin 8.6%     6.4%        
Operating margin BEIA 10.9%     8.5%        









Unilever is among the world leaders in domestic home care, which includes hygiene and cleaning products. In 2002, underlying sales grew by 1% and operating margin BEIA improved by 2.4%, through the benefit of our savings programmes. Growth was driven by Looks Great, Snuggle and Comfort.

Although people wash their fabrics in many different ways they all want to achieve cleaner, stain-free, fresh feeling clothes and linen, with less effort.

Around the world, we repositioned Omo, our top performance washing detergent, as a brand for mothers and their families. This strategy was driven by the message that getting dirty is all part of the experience children need to learn and develop. It helped to consolidate Omos leading



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

32 Operating review by category Home & Personal Care

position in Brazil and South Africa and to achieve market share gains in such countries as Morocco and Thailand.

In Morocco, Omo overtook its rivals to become the market leader. In Thailand, new innovations helped the brand to extend its leadership, while in South Africa it maintained its strong leadership position in a growing market.

Consumers increasingly demand detergents that dont just clean their clothes but are also gentle on their skin. In the UK, we lead this growing kind to skin market with Persil Non-Bio. To reinforce our position in the sector we launched Persil Aloe Vera. This successfully introduced new customers to the brand. During 2002, Persil achieved its highest market share for 10 years.

On 3 May 2002 we completed the sale of our DiverseyLever business to Johnson Professional Holdings Inc., leading to a 10% reduction in turnover, despite underlying sales growth of 1%.

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 10 467     10 284     2%  
Operating profit 667     578     15%  









Group turnover 10 432     10 258     2%  
Group operating profit 666     578     15%  









2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 10 884     10 284     6%  









Operating profit BEIA 926     917     1%  
Exceptional items (209 )   (323 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (19 )   (16 )      









Operating profit 698     578     21%  









Operating margin 6.4%     5.6%        
Operating margin BEIA 8.5%     8.9%        









In 2001, turnover rose by 6%, however, operating margin BEIA was slightly down.

Laundry products generated nearly a third of the divisions income. In 2001, we retained our clear leadership in tablets in Europe, however, in Canada and the US, tablets showed slow consumer uptake.

Building on the success of tablets in Europe, we launched liquid capsules. These provide the convenience and efficiency of laundry tablets for those consumers who prefer to use liquid detergents.

We demonstrated the enduring appeal of our laundry brands in South Latin America, emerging after two years of intense competition with significantly improved profitability.

We made significant progress in aligning all laundry detergent and fabric conditioners behind a limited number of our leading brands, such as Omo, Skip, Surf, Comfort and Snuggle. We rolled out standardised Omo packaging and advertising in Latin America, Asia and Pacific, Africa, Middle East and Turkey. In India, as part of this alignment, we relaunched the popular Surf brand, investing in an improved formulation and doubling marketing support.

We extended the Comfort fabric conditioner brand with the successful launch of Comfort Vaporesse in Europe. Comfort Vaporesse liquid is poured into the water wells of steam irons, making fabrics smell fresher and preventing limescale.

We extended the Domestos brand, launching Domestos Bi-Actif and Domestos WC Active Mousse in Europe and, in Asia, reaching new consumers with products tailored for low-income families. Other successes in household cleaning included further innovations in Cif wipes.

In professional cleaning, DiverseyLever enjoyed a strong year with growth in both turnover and operating profit.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Operating review by category Home & Personal Care
33

Report of the Directors


Personal care

2002 results compared with 2001 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 12 245     12 310     (1)%  
Operating profit 2 062     2 159     (4)%  









Group turnover 12 236     12 307     (1)%  
Group operating profit 2 059     2 157     (5)%  









2002 results compared with 2001 at constant 2001 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2002 2001 Change









Turnover 13 273     12 310     8%  









Operating profit BEIA 2 430     2 219     10%  
Exceptional items (166 )   (49 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (12 )   (11 )      









Operating profit 2 252     2 159     4%  









Operating margin 17.0%     17.5%        
Operating margin BEIA 18.3%     18.0%        









In the personal care sector, Unilever is one of the world leaders in deodorants, anti-perspirants and hair care products. Our leading brands, which include Axe, Dove, Lux, Ponds, Rexona, Signal and Sunsilk saw underlying sales growth of 10%. Turnover rose by 8%, with operating margin BEIA increasing to 18.3%.

From New York to New Delhi, image and beauty are important to millions of people. To meet their desire for attractive, healthy hair we continued to focus on Dove and Sunsilk.

The Dove hair range reached the number one position in its initial launch market of Korea and Taiwan and number two in Japan, where it was launched in 2001. During the year, we rolled out Dove shampoo and conditioners across more than 31 countries in Europe, Latin America and South East Asia.

In 2002, the underlying sales growth of Sunsilk was strong with good performances in Brazil and Mexico and new market entries in Algeria and Central America. In Ghana and South Africa we launched our new Afro Hair range. We further drove Sunsilks growth with the launch of new products, such as permanent colourant Pro-Color in Brazil and Argentina.

In Canada, we are migrating Pears to the highly successful North American brand Suave.

Washing away the everyday grime that builds up on skin is a daily ritual for countless people. In Brazil, although around 70 million consumers have black or mulatto skin, there had never been a mass-market soap specially designed for them. To meet their aspirations we launched a Lux variant specifically for this skin type.

Consumers want to feel clean and fresh all day, however hectic their lifestyles. This desire helped to drive growth in our deodorant business.

In 2002, the underlying sales growth of Axe was 17%, driven by powerful innovation in the core body spray range, including the launch of a new longer lasting 24-hour formulation. We launched Axe in North America with a campaign targeting young men between 14 and 24 a group that spends around $8 billion a year on personal grooming products.

Rexona enjoyed strong growth with the best performance coming from our anti-perspirant deodorant for men. Rexona for Men grew by 30% in the core regions of Europe and Latin America.

A clean, bright smile can say more than words, whatever language you speak. In 2002, we sought to reinforce the strength of our Signal brand through a strong competitive position in the electric toothbrush market. We launched the first electric toothbrush to offer the choice of two heads for cleaning and whitening.

Across the Home & Personal Care business our strong focus on leading brands and global innovations has left us well placed for further growth.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

34 Operating review by category Home & Personal Care

2001 results compared with 2000 at current exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 12 310     12 589     (2)%  
Operating profit 2 159     837     158%  









Group turnover 12 307     12 567     (2)%  
Group operating profit 2 157     837     158%  









2001 results compared with 2000 at constant 2000 exchange rates

  million     million     %  
2001 2000 Change









Turnover 12 685     12 589     1%  









Operating profit BEIA 2 298     2 034     13%  
Exceptional items (50 )   (1 190 )      
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (11 )   (7 )      









Operating profit 2 237     837     167%  









Operating margin 17.6%     6.7%        
Operating margin BEIA 18.1%     16.2%        









Personal care
Turnover increased by 1%, while operating margin BEIA improved. Our leading brands achieved sales growth of 7%, reflecting the strong performance of our global core brands, such as Axe, Dove, Rexona, Suave and Sunsilk.

Dove again surged ahead. It recorded its third consecutive year of over 25% growth with strong contributions from the new Nutrium bar in the US and shower and body care products in Europe. Another notable success was the brands move into hair care in Asia, where it reached number three in the Japanese shampoo and conditioner market within two months and contributed towards a 12% worldwide growth in our hair care business. The launch projected Unilever into a clear number one position in Japan, the second largest hair care market, with Lux, mods hair and Dove.

Sunsilk, our leading hair care brand, also performed strongly, growing in excess of 20%. It was launched in Mexico, marketed as Sedal, and rapidly became the fourth biggest hair care brand in the country. In the US, Suave captured an 11% value share of the shampoo market for the first time.

Our deodorant category grew by 8%, driven by the success of Dove, Axe and Rexona. Dove consolidated its position in deodorants with a particularly strong performance in the US and an encouraging launch in Mexico.

We refreshed the Axe male deodorant range, marketed as Lynx in the UK, with two new fragrances, Fusion and Gravity. In Europe, as part of our strategy of extending our brands beyond their core categories, we introduced an upgraded Axe shower gel range.

Rexona also made significant progress in the male anti-perspirant market, with Rexona for Men accounting for a growing proportion of the brands sales.

We introduced harmonised packaging for our roll-on deodorants across all brands, achieving significant efficiencies in our supply chain.

In face care, Ponds Perfect was launched in Japan and achieved a leading position in the mass sector of the anti-ageing market, while the launch of Ponds RenAscent achieved outstanding success in Mexico.

In Central Asia, Fair and Lovely continued to perform strongly, responding to renewed advertising focus and range extensions.

In oral care, we again saw good growth from Signal in Europe and Close-up in Asia and Pacific. Our position was strengthened by innovations in toothbrushes and confectionery, where we built on the success of our dental chewing gum with the launch of dental sweets. However, in China, Zhonghua toothpaste had a disappointing year.

Our Prestige fragrance business faced difficult economic conditions, and turnover declined. Following the disposal of Elizabeth Arden, we integrated the designer fragrance portfolio into Unilever Cosmetics International. We expanded the Nautica fragrance range into Europe and launched fragrances under the BCBG banner in the US.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Financial review
35

 

Report of the Directors

 

The figures quoted in this review are in euros, at current rates of exchange, unless otherwise stated. The profit and loss and cashflow information is translated at average rates of exchange for the relevant year and the balance sheet information at year-end rates of exchange.

For definitions of key ratios referred to in this review please refer to page 115.

Critical accounting policies
The accounts comply in all material respects with UK generally accepted accounting principles and Netherlands law. To prepare the accounts, we are required to make estimates and assumptions, using judgement based on available information, including historical experience. These estimates and assumptions are reasonable and are re-evaluated on an ongoing basis. However, actual amounts and results could differ. Critical accounting policies are those which are most important to the portrayal of Unilevers financial position and results of operations, and are described on pages 66 to 68. Unilever complies with UK Financial Reporting Standard 18, which requires that the most appropriate accounting policies are selected in all circumstances. Some of these policies require difficult, subjective or complex judgements from management, the most important being:

Retirement benefits:
Determining Unilevers pension assets, obligations and expenses depends on certain assumptions used by actuaries in calculating such amounts. Those assumptions are described in note 17 on page 88. Although the assumptions are thought to be appropriate, significant differences in actual experience or significant changes in assumptions may materially affect pension assets and obligations and future expenses.

Provisions:
Provision is made, amongst other reasons, for environmental and legal matters where a legal or constructive obligation exists at the balance sheet date and a reasonable estimate can be made of the likely outcome.

Market support costs:
Expenditure on market support costs, such as consumer promotions and trade advertising, is charged against profit in the year in which it is incurred. At each balance sheet date, we estimate the degree of expenditure incurred based on our knowledge of customer, consumer and promotional activity.

Goodwill, intangible and tangible fixed assets:
Following UK Financial Reporting Standard 11, United States SFAS 142 and SFAS 144, goodwill, intangible and tangible fixed assets are subject to review for impairment. Such reviews are performed by comparing the carrying value of the asset concerned to a valuation derived from discounted future cashflows. Significant assumptions are made in preparing these forecast cashflows; although these are believed to be appropriate, changes in these assumptions could change the outcomes of the impairment reviews.

The most significant goodwill is that arising from the purchase of Bestfoods. We have reviewed the goodwill related to the Bestfoods acquisition, by considering actual and planned growth rates of Bestfoods brands and the actual and planned synergy savings arising from its integration. No impairment loss has been identified.

Deferred tax:
Full provision is made for deferred taxation, as required under UK Financial Reporting Standard 19, at the rates of tax prevailing at the year-end unless future rates have been enacted, as detailed on page 68. Deferred tax assets are regularly reviewed for recoverability, and a valuation allowance is established to the extent recoverability is not considered likely.

Results 2002 compared with 2001

The 7% strengthening of the average exchange rate for the euro against the basket of Unilever currencies impacted turnover, which fell by 7% to 48 760 million. Underlying sales growth of 4% was offset by the net impacts of acquisitions and disposals which reduced sales by 4%. The most significant disposal impact came from DiverseyLever and Mazola, offset by the increase in our holding in the Unilever Bestfoods Robertsons business in Africa and the Middle East.

Group turnover, excluding our share of the turnover of joint ventures, fell by 6% to48 270 million. Our share of turnover from joint ventures fell to 490 million (2001:692 million) as the increase in our holding in Unilever Bestfoods Robertsons resulted in its reclassification as a subsidiary.

Operating profit BEIA was 7 260 million (2001: 7 269 million). Operating margin BEIA improved to 14.9% from 13.9% in 2001. This underlying margin improvement reflects the continuing contribution from our Path to Growth strategy; it was offset by the strengthening of the euro leaving operating profit BEIA in line with 2001. Group operating profit BEIA was also flat at7 165 million.

Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles was €1 261 million for the year, down from €1 423 million in 2001.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

36 Financial review

 

The decrease is primarily due to the strengthening of the euro during the year. Included in the charge is  1 023 million in respect of Bestfoods.

Exceptional items for the year of €874 million included €1 215 million of restructuring costs, a credit of €249 million for the net profits and losses on business disposals and €98 million credit from the release of legal and environmental provisions following the settlement of certain legal claims in our favour. Associated costs included within operating profit BEIA were191 million for the year (2001: 373 million).

The exceptional costs incurred during the year primarily relate to the Path to Growth initiatives announced in February 2000, and to the integration of Bestfoods. The total net cost of these programmes over 5 years is estimated to be 6.2 billion. Of the 5.0 billion incurred to date, €4.3 billion is exceptional and 0.7 billion is associated costs.

Operating profit and Group operating profit each fell by 3% to 5 125 million and 5 041 million respectively, with the underlying margin improvement offset by higher exceptional charges and the 7% average currency impact.

An overview of operating performance by region and product category is included in the Regional and Category texts on pages 18 to 23 and 24 to 34 respectively.

Net interest cost for the year was €473 million lower at €1 173 million as we benefited from strong cashflow from operations, the proceeds of business disposals, lower interest rates and the favourable effect of currency movements. Net interest cover for the year was 4.5 times, up from 3.2 times in 2001. The net interest cover on the basis of EBITDA (BEI) was 7 times (2001: 5 times).

The Groups effective tax rate on profit for the year was 38.7% (2001: 42.7%). This rate reflects the non-deductibility of the Bestfoods goodwill amortisation and a lower effective tax rate on net exceptional items. The underlying tax rate on normal operations for the year was 32.2% (2001: 33.7%).

Minority interests increased to312 million (2001: 239 million), mainly as a result of a fiscal policy change affecting local shareholders in India.

Net profit for the year rose by 16% to 2 129 million; combined earnings per share were up 18%; combined earnings per share BEIA increased by 14%.

Return on capital employed increased to 11% from 9% in 2001.

Results 2001 compared with 2000
Turnover rose by 9% to52 206 million.

Group turnover increased by 8% to 51 514 million. This increase was driven by underlying sales growth of 4%, compared with 1.5% in 2000, combined with a net effect from acquisitions and disposals of an increase of 7%. The most significant of these were the acquisition of Bestfoods and the disposal of Elizabeth Arden and some European soups and sauces brands. This growth was offset by a 3% strengthening of the average exchange rate for the euro against the basket of Unilever currencies.

As a result of the Bestfoods acquisition, the Groups share of joint venture turnover increased by 43% to 692 million.

Group operating profit BEIA of 7 149 million increased by 25% for the year. The improvement in group operating margin BEIA by 1.9% to 13.9% reflected the ongoing contribution from Path to Growth restructuring and procurement savings and the successful integration of Bestfoods.

Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles was1 387 million compared with 435 million in 2000. The increase was primarily the result of a full years amortisation charge for acquisitions made partway through 2000. Included in this charge was1 170 million for Bestfoods and 193 million as a result of other acquisitions in 2000, principally SlimFast, Ben & Jerrys, Cressida and Amora Maille.

Exceptional items for the year were588 million, which included1 515 million of restructuring investment and profits on disposals of927 million. Of the latter, 811 million related to the profit on the sale of the brands to secure regulatory approval for our acquisition of Bestfoods and 114 million related to profit on the sale of Unipath. Associated costs included within operating profit BEIA were373 million in 2001.

Group operating profit increased by 63% to 5 174 million, primarily being the net impact of acquisitions and disposals offset by an increase in the amortisation charge.

The share of operating profit of joint ventures increased to 84 million (2000: 57 million), reflecting a full year of the Bestfoods joint ventures.

Net interest cost rose to1 646 million compared with 632 million in 2000. This reflected the increase in the level of borrowings during 2000 to fund acquisitions, principally Bestfoods. Cash generation from disposals during the year, along with proceeds from the sale of the European bakery business in 2000, reduced the interest charge by approximately 80 million. Net interest cover for the year was just over 3 times. The net interest cover on the basis of EBITDA (BEI) was 5 times for the year.

The Groups effective tax rate for the year was 42.7% (2000: 49.3%). This rate reflected the non-deductibility of


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Financial review
37

 

Report of the Directors

 

goodwill amortisation and a tax rate on the net exceptional charges of 39%. The underlying tax rate for normal trading operations was in line with 2000.

Minority interests increased 11% to 239 million (2000:215 million) as a result of a strong performance in India.

Net profit rose by 66% to1 838 million. Combined earnings per share were up 70%. Combined earnings per share BEIA increased by 11%.

Return on capital employed increased slightly to 9% from 8% in 2000.

2002

Dividends and market capitalisation
Ordinary dividends paid and proposed on PLC ordinary capital amounted to 16.04p per 1.4p share (2001:14.54p), an increase of 10% per share. Ordinary dividends paid and proposed on the NV ordinary capital amount to €1.70 per €0.51 share (2001: €1.56), an increase of 9% per share. The ratio of dividends to profit attributable to ordinary shareholders was 79.5% (2001: 85.6%).

Unilevers combined market capitalisation at 31 December 2002 was 59.9 billion (2001: 64.5 billion).

Balance sheet
The euro strengthened considerably against most other Unilever currencies between the two balance sheet dates. This resulted in an exchange loss on translation of opening balances and of movements of1 517 million. Significant translation losses in Argentina and Brazil were partly offset by the translation gain on the highly geared balance sheet of our US business. Profit retained, after accounting for dividends, the writeback of goodwill on disposal of DiverseyLever and for the retranslation impact, decreased by 640 million to5 777 million.

Total capital and reserves decreased to 5 867 million (2001:6 993 million) reflecting the above movements in profit retained together with a551 million net increase in shares held to meet employee share option plans.

Cashflow
Cashflow from operations increased by386 million to 7 883 million. Strong underlying cashflows and working capital improvements were partly offset by higher restructuring outflows, and the impact of the strengthening of the euro on the consolidated figures.

Capital expenditure of1 313 million was 15% below 2001 levels and at 2.7% of turnover continues the reducing trend of recent years.

Acquisition activity in the year was limited. The most significant transaction was the purchase of an additional 9% share in the Bestfoods Robertsons businesses in Africa and the Middle East. During the year cash proceeds of

 

1 834 million were received from the disposal of 35 businesses, notably DiverseyLever and Mazola.

Finance and liquidity
Unilever aims to be in the top third of a reference group for Total Shareholder Return of 21 international consumer goods companies, as explained on pages 40 and 41. The Groups financial strategy supports this objective and provides the financial flexibility to meet its strategic and day-to-day needs. The key elements of the financial strategy are:

   Appropriate access to equity and debt capital
   Sufficient flexibility for tactical acquisitions
   A1/P1 short-term credit rating
   Sufficient resilience against economic turmoil
   Optimal weighted average cost of capital, given the constraints above

An EBITDA (BEI) net interest cover greater than 8 times is consistent with this strategy. An interest cover below this level is acceptable for a period following major acquisitions.

The definition and further details on the EBITDA (BEI) net interest cover ratio are given on pages 114 and 115.

Other relevant disclosures are given in notes 14 and 15 on pages 83 to 86.

Unilever concentrates cash in the parent and finance companies in order to ensure maximum flexibility in meeting changing business needs. Operating subsidiaries are financed through the mix of retained earnings, third party borrowings and loans from parent and group financing companies that is most appropriate to the particular country and business concerned.

Unilever maintains access to global debt markets through an infrastructure of short-term debt programmes (principally US domestic and euro commercial paper programmes) and long-term debt programmes (principally a US Shelf registration and euro-market Debt Issuance Programme). Debt in the international markets is, in general, issued in the name of NV, PLC or Unilever Capital Corporation. NV and PLC will normally guarantee such debt where they are not the issuer.

Unilever has committed credit facilities in place to support its commercial paper programmes and for general corporate purposes. The committed credit facilities in place at the end of 2002 were: bilateral committed credit facilities of in aggregate US $3 737 million, bilateral notes commitments of in aggregate US $400 million and bilateral money market commitments of in aggregate US $2 080 million. Further details of these facilities are given in note 14 on page 84.

In 2002 a total of €3 195 million was raised through term financing. The term financing mainly consisted of a US $650 million 51/2 year eurobond issued in June, a €1 billion 5-year eurobond issued in September and a US $1 billion 30-year Global Bond issued in November. In addition Unilever Thai Trading Limited (UTT) raised the


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

38 Financial review

 

equivalent of418 million of term financing in the Thai capital market, all of which carried a Unilever NV guarantee excluding political risk, through a combination of bank loans and the issuance of a debenture with a 5-year maturity.

During 2002, net debt decreased to 16 966 million (2001: 23 199 million). This was due to strong operating cash flow, the proceeds of business disposals and the favourable effect of currency movements.

Borrowings at the end of 2002 totalled20 444 million (2001:25 500 million). Taking into account the various cross currency swaps and other derivatives, 78% of Unilevers borrowings were in US dollars, 1% in euros and 7% in sterling with the remainder spread over a large number of other currencies.

Long-term borrowings decreased by €3 288 million to €10 933 million at the end of 2002. At the end of 2002 short-term borrowings were €9 511 million (2001: €11 279 million), including €4 854 million of long-term debt coming to within a year of maturity at the year-end. At the end of 2002, 68% of the long-term debt is repayable within five years (2001: 77%).

Unilevers contractual obligations at the end of 2002 include capital expenditure commitments, borrowings, operating lease commitments and other commitments. Details are set out in the following notes to the accounts: note 10 on page 81, note 14 on page 83, and note 24 on page 99. Details on derivatives are given in note 15 on pages 85 and 86.

Cash and current investments at the end of 2002 totalled 3 478 million (2001: 2 301 million); these funds were held in euros (34%), sterling (4%), US dollars (14%), and other currencies (48%). The funds are mainly to support day-to-day needs and are predominantly invested in short-term bank deposits and high-grade marketable securities.

Treasury and hedging policies
Unilever Treasurys strategic purpose is to provide financial flexibility in support of Unilevers Path to Growth strategy within the context of the financial strategy set out in the Finance and liquidity section above. Unilever Treasurys role is to ensure that appropriate financing is always available for all value-creating investments. Additionally, Treasury delivers financial services to allow operating companies to manage their financial transactions and exposures in an efficient, timely and low cost manner.

Unilever Treasury operates as a service centre and is governed by policies and plans agreed by the Executive Committee of the Board. In addition to policies, guidelines and exposure limits, a system of authorities and extensive independent reporting covers all major areas of activity. Performance is monitored closely. Reviews are undertaken by the corporate internal audit function.

The key financial instruments used by Unilever are short- and long-term borrowings, cash and other fixed and current investments and certain straightforward derivative instruments, principally comprising interest rate swaps and foreign exchange contracts. The accounting for derivative instruments is discussed in Accounting policies on page 68. The use of leveraged instruments is not permitted.

Unilever Treasury manages a variety of market risks, including the effects of changes in foreign exchange rates, interest rates and credit spreads. Other risks managed include liquidity, country and counterparty risks.

Unilever has an interest rate management policy aimed at optimising net interest cost and reducing volatility. This is achieved by modifying the interest rate exposure of debt and cash positions through the use of interest rate swaps. At the 2002 year-end the application of this policy resulted in approximately 80% of our projected net debt for 2003 and 47% for 2004 being fixed.

Unilevers foreign exchange policy requires that operating companies hedge trading and financial foreign exchange exposures. This is achieved primarily through the use of forward foreign exchange contracts. Some flexibility is permitted within overall exposure limits. At year-end there was no material exposure from companies holding assets and liabilities other than in their functional currency.

Unilever aims to hedge its net investment in operating companies through borrowings in the same currency, except where inhibited by local regulations, lack of local liquidity or local market conditions. An exception may also be made where the economic value of the net assets locally is considered to exceed their book value substantially. The business in the US is one such example where the economic value of the assets is considerably in excess of book value and accordingly we have higher US dollar debt. From time to time, currency revaluations will trigger exchange translation movements in our balance sheet as a result of these exceptions.

In 2002, we suffered significant retranslation differences as a result of the devaluations in Brazil (1 106 million) and Argentina (502 million), partly offset by the effect of the weakening of the US dollar. The above figures reflect the effect exchange rate movements have on the book values of assets and liabilities but do not take into account the underlying value of our assets or future earnings potential in the countries involved.

Our policies and strategies for the management of liquidity risk are discussed in more detail on pages 37 and above.

Counterparty exposures are minimised by restricting dealing counterparties to a limited number of financial institutions that have secure credit ratings, by working within agreed counterparty limits and by setting limits on the maturity of exposures. Counterparty credit ratings are closely monitored and concentration of credit risk with any single counterparty


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Financial review
39

 

Report of the Directors

is avoided. There was no significant concentration of credit risks with any single counterparty as at the year-end.

As a result of hedging the share option plans for employees, we are exposed to movements in our own share price. In recent years we have hedged this risk through buying Unilever shares in the market when the share option is granted and holding these shares until the share option is exercised or lapses. In 2001 we also entered into a contract with a bank for the forward purchase of Unilever shares, further details of which are given in note 15 on page 86. At the year-end 92% of all outstanding employee share options were hedged; based on Unilevers experience with the exercise level of options we consider this percentage as being fully hedged.

Risk management
The following discussion about risk management activities includes forward-looking statements that involve risk and uncertainties. The actual results could differ materially from those projected. See the Cautionary Statement on page 2.

The analysis below presents the sensitivity of the fair value of the financial and derivative instruments the Group held at 31 December 2002, to the hypothetical changes described below.

Interest rate risk
The fair values of debt, investments and related hedging instruments are affected by movements in interest rates. The analysis shows the sensitivity of the fair value of interest rate sensitive instruments to a hypothetical 10% change in the interest rates across all maturities as at 31 December 2002.

Foreign exchange rate risk
The fair values of debt, investments and hedging instruments, denominated in currencies other than the functional currency of the entities holding them, are subject to exchange rate movements. The analysis shows the sensitivity of these fair values to a hypothetical 10% change in foreign exchange rates as at 31 December 2002.

Fair value changes:

 
Sensitivity to a
hypothetical 10% change in
rates as at 31 December
 
 
million
million
 
2002
2001





Interest rate risk 298   243  
Foreign exchange rate risk 1   28  





Further details on derivatives, foreign exchange exposures and other related information on financial instruments are given in note 15 on pages 85 and 86.

Supply risk and commodities contracts
Unilevers products are manufactured from a number of raw materials. While materials are expected to be in adequate supply, any shortages or disruptions in supply would have a material adverse effect on gross margin.

 

Some of our businesses, principally edible fats companies in Europe, may use forward contracts over a number of oils to hedge future requirements. We purchase forward contracts in bean, rape, sunflower, palm, coconut and palm kernel oils, almost always for physical delivery. We may also use futures contracts to hedge future price movements; however, the amounts are not material. The total value of open forward contracts at the end of 2002 was 417 million compared with292 million in 2001.

In addition, our plantations businesses may use forward contracts for physical delivery of palm oil and tea under strictly controlled policies and exposure limits. We had no material outstanding contracts at the end of 2002.

Distribution
Unilevers products are generally sold through its sales force and through independent brokers, agents and distributors to chain, wholesale, co-operative and independent grocery accounts, food service distributors and institutions. Products are distributed through distribution centres, satellite warehouses, company-operated and public storage facilities, depots and other facilities.

Unilever has undertaken several initiatives to work with its customers to accelerate the development of product categories, to optimise the flow of merchandise and the inventory levels of its customers. These include efficient consumer response (ECR) to achieve optimal stock management, automatic stock replenishments and just-in-time delivery using electronic data interchange (EDI) to co-ordinate stock levels in stores and at Unilevers warehouses. ECR is also a process used by Unilever and retailers to understand, and deliver against, consumer demand and expectations.

Impact of price changes
Information concerning the impact of price changes on tangible fixed assets and depreciation is shown in note 10 on page 81.

Other risk factors
Particular risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to vary from those described in forward-looking statements within this document, or which could impact on our ability to meet our published targets under the Path to Growth strategy which consists of focusing resources on leading brands, closing manufacturing sites and re-organising or divesting under-performing businesses include those previously described above and the following:

   Managing restructuring and reorganisation programmes: Unilever has announced wide-ranging business restructuring initiatives. This high level of change absorbs considerable management time and can interrupt normal business operations.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

40 Financial review

 

  

Innovation:
Our growth depends in large part on our ability to generate and implement a stream of consumer-relevant improvements to our products. The contribution of innovation is affected by the level of funding that can be made available, the technical capability of the research and development functions, and the success of operating management in rolling out quickly the resulting improvements.

   
   Economic conditions in developing countries:
About a third of Unilevers sales come from the group of developing and emerging economies. These markets are also an important source of our growth. These economies are more volatile than those in the developed world, and there is a risk of downturns in effective consumer demand that would reduce the sales of our products.
   
   Borrowings:
The Group had borrowings totalling
20 444 million at the end of 2002. Any shortfalls in our cashflow commitments to service these borrowings could undermine our credit rating and overall investor confidence. Market, interest rate and foreign exchange risks to which the Group is exposed are described on page 39.
   
   Price volatility of raw materials:
Unilevers raw materials cover a wide range of agricultural and mineral products that are subject to movements in cyclical commodity prices. There may be times when increases in these prices cannot be recovered fully in selling prices due to competitor actions or weakness in effective consumer demand.
   
   Reputation:
Unilever has a good corporate reputation and many of our businesses, which operate in around 100 countries around the world, have a high pro
file in their region. Unilever products carrying our famous brand names are sold in over 150 countries. Should we fail to meet high product safety, social, environmental and ethical standards in all our operations and activities, Unilever's corporate reputation could be damaged, leading to the rejection of our products by consumers, devaluation of our brands and diversion of management time into rebuilding our reputation. Examples of initiatives to manage key social and environmental risks are mentioned on pages 11 and 12.
   
   Customer relationships:
Sales to large customers or sales via specialised distribution channels are signi
ficant in some of our businesses. The loss of a small number of major customers or a major disruption of a specialised distribution channel could have an adverse effect on the Groups business and results of operations.
   

 

   Developing our managers:
Unilever’s performance requires that it have the right calibre of managers in place. We must compete to obtain capable recruits for the business, and then train them in the skills and competencies that we need to deliver growth.
   
   Our brands:
A key element of our Path to Growth strategy is the development of a small number of global, leading brands. Any adverse event affecting consumer confidence or continuity of supply of such a brand would have an impact on the overall business.

In addition, as a multinational group, Unilevers businesses are exposed to varying degrees of risk and uncertainty related to other factors including competitive pricing, consumption levels, physical risks, legislative, fiscal, tax and regulatory developments, terrorism and economic, political and social conditions in the environments where we operate. All of these risks could materially affect the Groups business, our turnover, operating profit, net profit, net assets and liquidity. There may also be risks which are unknown to Unilever or which are currently believed to be immaterial.

Total Shareholder Return
Total Shareholder Return (TSR) is a concept used to compare the performance of different companies stocks and shares over time. It combines share price appreciation and dividends paid to show the total return to the shareholder. The absolute level of the TSR will vary with stock markets, but the relative position reflects the market perception of overall performance relative to a reference group.

The Company calculates TSR over a three-year rolling period. This period is sensitive enough to reflect changes but long enough to smooth out short-term volatility. The return is expressed in US dollars, based on the equivalent US dollar share price for NV and PLC. US dollars were chosen to facilitate comparison with companies in Unilevers chosen reference group.

Unilevers TSR target is to be in the top third of a reference group of 21 international consumer goods companies on a three year rolling basis.

At the end of 2001 we were positioned 15th and during 2002 we rose to 12th, outside our target position which remains the top third of our reference group. This position is influenced by the decline in the share price in the latter part of 1999. On a one year basis, our TSR has been in the top third of the reference group for each of the last two years.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Financial review
41

 

Report of the Directors

 

Unilevers position relative to the TSR reference group

In 2002 the following companies formed the peer group of comparative companies:

Avon Lion
Beiersdorf L’ Oréal
Cadbury Schweppes Nestlé
Clorox Orkla
Coca-Cola Pepsico
Colgate Philip Morris
Danone Procter & Gamble
Gillette Reckitt Benckiser
Heinz Sara Lee
Kao Shiseido

Significant changes
Any important developments and post-balance sheet events that have occurred since 31 December 2002 have been noted in this Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002. Otherwise, there have been no significant changes since the year end.

 


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

42 Corporate governance

 

Organisational structure of Unilever
NV and PLC are the two parent companies of the Unilever Group of companies. NV was incorporated under the name Naamlooze Vennootschap Margarine Unie in the Netherlands in 1927. PLC was incorporated under the name Lever Brothers Limited in Great Britain in 1894.

Since 1930 when the Unilever Group was formed, NV and PLC together with their group companies have operated, as nearly as is practicable, as a single entity. They have the same directors, adopt the same accounting principles, and are linked by a series of agreements. The Equalisation Agreement, which regulates the mutual rights of the two sets of shareholders, is particularly important. It makes the position of the shareholders of both companies, as far as possible, the same as if they held shares in a single company.

NV and PLC are separate companies, with separate stock exchange listings and different shareholders. You cannot convert or exchange the shares of one for shares of the other and the relative share prices on the various markets can, and do, fluctuate. This happens for a number of reasons, including changes in exchange rates. However, over time the prices of NV and PLC shares do stay in close relation to each other, in particular because of our equalisation arrangements.

NV and PLC are holding and service companies. Our businesses are carried out by our group companies around the world. The holding companies have agreed to co-operate in all areas, to exchange all relevant business information and to ensure all group companies act accordingly. Usually, shares in the group companies are held ultimately by either NV or PLC, with the main exception being that the US companies are owned by both and, as a result of the legal integration of Bestfoods into Unilever, a number of the group companies are partly held by Unilever United States, Inc. These group companies are therefore also ultimately owned jointly by NV and PLC.

These arrangements are designed to create a balance between the funds generated by the NV and PLC parts of the Group.

See pages 128 to 131 for a listing of the Groups principal subsidiaries and also Control of Unilever on page 138.

Legal structure of the Group

Directors
The Chairmen and all of the directors are full-time executives and directors of both NV and PLC and, as well as holding specific management responsibilities, they are responsible for the conduct of the business as a whole.

The Chairmen of NV and PLC are the principal executive officers of Unilever.

Our operations are organised into two global divisions Foods and Home & Personal Care headed by Division Directors. Reporting to their respective Division Directors are the Foods and the Home & Personal Care Business Presidents, responsible for the profitability of their regional and global businesses. For details of the Division Directors and Business Presidents, see pages 46 to 48.

The directors have set out a number of areas for which the Boards have direct responsibility for decision-making. They meet to consider the following corporate events and actions:

Agreement of quarterly results announcements
Approval of the Annual Report and Accounts
  and Form 20-F
Declaration of dividends
Convening of shareholders’ meetings
Approval of corporate strategy
Authorisation of major transactions

All other matters are delegated to committees whose actions are reported to and monitored by the Boards.

Board meetings are held in London and Rotterdam and chaired by the Chairmen of NV and PLC. The Chairmen are assisted by the Joint Secretaries, who ensure the Boards are supplied with all the information necessary for their deliberations. Information is normally supplied a week prior to each meeting.

Directors are elected by shareholders at the Annual General Meetings of NV and PLC, to hold office until the end of the next Annual General Meetings. For details of the nomination procedure for directors, see Control of Unilever on page 138. All directors submit themselves for re-election each year and retire at the latest by the age of 62. They are executive officers, and cease to hold executive office on ceasing to be directors. We appoint our other executive officers, who are full-time, for an indefinite period. These other executive officers are the corporate officers listed on page 48. None of our directors or executive officers is elected or appointed under any arrangement or understanding.

A procedure is in place to enable directors, if they so wish, to seek independent professional advice. On election, directors are briefed thoroughly on their responsibilities.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Corporate governance
43

 

Report of the Directors

 

All of our directors have been with Unilever full-time for at least five years, and in most cases for most of their business careers. For details see pages 46. There are no family relationships between any of our directors or executive officers.

Advisory Directors
The Advisory Directors are the principal external presence in the governance of Unilever. The role of an independent Advisory Director involves giving advice to the Boards in general, and to the Executive Committee in particular, on business, social and economic issues. One of their key roles is to assure the Boards that our corporate governance provisions are adequate and reflect, as far as possible, best practice. They serve on certain key Board committees, the roles and membership of which are described below.

The appointment of Advisory Directors is provided for in the Articles of Association of both parent companies, although they are not formally members of the Boards. They are therefore not entitled to vote at meetings of the Boards and bear no legal responsibility for the Boards actions. Their terms of appointment, role and powers are enshrined in resolutions of the Boards. As well as Board committee meetings, they attend the quarterly directors meetings, other directors conferences, and other meetings with the Chairmen. In addition, the Advisory Directors may meet as a body, at their discretion, and appoint a senior member as their spokesman.

Our Advisory Directors are chosen for their broad experience, international outlook and independence. They are appointed by resolutions of the Boards, normally for an initial term of three to four years and thereafter for terms of three years.

Their remuneration is determined by the Boards and this is reported on page 59. All appointments and re-appointments are based on the recommendations of the Nomination Committee.

In the context of Unilevers unique arrangements for corporate governance, all the Advisory Directors are considered to be independent of Unilever. The report on pages 59 and 60 describes the relationships between the Advisory Directors and Unilever.

Unilever has always aspired to high standards of corporate governance and in the light of the latest developments in Europe and the US, it is keeping its arrangements under active review. We currently anticipate concluding this review early in 2004.

Board Committees
The directors have established the following committees:

Executive Committee
The Executive Committee comprises the Chairmen of NV and PLC and five other members: the two Division Directors for Foods and for Home & Personal Care; the Corporate

 

Development Director; the Financial Director; and the Personnel Director. Members of the Executive Committee are appointed by all of the directors for one year at a time. The Executive Committee is responsible for agreeing priorities and allocating resources, setting overall corporate targets, agreeing and monitoring divisional strategies and plans, identifying and exploiting opportunities created by Unilevers scale and scope, managing external relations at the corporate level and developing future leaders. The Executive Committee generally meets formally at least monthly and is chaired, alternately, by the Chairmen of NV and PLC. The Committee is supplied with information by the Executive Committee Secretariat.

Audit Committee
The Audit Committee comprises a minimum of three Advisory Directors. The Committee has historically met three times a year and in accordance with its new charter plans to meet five times a year from 2003. It is chaired by Hilmar Kopper, and its other members are Oscar Fanjul and Claudio X Gonzalez. The Committees meetings are attended by the Financial Director, the General Counsel, the Controller, the Chief Auditor and our external auditors. The Committee reviews the overall risk management and control environment, financial reporting arrangements and standards of business conduct. It also provides independent monitoring of internal control arrangements. The Chief Auditor ensures that the Committee is supplied with necessary information. Both the Chief Auditor and the external auditors have direct access to the Audit Committee separately from other management.

See page 61 for the Report of the Audit Committee to the shareholders.

Corporate Risk Committee
The Corporate Risk Committee currently comprises the Financial Director, the Foods Director, the Home & Personal Care Director, the Personnel Director, the General Counsel, the Chief Auditor and the Controller. It meets at least twice a year. The objective of the Committee is to assist the Boards to carry out their responsibilities to ensure effective risk management and systems of internal control. It reports to the Boards, the Executive Committee and, as relevant, to the Audit Committee. The Committee is supplied with information by the Controller.

External Affairs and Corporate Relations Committee
The External Affairs and Corporate Relations Committee currently comprises five Advisory Directors and normally meets four times a year. It is chaired by Lady Chalker, and its other members are Lord Brittan, Senator George J Mitchell, Charles R Shoemate and Professor Wim Dik. The Committee oversees the Code of Business Principles, advises on external matters of relevance to the business including issues of corporate social responsibility and reviews our corporate relations strategy. The Committee is supplied with necessary information by the Corporate Development Director.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

44 Corporate governance

 

Nomination Committee
The Nomination Committee comprises a minimum of three Advisory Directors and the Chairmen of NV and PLC and meets at least once a year. It is chaired by Frits Fentener van Vlissingen and its other members are Antony Burgmans, Bertrand Collomb, Niall FitzGerald, Lord Simon and Jeroen van der Veer. It recommends to the Boards candidates for the positions of Director, Advisory Director and Executive Committee member. The Committee is supplied with information by the Joint Secretaries.

Remuneration Committee
The Remuneration Committee currently comprises four Advisory Directors and meets at least three times a year. It is chaired by Frits Fentener van Vlissingen, and its other members are Bertrand Collomb, Lord Simon and Jeroen van der Veer. It reviews executive directors remuneration and is responsible for the executive share-based incentive plans. The Committee determines specific remuneration packages for each of the directors. The Committee is supplied with information by J A A van der Bijl, Joint Secretary of Unilever.

The detailed report to shareholders on directors remuneration is on pages 49 to 60.

Routine business committees
Committees are set up to conduct routine business as and when they are necessary. They comprise any two of the directors and certain senior executives and officers of the Company. They administer certain matters previously agreed by the Boards or the Executive Committee. The Joint Secretaries are responsible for the operation of these committees.

All committees are formally set up by Board resolution with carefully defined remits. They report regularly and are responsible to the Boards of NV and PLC.

Requirements in the Netherlands and the UK
Unilever is subject to corporate governance requirements in both the Netherlands and the United Kingdom. A vital factor in the arrangements between NV and PLC is their having the same directors. The concept of the non-executive director, as recognised in the United Kingdom, is not a standard feature of corporate governance in the Netherlands, and the supervisory board, as recognised in the Netherlands, is unknown in the United Kingdom. It has hitherto not been considered practicable to appoint supervisory or non-executive directors who could serve on both Boards. Nevertheless, Unilevers Advisory Directors have long provided a strong independent element, performing many of the functions of supervisory and non-executive directors. The Audit, External Affairs and Corporate Relations and Remuneration Committees consist exclusively of Advisory Directors and the majority of the members of the Nomination Committee are Advisory Directors. See pages 46 and 47 for details.

The Committee on Corporate Governance in the Netherlands issued its reportRecommendations on

 

Corporate Governance in the Netherlands in 1997. NV applies the Committees recommendations for supervisory directors to its Advisory Directors in so far as these are in line with their specific role within Unilever. NV complies with all other recommendations of the Committee except that the Board of Directors takes the view that requests for an item to be placed on the agenda for a shareholders meeting must be supported by more than an insignificant proportion of the shareholders and will therefore only accept requests from a shareholder or group of shareholders holding at least 1% of the voting rights attaching to the issued share capital of NV. Requests must be submitted, at the latest, 60 days prior to the date of the meeting.

PLC is required, as a company that is incorporated in the United Kingdom and listed on the London Stock Exchange, to state how it has applied the principles and how far it has complied with the provisions set out in Section 1 of the Combined Code (the Combined Code) appended to the United Kingdom Listing Rules.

As already explained, the Boards exercise control through the Executive Committee. Responsibilities are shared by the Chairmen of NV and PLC, while the Advisory Directors perform many of the functions of the supervisory board members or non-executive directors, although they are not formally members of the Boards. For the purposes of the Combined Code, the Boards have not appointed a senior independent director, on the basis that issues for the Boards can be raised with whichever Advisory Director is the Chairman of the relevant Board Committee and the Advisory Directors are entitled to meet as a body and appoint a senior member as their spokesman.

Unilevers remuneration policy is contained within the report on the directors remuneration and interests on pages 49 to 60. This also deals with aspects of non-compliance with the Combined Code in this area. Members of the Audit, Remuneration and Nomination Committees will be available to answer questions at the Annual General Meetings of both NV and PLC. The members attending each meeting will not necessarily include the Chairman of the Committee, since these meetings take place at about the same time in Rotterdam and London respectively.

A description of Unilevers compliance withInternal Control Guidance for Directors on the Combined Code is given on pages 63 and 64.

Unilever has, since its inception, adopted the principle that it is good practice that the most senior roles in NV and PLC are shared and not concentrated in one person. As a consequence it is a principal tenet of its governance philosophy, which finds expression in two people who each combine the roles of Chairman and Chief Executive and who meet regularly for joint decision making. This carefully balanced arrangement has served Unilevers unique constitutional arrangements very well for many years and the Boards believe that to separate these roles would only


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Corporate governance
45

 

Report of the Directors

 

introduce undesirable and unnecessary complexity. Since the Advisory Directors are not formally members of the Boards, it would be inappropriate for one of them to act as Chairman.

In all other respects, PLC has complied with the Combined Code throughout 2002.

Auditors
Subject to the annual appointment of auditors by the shareholders and in addition to our ongoing process of monitoring the auditors performance, we undertake a formal review every three years. The most recent review was completed in November 2002. As a result, and on the recommendation of the Audit Committee, the directors will be proposing the re-appointment of PricewaterhouseCoopers at the AGMs on 7 May 2003 (see pages 134 and 137).

Both the Executive Committee and the auditors have for many years had safeguards to avoid the possibility that the auditors objectivity and independence could be compromised. In particular, our procedures in respect of other services provided by PricewaterhouseCoopers are:

Audit related services This is work that, in their position as the auditors, they must or are best placed to undertake. It includes formalities relating to borrowings, shareholder and other circulars, various other regulatory reports and work in respect of acquisitions and disposals.
   
Tax services In cases where they are best suited, we use the auditors. All other significant tax consulting work is put to tender.
   
General consulting Throughout 2002 our policy was that our external auditors may not tender for any new general consulting work. Previously, they were able to tender for general consulting projects.

These safeguards have been approved by the Audit Committee and are regularly reviewed and updated in the light of internal developments, external requirements and best practice. Non-audit services to be undertaken by our external auditors are now approved in advance by the Audit Committee.

The auditors report to the directors and the Audit Committee on the actions they take to comply with the professional and regulatory requirements and best practice designed to ensure their independence from Unilever, including, for example, the periodic rotation of key team members. The lead partner in charge of the audit changed in 2001.

See note 2 on page 77 for the actual payments made to PricewaterhouseCoopers.

Relations with shareholders and other investors
We believe it is important both to explain the business developments and financial results to investors and to understand their objectives. Within the Executive Committee, the Financial Director has lead responsibility for investor relations, with the active involvement of the Chairmen. They are supported by an Investor Relations Department which organises presentations for analysts and institutional investors. Such presentations are generally made available on our website. Briefings on quarterly results are given via teleconference and are accessible by telephone or via our website. Briefings are similarly given to update the market between each quarterly announcement. For further information visit our website at www.unilever.com.

Both NV and PLC communicate with their respective shareholders through the Annual General Meetings. At the AGMs, each Chairman gives a full account of the progress of the business over the last year and a review of the current issues. A summary of their addresses is published on our website and released to stock exchanges and media. Copies are freely available on request.

Our Chairmen, both in communications about the Annual General Meetings and at the actual meetings, encourage shareholders to attend and to ask questions. Question and answer sessions form an important part of the meetings in both the Netherlands and the United Kingdom. We are committed to efforts to establish more effective ways of shareholder communication. We actively participate in the Shareholders Communication Channel which facilitates proxy voting in the Netherlands.

Electronic communication is becoming an important medium for shareholders, providing ready access to shareholder information and reports, and for voting purposes. Shareholders of PLC in the United Kingdom can now choose to receive electronic notification that the Annual Review, Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F and Notice of Annual General Meeting have been published on our website, instead of receiving printed copies, and can also electronically appoint a proxy to vote on their behalf at the Annual General Meeting. Registration for electronic communication by shareholders of PLC can be made at www.shareview.co.uk.

Reporting to shareholders
The directors responsibilities are set out formally on page 63 and 64. The report to shareholders on directors remuneration and interests is set out on pages 49 to 60. The report of the Audit Committee is set out on page 61.

The responsibility of the auditors to report on these matters is set out on page 65.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

46 Corporate governance

 

Biographical details:

Directors

Antony Burgmans*1
Chairman, Unilever N.V.
Aged 56. Chairman of Unilever N.V. and Vice-Chairman of Unilever PLC since 4 May 1999. Joined Unilever 1972. Appointed director 8 May 1991. Previous posts include: Vice-Chairman of Unilever N.V. 1998. Business Group President, Ice Cream & Frozen Foods – Europe and Chairman of Unilever Europe Committee 96/98. Responsible for South European Foods business 94/96. Personal Products Co-ordinator 91/94. External appointments include: Member, Supervisory Board of ABN AMRO Bank N.V. and International Advisory Board of Allianz AG.

Niall FitzGerald KBE*1
Chairman, Unilever PLC
Aged 57. Chairman of Unilever PLC and Vice-Chairman of Unilever N.V. since 1 September 1996. Joined Unilever 1967. Appointed director 20 May 1987. Previous posts include: Vice-Chairman of Unilever PLC 1994. Detergents Co-ordinator 91/95. Member, Foods Executive 89/91. Edible Fats & Dairy Co-ordinator 89/90. Financial Director 87/89. External appointments include: Non-executive director of Reuters Group PLC.

Clive Butler*
Corporate Development Director
Aged 56. Corporate Development Director since 1 January 2001. Joined Unilever 1970. Appointed director 6 May 1992. Previous posts include: Category Director, Home & Personal Care 1996. Personnel Director 93/96. Corporate Development Director 1992. External appointments include: Non-executive director of Lloyds TSB Group plc.

Patrick Cescau*9
Foods Director
Aged 54. Foods Director since 1 January 2001. Joined Unilever 1973. Appointed director 4 May 1999. Previous posts include: Financial Director 1999. Controller and Deputy Financial Director 98/99. President, Lipton USA 97/98. President, Van den Bergh Foods USA 95/97. Chairman, Indonesia 91/95. External appointments include: Non-executive director of Pearson plc.

Keki Dadiseth*9
Home & Personal Care Director
Aged 57. Home & Personal Care Director since 1 January 2001. Joined Unilever 1973. Appointed director 3 May 2000. Previous posts include: Hindustan Lever Chairman 1996, Vice-Chairman and Managing Director 95/96. External appointments include: Non-executive director of The Indian Hotels Company. Member, International Advisory Board of DaimlerChrysler AG.

André baron van Heemstra*9
Personnel Director
Aged 57. Personnel Director since 3 May 2000. Joined Unilever 1970. Appointed director 3 May 2000. Previous posts include: Business Group President, East Asia Pacific 1996. Chairman, Langnese-Iglo 92/96.

Rudy Markham*10
Financial Director
Aged 56. Financial Director since 4 August 2000. Joined Unilever 1968. Appointed director 6 May 1998. Previous posts include: Strategy & Technology Director 1998. Business Group President, North East Asia 96/98. Chairman, Nippon Lever Japan 92/96. Group Treasurer 86/89. External appointments include: Non-executive director of Standard Chartered PLC.

 

Charles Strauss
President, Home & Personal Care North America and Global Prestige Business. Chairman, North America Committee
Aged 60. Joined Unilever 1986 upon Unilever’s acquisition of Ragú Foods. Appointed director 3 May 2000. Previous posts include: Business Group President, Latin America 96/99. President, Lever Brothers USA 93/96. Chairman, Langnese-Iglo 89/92. External appointments include: Non-executive director of Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.

* Member Executive Committee

Advisory Directors

The Rt Hon The Lord Brittan of Spennithorne QC, DL2
Aged 63. Appointed 2000. Vice-Chairman of UBS Warburg and Chairman of UBS Warburg Ltd. Member of the European Commission and Vice-President 89/99. Member of the UK Government 79/86. Home Secretary 83/85 and Secretary of State for Trade and Industry 85/86.

Baroness Chalker of Wallasey3
Aged 60. Appointed 1998. Director of Freeplay Energy plc, Development Consultants International, Group 5 (Pty) Ltd and Ashanti Goldfields Company Ltd. UK Minister of State at the Foreign and Commonwealth Office 86/97. Created Life Peer in 1992. Member of Parliament for Wallasey 74/92.

Bertrand Collomb1,4
Aged 60. Appointed 1994. Chairman and CEO of Lafarge S.A. Director of Vivendi Universal, TotalFinaElf and Atco. Member, Supervisory Board of Allianz AG and Advisory Board of Banque de France.

Professor Wim Dik2
Aged 64. Appointed 2001. Professor at Delft University of Technology. Chairman, Supervisory Boards of Van Gansewinkel Groep and Holland Casino. Member, Supervisory Boards of ABN AMRO Bank N.V., Vos Logistics and Tele Atlas N.V. Non-executive director of Aviva plc and LogicaCMG plc. Chairman and CEO of Koninklijke PTT Nederland (KPN) 88/98 and Koninklijke KPN N.V. (Royal Dutch Telecom) 98/00. Minister for Foreign Trade, Netherlands 81/82.

Oscar Fanjul7
Aged 53. Appointed 1996. Honorary Chairman of Repsol-YPF S.A. Director of Marsh & McLennan Companies, the London Stock Exchange, ACERINOX S.A., Técnicas Reunidas S.A. Member, International Advisory Boards of Marsh & McLennan and The Chubb Corporation. Member, European Advisory Board of the Carlyle Group. Chairman and CEO Repsol 86/96. Chairman of Hidroeléctrica del Cantábrico S.A. 99/01. Secretary General and Under Secretary, Spanish Ministry of Industry and Energy 83/85.

Frits Fentener van Vlissingen5,6
Aged 69. Appointed 1990. Retiring 2003. Managing Director of Flint Holding N.V. Chairman, Supervisory Board of Draka Holdings N.V. Deputy Chairman, Supervisory Boards of Akzo Nobel N.V. and SHV Holdings. Member, Supervisory Board of CSM N.V.

Claudio X Gonzalez7
Aged 68. Appointed 1998. Chairman and CEO of Kimberly-Clark de Mexico S.A. Director of Kimberly-Clark Corporation, Kellogg Company, General Electric Company (USA), Grupo Carso S.A., Grupo Alfa, Grupo Televisa, Fondo Mexico, Home Depot, America Movil, and Investment Company of America. Member, International Advisory Council of JPMorgan Chase. Special Advisor to the President of Mexico 88/94.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Corporate governance
47

 

Report of the Directors

 

Hilmar Kopper8
Aged 67. Appointed 1998. Chairman, Supervisory Board of DaimlerChrysler AG. Non-executive director of Xerox Corp. and member, Supervisory Boards of Akzo Nobel N.V. and Solvay S.A. Former CEO and Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Deutsche Bank AG.

Senator George J Mitchell2
Aged 69. Appointed 1998. Partner of the law firm Piper Rudnik. Director of Walt Disney Company, Federal Express Corp., Starwood Hotels and Resorts and Staples Inc. Member, International Advisory Board of Thames Water Plc. Member of the US Senate 80/95 and Senate Majority Leader 88/95. Chairman of the Northern Ireland Peace Initiative 95/99.

Charles R Shoemate2
Aged 63. Appointed 2001. Retiring 2003. Director of CIGNA Corporation, International Paper Company and Chevron Texaco Corporation. Chairman & CEO of Bestfoods 90/00 and President 88/90.

The Lord Simon of Highbury CBE1,4
Aged 63. Appointed 2000. Member, Advisory Board of LEK Consulting and International Advisory Council of Fortis. Non-executive director of Suez Group. Member, Supervisory Board of Volkswagen AG. Senior Advisor and member, European Advisory Board of Morgan Stanley Dean Witter. UK Government Minister 97/99. Group Chief Executive of BP 92/95 and Chairman 95/97.

Jeroen van der Veer1,4
Aged 55. Appointed 2002. President of Royal Dutch Petroleum Company and Vice-Chairman of the Committee of Managing Directors of Royal Dutch/Shell Group of Companies. Member, Supervisory Board of De Nederlandsche Bank.

1 Member Nomination Committee
2 Member External Affairs and Corporate Relations Committee
3 Chairman External Affairs and Corporate Relations Committee
4 Member Remuneration Committee
5 Chairman Nomination Committee
6 Chairman Remuneration Committee
7 Member Audit Committee
8 Chairman Audit Committee
9 Member Corporate Risk Committee
10 Chairman Corporate Risk Committee

Business Presidents Foods

Regions

Manfred Stach, Europe. Chairman, Europe Committee Aged 60. Joined Unilever 1970. Appointed Business President 1998. Previous position: Business Group President Africa.

Kees van der Graaf, Ice Cream and Frozen Foods Europe Aged 52. Joined Unilever 1976. Appointed Business President 2001. Previous position: Chief Executive Officer, Unilever Bestfoods Europe.

John Rice, North America Aged 51. Joined Unilever 1981. Appointed Business President 2001. Previous position: Business President Latin America.

Rachid M Rachid, North Africa, Middle East and Turkey Aged 48. Joined Unilever 1987. Appointed Business President 2001. (Also is a representative of the region for HPC). He is interested through family holdings in the partner that holds 40% of Unilever Mashreq, which comprises Unilever’s operations in Egypt and the Levant.

Tex Gunning, Asia Aged 52. Joined Unilever 1982. Appointed Business President 2000. Previous position: Business Group President East Asia Pacific.

Alberto Sobredo, Latin America Aged 53. Joined Unilever 1998. Appointed Business President 2002. Previous position: Executive Vice-President, Latin America and Chairman, Unilever Chile.

Global Businesses

Diego Bevilacqua, Foodsolutions Aged 49. Joined Unilever 2000 upon Unilever’s acquisition of Bestfoods. Appointed Business President 2001. Previous position: Vice-President Bestfoods and President Bestfoods, Asia.

Robert Polet, Ice Cream & Frozen Foods Global Aged 47. Joined Unilever 1978. Appointed Business President 1998. Previous position: Business Group President Ice Cream & Frozen Foods Europe.

John Rice, Slim•Fast Worldwide See above.

Function

Jean Martin, Global integration leader Aged 58. Joined Unilever 1968. Appointed Business President 1996. Previous position: Business Group President Central and Eastern Europe.

Anthony Simon, Marketing Aged 57. Joined Unilever 2000 upon Unilever’s acquisition of Bestfoods. Appointed Business President 2001. Previous position: Vice-President Strategies and Core Businesses Bestfoods.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

48 Corporate governance

 

Business Presidents Home & Personal Care

Regions

Ralph Kugler, Europe Aged 47. Joined Unilever 1979. Appointed Business President 1999. Previous position: Business Group President Latin America.

Charles Strauss, North America Unilever Director see page 46.

Anton Lenstra, Africa Aged 54. Joined Unilever 1989. Appointed Business President 2000. (Also is a representative of the region for Foods). Previous position: Vice-President Home & Personal Care Europe.

Jeff Fraser, Asia Aged 59. Joined Unilever 1967. Appointed Business President 1996. Previous position: Business Group President Central Asia & Middle East.

Harish Manwani, Latin America Aged 49. Joined Unilever 1976. Appointed Business President 2001. Previous position: Senior Vice-President, Home & Personal Care Category Group.

Global Businesses

Charles Strauss, Prestige Unilever Director see page 46.

Function

Simon Clift, Marketing Aged 44. Joined Unilever 1982. Appointed Business President 2001. Previous position: Chairman Personal Care Category Group, Latin America.

Corporate Officers

Jan van der Bijl, Joint Secretary and Head of Group Taxation Aged 53. Appointed 1 July 2001. Years of service on 31 December 2002: 15 years.

Stephen Williams,9 Joint Secretary and General Counsel Aged 55. Appointed 1 December 1986. Years of service on 31 December 2002: 16 years.

Jeffrey Allgrove,9 Controller Aged 50. Appointed 4 May 1999. Years of service on 31 December 2002: 25 years.

Henning Rehder, Treasurer Aged 49. Appointed 23 April 2002. Years of service on 31 December 2002: 22 years.

James Duckworth,9 Chief Auditor Aged 58. Appointed 1 March 1999. Years of service on 31 December 2002: 34 years.

 

Board changes
All directors held office throughout the year.

In accordance with the Articles of Association of NV and PLC, all existing directors will retire from office at the Annual General Meetings on 7 May 2003 and will offer themselves for re-election.

Details of directors service contracts are given on page 54.

Advisory Directors changes
Frits Fentener van Vlissingen will retire as an Advisory Director with effect from the Annual General Meetings in 2003. The directors wish to record their gratitude for his substantial and positive contribution during the last thirteen years, and particularly as chairman of the Nomination and Remuneration Committees. He will be succeeded as Chairman of these committees by Bertrand Collomb. Charles R Shoemate will also cease to be an Advisory Director at these Annual General Meetings. The Directors wish to record their appreciation of his contribution to the success of the integration of the Bestfoods business.

With effect from 1 May 2002, Jeroen van der Veer was appointed as an Advisory Director until the Annual General Meetings in 2005, serving on both the Remuneration and Nomination Committees. Wim Dik was appointed to the External Affairs and Corporate Relations Committee at the same time. As anticipated, Onno Ruding retired as an Advisory Director in 2002.

The Boards have resolved to re-appoint Lord Brittan, Lord Simon and Bertrand Collomb as Advisory Directors until the Annual General Meetings in 2006.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Remuneration report
49

Report of the Directors

Report to shareholders
This report sets out the policy and disclosures on directorsremuneration, as required by legislation in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom. It also takes into account the recommendations of the Committee on Corporate Governance in the Netherlands (Peters Committee). In addition, full consideration has been given to the Combined Code of the United Kingdom Listing Rules (the Combined Code).

The Remuneration Committee
The Remuneration Committee is responsible for making recommendations to the Boards on the remuneration policy for directors. The Committee consists of Advisory Directors who are chosen for their broad experience, international outlook and independence. In 2002 the Committee comprised F H Fentener van Vlissingen (Chairman), B Collomb, Lord Simon of Highbury and, with effect from May 2002, J van der Veer. Professor W Dik was a member of the Committee until April 2002.

The Committee meets at least three times a year and, on behalf of the Boards, sets the remuneration packages for directors, including base salary, pension rights, bonus and long-term incentive awards, grants of share options and any compensation payments. The Committee is assisted by the Secretary to the Remuneration Committee, J A A van der Bijl, Joint Secretary of Unilever. A Burgmans and N W A FitzGerald attend part of the Committee meetings in their capacity as Chairmen of NV and PLC respectively.

The Remuneration Committee does not retain remuneration consultants but seeks professional advice from external advisors as it sees fit. During the year professional advice on remuneration matters was sought from an independent firm of remuneration specialists, Towers Perrin. This firm also provides general consultancy advice to Unilever Group companies on pension, communications and other human resource matters.

Directors remuneration policy
The objective of Unilevers remuneration policy for directors is to attract, motivate and retain top class business executives who are able to direct and lead a large global company and to reward them accordingly based on performance.

Levels of remuneration are reviewed annually by the Remuneration Committee in the light of external expert advice which assesses competitive levels of remuneration paid by other major international companies. In particular, remuneration arrangements for comparable companies based in Continental Europe and the UK are taken into account. For our US-based director the Committee also reviews remuneration packages applicable in the US market.

In addition a comparison is made with the remuneration arrangements for other senior employees within Unilever.

In line with the Path to Growth strategy it is the Remuneration Committees policy to link a significant proportion of directors remuneration to a number of key measures of company performance. As will be seen from the descriptions below, the three main measures underlying our annual and longer-term incentive plans are earnings per share growth (BEIA), underlying sales growth in the leading brands and the total shareholder return generated by Unilever in comparison with a group of 20 relevant competitors. In broad terms, if the Group achieves its target levels of performance the variable elements will account for about 60% of the directors total remuneration. The variable elements would, of course, result in no incentive awards if performance is unsatisfactory. By the same token, if the Group clearly achieves outstanding results the overall value of the incentive awards could increase to more than three-quarters of the directors total remuneration.

NV and PLC and their group companies operate as nearly as possible as a single entity. Directors serve both companies as executives and therefore receive remuneration from both. Whenever we refer to remuneration, this includes payments from both NV and PLC. The remuneration for the US-based director is paid mainly by Unilever United States, Inc. (UNUS) to reflect the fact that a major proportion of his duties is performed in the US. He does, however, also receive part of his remuneration from NV and PLC to cover his executive responsibilities as a director of these companies. In this report his total remuneration from all three sources is shown in full.

All remuneration and fees earned by directors from outside directorships and similar sources are required to be paid over to, and retained by, Unilever.

The Remuneration Committee keeps its remuneration policies under review in the light of company and market developments. However it has no plans, at present, to materially alter the framework of the current remuneration arrangements, as described below, during 2003.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

50 Remuneration report

 

Remuneration package
The remuneration package of the directors consists of a base salary, allowances and benefits in kind, annual performance bonus, long-term incentive arrangements and pension provision. The details are as follows:

1. Base salary

Base salaries are set by the Remuneration Committee and are fixed in the currency appropriate to the country in which the individual is based. Whilst one overall salary framework applies to all directors, separate salary ranges are agreed each year for directors based in continental Europe, the UK and the US.

2. Allowances and benefits in kind

Directors enjoy similar benefits to many other employees of the Unilever Group. These include private medical insurance, the use of company cars (or cash in lieu) and assistance with relocation costs when moving from one country to another. They also receive an allowance to cover small out-of-pocket expenses not covered by the reimbursement of their business entertaining expenses. In addition, the UK-based directors receive an allowance, where applicable, to compensate for the fact that some of their remuneration is paid in the Netherlands.

3. Annual performance bonus

The annual bonus can range between 0% and 100% of base salary. This bonus is based on achievement of specific corporate and personal targets which are set by the Remuneration Committee at the beginning of each year. Up to the equivalent of 80% of base salary is paid by reference to corporate targets and up to 20% of base salary is paid by reference to personal targets.

The corporate targets are based on a combination of the increase in earnings per share (BEIA) and underlying sales growth of the leading brands for the year in question. Personal targets are based on agreed key objectives relative to the directors specific responsibilities.

At the end of each year the Remuneration Committee reviews the results against the targets which had been set previously.

For 2002 the earnings per share (BEIA) target range was exceeded and underlying sales growth in the leading brands was in the upper half of the target range. Moreover the personal key objectives set for each director were generally achieved. Details of the payments made for 2002 are shown in the remuneration table.

One quarter of the annual bonus for directors is delivered in the form of NV and PLC shares and the directors are then awarded an equivalent number of matching shares. These matching shares are described as forming part of the long-term incentive arrangements (see below).

4. Long-term incentive arrangements

Directors are eligible to be considered for participation in three long-term incentive arrangements as follows:

(a) Matching shares

As explained above, one quarter of the annual bonus is delivered in the form of NV and PLC shares. The Group then awards an equivalent number of matching shares. These matching shares vest three years after grant provided that the original bonus shares have been retained for the three-year period and that the director has not resigned or been dismissed during that period.

Apart from these latter conditions no further performance conditions apply to the vesting of the matching shares. The Remuneration Committee considers that, as the level of the award is directly linked to the payment of the annual bonus (to which performance conditions do apply), there is no need for further performance conditions on the vesting of the award. The Remuneration Committee also wishes to encourage directors to hold shares in the company they serve to further align the interests of the directors with those of the shareholders in general. The necessity to hold the bonus shares for a minimum of a three-year period (during which time the share price will be influenced by the performance of the Group) reinforces this commitment on the part of the director and is also consistent with the shareholding requirement described on page 55. In addition, the Remuneration Committee believes that the three-year period to vesting of the matching shares supports, as far as is possible, the retention of key executives.

(b) Share options

Directors are able to participate in the UK Employee ShareSave Plan and the Netherlands Employee Option Plan, which are both All-Employee plans. The US-based director is able to participate in the North American Employee Stock Purchase Plan. These plans are referred to in note 29 on pages 103 to 111.

In addition, directors participate in the Executive Option Plans, as described in note 29 on pages 103 and 106 to 108.

The Remuneration Committee has established benchmark grant levels, described as the normal allocation, to assist each year in deciding on actual grant levels under the Executive Option Plans. The Committee has reviewed these normal allocations in 2002 and has concluded that they are still in line with those awarded by other companies with which we compare ourselves.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Remuneration report 51

 

Report of the Directors

The normal share option allocations for the directors are:

 
NV Shares
 
 
PLC Shares
 






Chairmen 12 000     80 000  
US-based director 12 000     80 000  
Other directors 7 500     50 500  






Group performance conditions are set annually by the Remuneration Committee, and these conditions must be satisfied before a director can be granted an option. The Remuneration Committee then sets the level of actual grants to be made to each director for the year in question by applying the relevant percentage (see below) to the normal allocation shown above.

The Group performance condition for 2002 in respect of the grant of an option under the Executive Option Plans is that our earnings per share before exceptional items and amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (BEIA) over the three financial years preceding the date of grant should have cumulatively risen by at least 6% more than inflation within the UK and the eurozone over that period when measured at current rates of exchange. If it had not, no grants would be made. The Remuneration Committee regards earnings per share BEIA growth as the most appropriate measure of the Groups underlying financial performance.

Once the Group performance condition has been met, each directors option grant is determined by the percentage increase, above the rate of inflation in the UK and the eurozone, of the Groups earnings per share BEIA over the financial year preceding the date of grant. For 2002 (as in 2001) the Remuneration Committee set the following targets and levels of grants based on their view that less than 4% real growth is unexceptional and more than 6% real growth represents above target performance.

 EPS BEIA growth achieved in 2001  Par level of grant as
percentage of normal allocation
  




Inflation + less than 4%   0%  
Inflation + 4%   50%  
Inflation + 5%   75%  
Inflation + 6%   100%  
Inflation + 7%   125%  
Inflation + 8% or more   150%  




The earnings per share BEIA growth for 2001 was in excess of inflation + 8% which produced a 150% level of grant for 2002.

There are no additional performance conditions applying to the exercise of executive options as the Remuneration Committee considers that the underlying financial performance of the Group, which in turn affects the growth in share price between grant and exercise of an option, is sufficient. The Remuneration Committee has also taken account of the fact that the Executive Option Plans extend to Unilever executives worldwide and in many countries in which the Group operates it is not common practice to have any performance conditions on exercise.

The price payable for each share on the exercise of the options is not less than the market price of the share on the date of grant. In normal circumstances, an option granted under the Executive Plans may not be exercised earlier than three years from the date of grant.

Premium options, equivalent to 20% of the number of shares included in the original grant, may be granted to directors upon the fifth anniversary of each of the share option grants they received in the years 1997 to 2000. These premium grants are conditional upon sustained good performance by both the Group and the individual director over the relevant five year period and upon the director either not having exercised the original options or having retained all profit from an exercise in the form of shares. This incentive was discontinued as part of the changes to remuneration arrangements in 2001.

Under the Executive Option Plan rules the Group has the right to substitute the cash value for shares on the exercise of any individuals options. The Group does not generally intend to exercise this right unless an individual would be disadvantaged if we did not.

(c) TSR Long-Term Incentive Plan

Under this plan directors are granted conditional rights to shares in NV and PLC. The level of the annual grants is made under the guidance of the Remuneration Committee. In March 2002 the following conditional awards were made to each director:

   Chairmen: Shares in NV and PLC to the combined value of800 000
   European-based directors: Shares in NV and PLC to the combined value of 500 000
   US-based director: Shares in NV and PLC to the combined value of400 000

Depending on the performance of Unilevers Total Shareholder Return (TSR) over a three-year performance cycle compared with that of its defined peer group (as set out on page 40 and 41), the awards vest following the end of the three-year performance cycle in accordance with the following table:

Ranking within TSR Peer Group Percentage of award
that vests
  




Numbers 12 – 21   Nil  
Numbers 10 – 11   25%  
Numbers 8 – 9   50%  
Numbers 5 – 7   100%  
Numbers 3 – 4   150%  
Numbers 1 – 2   200%  




The conditional awards made in March 2002 represent 100% on the above table and will vest in March 2005. The percentage of the award that vests will depend on the outcome of the performance tests for the three-year performance cycle starting with the financial year 2002 and ending with the financial year 2004.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

52 Remuneration report

 

Details of the companies which formed the reference group of comparator companies, and a ranking table showing Unilevers position relative to this peer group over the last five years are given on page 41.

By using the TSR table as a performance indicator for our Long-Term Incentive Plan there is a clear link between the reward given to directors and the investment growth enjoyed by our shareholders in comparison with that enjoyed by investors in the defined peer group of companies. It will be noted from the table that there is no award if Unilevers performance is ranked at less than position 11 of the peer group and an award in excess of the full conditional award will only be made if Unilever is ranked in the top four of the group.

Unilevers position relative to broad based equity indices
Under the UK Directors Remuneration Report Regulations 2002 we are also required to show Unilevers relative share performance against a holding of shares in a broad based equity index for the last five years. The Remuneration Committee has decided to show Unilevers performance against two indices (Euronext AEX Index, Amsterdam and FTSE 100 Index) as these are the most generally used indices in the Netherlands and the UK, where we have our principal listings.

Directors pensions
The aim of the Remuneration Committee is that retirement benefits should be in line with good practice of major companies in continental Europe and the United Kingdom, bearing in mind the need to make the retirement benefit position of the various directors, who have different nationalities, reasonably comparable.

In accordance with this policy, directors are covered by a final salary defined benefit arrangement and can retire with retirement benefits broadly equivalent to two-thirds of final pensionable pay at age 60. Final pensionable pay includes the average annual performance bonuses paid in the last three years, up to a maximum of 20% of base pay. This is similar to the current Group practice for senior executives. It is the view of the Remuneration Committee that a significant part of directors remuneration should be performance related, and that therefore part of the annual performance related bonus should be pensionable. The Committee reconsiders this topic from time to time in the light of the recommendations of the Combined Code and continues to take the view that these arrangements should be kept in place.

The tables on page 53 give details of the directors pensions values for the year ended 31 December 2002.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Remuneration report

53

 

Report of the Directors

Directors pension values for the year ended 31 December 2002 were as follows:

 
Age at
31 December 2002
 
Increase
in total
accrued
annual
benefit
during
(1) 
Total
accrued
annual
benefit at
31 December
(1) 
Transfer
value of
accrued
benefit at
31 December
(2) 
Transfer
value of
accrued
benefit at
31 December
(2) 
Difference
between
2001 & 2002
transfer
values less
individual
(2)(3)
years
 
months
  2002 2002 2002 2001 contributions
NV (1)         €’000   €’000   €’000   €’000   €’000  















A Burgmans (4)
55
 
11
 
138
 
571
 
9 747
 
6 312
 
3 435
 
P J Cescau (5)
54
 
3
 
26
 
584
 
7 754
 
7 807
 
(53
)
A R van Heemstra
56
 
11
 
66
 
405
 
6 702
 
5 753
 
949
 















                             
         
$’000
 
$’000
 
$’000
 
$’000
 
$’000
 















C B Strauss
59
 
11
 
70
 
800
 
12 390
 
11 364
 
1 026
 















                             
                             
PLC
       
£’000
 
£’000
 
£’000
 
£’000
 
£’000
 















N W A FitzGerald (6)
57
 
4
 
111
 
718
 
11 720
 
9 420
 
2 300
 
A C Butler
56
 
6
 
36
 
366
 
5 730
 
5 200
 
530
 
K B Dadiseth
57
 
0
 
67
 
419
 
6 950
 
5 790
 
1 160
 
R H P Markham
56
 
10
 
54
 
393
 
6 340
 
5 460
 
880
 
















(1) The accrued annual benefits are calculated on the basis that directors would have left service at 31 December 2002 and include all benefits provided from Unilever pension plans. Under the NV directors arrangement, which operates on the basis of a justifiable expectation and does not provide any vested deferred entitlement, NV directors leaving before age 55 are only entitled to benefits from other Unilever pension plans, while for those terminating service at age 55 or older an immediate, but reduced, pension is shown in line with their expectations under the NV directors arrangement. Under the PLC directors arrangement, directors terminating service between age 55 (50 or older for directors appointed prior to 1 January 1999) and age 60 may elect for early payment of their deferred benefits on a reduced basis.
(2) The transfer values for the NV directorsarrangement are calculated on the basis used by the Unilever Netherlands pension plan (Progress), in line with the Netherlands regulations. The transfer values for the PLC directorsarrangement are calculated on the basis used by the Unilever United Kingdom pension plan (UPF), in line with the GN11 guidance note published by the Institute and Faculty of Actuaries in the United Kingdom.
(3) During 2002 no compulsory contributions were paid by any director, in line with the then current practice for all employees in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom and the United States.
(4) Reached age 55 during the year, therefore the increase in total accrued benefit during 2002 was calculated using the 31 December 2001 total accrued annual benefit, actuarially converted to be consistent with the form of the 31 December 2002 accrued annual benefit.
(5) Moved to NV directors arrangement with effect from 1 January 2002 with a deferred benefit in the PLC directors arrangement.
(6) During 2002, the qualifying age for pension for N W A FitzGerald was reduced from 60 years 9 months to 60 years, in line with the qualifying age for the other directors. The effect of this change was to increase his accrued annual benefit by £19 thousand and his transfer value by £940 thousand.

Supplementary disclosures on directors’ pensions required by the Listing Rules of the Financial Services Authority:

 
Increase in accrued
annual benefit
excluding inflation
during 2002
(1)
Transfer value at
31.12.2002 of
the increase in
accrued benefit
excluding inflation
(2)(3)
NV
€’000
 
€’000
 





A Burgmans (4)
121
 
2 955
 
P J Cescau (5)
18
 
225
 
A R van Heemstra
53
 
849
 





 
$’000
 
$’000
 





C B Strauss
42
 
862
 





         
PLC
£’000
 
£’000
 





N W A FitzGerald (6)
102
 
2 165
 
A C Butler
31
 
466
 
K B Dadiseth
62
 
1 014
 
R H P Markham
49
 
784
 





For footnotes please refer above.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

54

Remuneration report

 

Directors service contracts
NVs and PLCs Articles of Association require that all directors retire from office at every Annual General Meeting. Directorscontracts of service with the Unilever Group are generally terminated no later than the end of the month in which the Annual General Meeting closest to their 62nd birthday is held. See table below:

   
Date of
appointment
 
Effective date
of current
contract
 
Expiry/
retirement
date
*
Notice period
for company
 
Notice period
for director
   












A Burgmans  
8 May 1991
 
5 May 1993
 
31 May 2009
 
12 months
 
6 months
 
N W A FitzGerald  
20 May 1987
 
5 May 1993
 
31 May 2007
 
12 months
 
6 months
 
A C Butler  
6 May 1992
 
5 May 1993
 
31 May 2008
 
12 months
 
6 months
 
P J Cescau  
4 May 1999
 
4 May 1999
 
31 May 2010
 
12 months
 
6 months
 
K B Dadiseth  
3 May 2000
 
3 May 2000
 
31 May 2007
 
12 months
 
6 months
 
A R van Heemstra  
3 May 2000
 
3 May 2000
 
31 May 2008
 
12 months
 
6 months
 
R H P Markham  
6 May 1998
 
6 May 1998
 
31 May 2008
 
12 months
 
6 months
 
C B Strauss  
3 May 2000
 
3 May 2000
 
31 May 2005
 
12 months
 
6 months
 













* Assumes that the Annual General Meeting is held in May, as is the current practice.

The directors are long serving Unilever executives who can reasonably expect, subject to satisfactory performance, to be employed by Unilever until retirement. The Committee takes the view that the entitlement by the directors to the security of twelve months notice of termination of employment is in line both with the practice of many comparable companies and the entitlement of other senior executives within Unilever.

The directors have service contracts with both NV and PLC. The service contracts provide for 12 months notice of termination on the part of each company. NV and PLC may, if they choose, pay to the director a sum equal to 12 months salary in lieu of notice.

The Remuneration Committees aim is always to deal fairly with cases of termination whilst taking a robust line in minimising any compensation. The Remuneration Committee has given due consideration to the recommendations contained in the Combined Code regarding inclusion of explicit provisions in directors service contracts for compensation commitments in the event of early termination. The Committee will continue to keep under review its current practice, which is not to include such provisions in order to enable it to respond appropriately to particular circumstances.

In both 2002 and 2001, all eight directors served for the whole of the year. In 2001, two other directors served for only part of the year.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Remuneration report

55

 

Report of the Directors

Directors shareholding requirements
It is a requirement of the long-term incentive arrangements described on pages 50 to 52 that over a period of five years (starting from the date of appointment or 1 April 2000, whichever is the later), each director must build up and maintain a personal shareholding in NV and PLC equivalent in value to one and a half times their annual base salary.

Directors interests: share capital
The interests in the share capitals of NV and PLC and their group companies of those who were directors at the beginning and end of 2002 and of their immediate families were as shown in the tables below:

 
Shares
held at
1 January
 
Matching
shares at
1 January


(c)
Total
shares at 1 January
 
Shares
held at 31 December
 
Matching
shares at
31 December


(c)
Total
shares at
31 December
 













NV (€0.51 ordinary shares)                        
A Burgmans
44 765
 
1 867
 
46 632
30 533
 
3 635
 
34 168
 
N W A FitzGerald
6 766
 
3 195
 
9 961
5 510
 
5 511
 
11 021
 
A C Butler
2 351
 
1 288
 
3 639
 
3 502
 
2 439
 
5 941
 
P J Cescau
942
 
942
 
1 884
2 403
 
2 403
 
4 806
 
K B Dadiseth
434
 
434
 
868
 
1 752
 
1 752
 
3 504
 
A R van Heemstra
1 000
 
1 000
 
2 000
 
1 953
 
1 953
 
3 906
 
R H P Markham
32 106
 
1 274
 
33 380
33 430
 
2 598
 
36 028
 
C B Strauss
3 859
 
2 245
 
6 104
12 971
 
4 157
 
17 128
 













NV (€0.05 preference shares)                        
A Burgmans        
7 750
       
7 750
 













PLC (1.4p ordinary shares)                        
N W A FitzGerald
48 965
 
24 191
 
73 156
361 951
 
40 581
 
402 532
 
         
156 815 034
(a)
       
156 815 034
(a)
A Burgmans
24 643
 
14 076
 
38 719
37 159
 
26 592
 
63 751
 
A C Butler
32 110
 
9 943
 
42 053
44 910
 
18 091
 
63 001
 
P J Cescau
7 129
 
7 129
 
14 258
17 471
 
17 471
 
34 942
 
K B Dadiseth
5 360
 
3 172
 
8 532
17 679
 
12 499
 
30 178
 
A R van Heemstra
7 429
 
7 429
 
14 858
14 174
 
14 174
 
28 348
 
R H P Markham
48 319
 
9 803
 
58 122
57 689
 
19 173
 
76 862
 
C B Strauss
16 475
 
16 475
 
32 950
(b)
30 014
 
30 014
 
60 028
(b)













Hindustan Lever Limited (ordinary shares)                        
K B Dadiseth        
107 490
       
107 490
 













Margarine Union (1930) Limited (shares)                        
N W A FitzGerald        
400
(a)
       
400
(a)














(a) Held jointly as a trustee of the Leverhulme Trust and the Leverhulme Trade Charities Trust with no beneficial interest. The holding of 156 815 034 PLC ordinary shares represents 5.39% of the ordinary issued share capital of PLC.
(b) Partially held as American Depositary Receipts (ADRs).
(c) Matching shares were conditionally awarded as part of the annual performance bonus plan (see page 50).

The directors, in common with other employees of PLC and its United Kingdom subsidiaries, had beneficial interests in 41 531 145 PLC ordinary shares at 1 January 2002 and 43 176 360 PLC ordinary shares at 31 December 2002, acquired by the Unilever Employee Share Trusts for the purpose of satisfying options under the PLC Executive Option Plans and the UK Employee Sharesave Plan. Further information, including details of the NV and PLC ordinary shares acquired by certain group companies in connection with other share option plans, is given in note 29 on page 111.

The voting rights of the directors who hold interests in the share capitals of NV and PLC are the same as for other holders of the class of shares indicated. Except as stated above, none of the directors or other executive officers shareholdings amounts to more than 0.01% of the issued shares in that class of share. Except as stated above, all shareholdings are beneficial.

The only changes in the interests of the directors and their families in NV and PLC ordinary shares between 31 December 2002 and 28 February 2003 were that:

(i) the holding of the Unilever Employee Trusts has reduced to 42 945 620 PLC shares.
(ii) N W A FitzGerald acquired 36 PLC shares through a reinvestment of dividends.
(iii) C B Strauss gifted 100 NV shares.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

56

Remuneration report

Remuneration of directors and executive officers
The total amount of remuneration (including share option gains but excluding pension provisions) received by all directors and executive officers (being the directors and corporate officers listed on pages 46 and 48 respectively) for services in all capacities during 2002 was 26 474 466 (£16 625 972).

The total amount set aside by the Unilever Group during 2002 to provide pension, retirement or similar benefits for directors and executive officers was 4 585 032 (£2 879 401).

Directors emoluments
The aggregate remuneration of the directors was as follows:

 
2002
 
2001
   
2002
 
2001
 
 
€’000
 
€’000
   
£’000
 
£’000
 










Salary
7 975
 
7 857
 
5 008
 
4 887
 
Allowances
515
 
662
   
323
 
412
 
Value of benefits in kind
800
 
959
   
503
 
597
 
Performance related payments
8 024
 
8 726
 
5 039
 
5 427
 










Total
17 314
 
18 204
 
10 873
 
11 323
 










Gains on exercise of share options (1)
3 037
 
2 180
 
1 907
 
1 356
 










The figures for 2001 include emoluments paid to Mr R D Brown and Mr A Kemner prior to their retirement in that year. The emoluments of the individual directors for 2002 (excluding gains on exercise of share options) were as follows:

 
Salary
 
Allowances
(10)
Value of benefits in
kind
(9)
Performance related payments
(7)
Total
2002
 
Total
2001
 
 
Equivalent totals
(8)
 

 
 
2002
 
2001
 
Paid in euros:
€’000
 
€’000
 
€’000
 
€’000
 
€’000
 
€’000
   
£’000
 
£’000
 


















A Burgmans (2)
1 210
 
29
 
141
 
1 301
2 681
2 262
 
1 684
 
1 407
 
P J Cescau (5)
975
 
12
 
170
 
1 048
2 205
2 565
 
1 385
1 595
 
A R van Heemstra
650
 
203
(4)
46
 
650
 
1 549
 
1 257
 
972
 
782
 


















                                   
Paid in pounds sterling:
£’000
 
£’000
 
£’000
 
£’000
 
£’000
 
£’000
   
€’000
 
€’000
 


















N W A FitzGerald (3)
940
 
99
 
47
 
1 011
2 097
1 925
 
3 340
3 095
 
A C Butler
510
 
4
 
21
 
510
 
1 045
990
   
1 664
1 592
 
K B Dadiseth
575
 
55
(11)
56
 
632
 
1 318
 
1 126
 
2 098
1 811
 
R H P Markham
535
 
9
 
23
 
555
 
1 122
 
1 087
 
1 787
1 748
 


















                           
Equivalent totals (’000)
(8)
                           

 
Paid in US dollars:
$’000
 
$’000
 
$’000
 
$’000
 
$’000
 
$’000
   
2002
 
2001
 


















C B Strauss (6)
1 000
 
5
 
196
 
670
 
1 871
2 301
 
€1 990
€2 570
 
                           
£1 250
£1 599
 



















(1) See pages 57 and 58.
(2) Chairman of NV.
(3) Chairman of PLC.
(4) Allowances include 197 thousand paid in respect of relocation costs taxed in the Netherlands.
(5) Excluded from the emoluments are incentive payments of 639 thousand paid in 2002 and 614 thousand paid in 2001 which relate to an appointment prior to joining the Board.
(6) Excluded from the emoluments are payments totalling $2 448 thousand paid in 2002 and $1 009 thousand paid in 2001 which relate to an appointment prior to joining the Board.
(7) Includes value of shares (bothbonus shares andmatching shares) awarded under the bonus scheme relating to 2002.
(8) Based on average rates for the year of £1.00 = 1.592, £1.00 = $1.497, $1.00 = 1.064 (2001: £1.00 =1.608, £1.00 = $1.439, $1.00 = 1.117).
(9) Includes value of benefits in kind relating to company provided accommodation, company cars and private medical insurance. All items are taxable in the country of residence of the directors concerned (apart from the value of accommodation provided for Netherlands based directors).
(10) Includes cash allowances in lieu of company car, entertaining allowance, financial planning assistance and an allowance, where applicable, for UK-based directors to compensate for the fact that part of their remuneration is paid in the Netherlands. All allowances are taxable in either the UK, the Netherlands or the US, apart from the entertaining allowance which is tax free.
(11) Includes long service award of £49 thousand.

For the years up to and including 1997, NV loaned the amount of taxation charged on the grant of options under Netherlands fiscal legislation to the recipients. Amounts were repaid on exercise. During 2002 all options in question were exercised and all outstanding loans were repaid. In 2001 loans of €0.03 million were outstanding.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

Remuneration report
57

 

Report of the Directors

No compensation for loss of office, payments for loss of office or other termination payments were paid to directors in 2002.

Directors share options
Details of the option plans under which directors and employees are able to acquire ordinary shares of NV and PLC are shown in note 29 on pages 103 to 111.

As at 28 February 2003 the directors and officers as a group held options to purchase the following ordinary shares:

594 795 NV shares of0.51
4 407 793 PLC shares of 1.4p

246 134 NV shares of0.51 of the New York Registry
706 828 PLC shares of 1.4p (held as 176 707 ADRs)

Options to acquire NV ordinary shares of 0.51 each and options to acquire PLC ordinary shares of 1.4p each were granted, exercised and held during 2002 as follows:

                                                          Options outstanding below market
price at end of year
      Options outstanding above market price at end of year    




















   
Name
       1 January €0.51/1.4p              Granted (g)              Exercised          31 December €0.51/1.4p            Range of dates for earliest and  latest exercise        Number           Weighted
average
exercise
 
price
          Number           Weighted
average
exercise
price
    




























                                                       
A Burgmans (a) 66 000     19 800     9 000     76 800     08.05.01 - 06.06.12     30 000     €51.00     46 800     €66.09  
  (b) 216     50     16     250     15.09.03 - 12.06.07     100     €55.34     150     €65.40  
  (c) 440 000     132 000     60 000     512 000     08.05.01 - 06.06.12     440 000     504p     72 000     660p  
  (d) 2 904             2 904     01.10.03 - 31.03.04             2 904     594p  




























                                                       
N W A FitzGerald (a) 84 000     21 600         105 600     02.06.00 - 06.06.12     48 000     €47.92     57 600     €66.64  
  (b) 200     50         250     15.09.03 - 12.06.07     100     €55.34     150     €65.40  
  (c) 955 392     144 000     353 092     746 300     29.05.99 - 06.06.12     602 300     471p     144 000     660p  
  (d) 3 543             3 543     01.10.03 - 31.03.06     2 382     425p     1 161     594p  




























                                                       
A C Butler (a) 52 502     13 500         66 002     02.06.00 - 06.06.12     30 002     €47.92     36 000     €66.64  
  (b) 150     50         200     01.06.04 - 12.06.07     50     €53.05     150     €65.40  
  (c) 588 212     90 000         678 212     07.06.98 - 06.06.12     588 212     411p     90 000     660p  
  (d) 4 652         4 652                            




























                                                       
P J Cescau (a) 49 143     14 250         63 393     08.05.01 - 06.06.12     18 750     €51.00     44 643     €66.25  
  (b) 50     50         100     30.05.04 - 12.06.07             100     €66.28  
  (c) 334 626     95 040         429 666     08.05.01 - 06.06.12     349 626     511p     80 040     657p  
  (e) 45 000             45 000     29.05.97 - 02.06.07     45 000     $38.84          
  (f) 100 192             100 192     03.06.98 - 02.06.07     100 192     $6.72          




























                                                       
K B Dadiseth (a) 30 750     11 850         42 600     02.06.00 - 06.06.12     21 750     €49.87     20 850     €66.71  
  (c) 222 240     79 000     2 992     298 248     10.06.97 - 06.06.12     264 248     476p     34 000     662p  
  (d)     2 744         2 744     01.10.07 - 31.03.08             2 744     603p  




























                                                       
A R van Heemstra (a) 45 750     13 050     9 000     49 800     08.05.01 - 06.06.12     27 750     €55.06     22 050     €67.95  
  (b) 50     50         100     30.05.04 - 12.06.07             100     €66.28  
  (c) 348 276     87 000     103 276     332 000     08.05.01 - 06.06.12     185 000     468p     147 000     621p  




























                                                       
R H P Markham (a) 50 250     13 050         63 300     02.06.00 - 06.06.12     27 750     €48.34     35 550     €66.63  
  (b) 200     50         250     15.09.03 - 12.06.07     100     €55.34     150     €65.40  
  (c) 367 292     87 000         454 292     06.12.99 - 06.06.12     367 292     474p     87 000     662p  
  (d) 3 283             3 283     01.10.04 - 31.03.05     3 283     514p          




























                                                       
C B Strauss (e) 172 200     19 800     7 200     184 800     10.06.94 - 02.06.12     165 000     $36.87     19 800     $72.28  
  (f) 380 000     132 000         512 000     03.06.98 - 02.06.12     452 000     $7.41     60 000     $10.85  




























       
(a) Options in NV shares under the Executive Plan. (b) Options in NV shares under the Netherlands Employee Option Plan.
(c) Options in PLC shares under the Executive Plan. (d) Options in PLC shares under the UK Employee Sharesave Plan.
(e) Options in NV New York shares under the Executive Plan.

(f)

Options in PLC shares in the form of American Depositary Receipts under the Executive Plan (1 ADR equivalent to 4 PLC shares).
(g) Granted in the year on the basis, where applicable, of earnings per share (BEIA) in the prior year.

The term ‘Executive Plan’ refers to options granted under the PLC, NV or NA Executive Option Plans (see page 106).

See also notes on page 58.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

58 Remuneration report

 

Supplementary table of options granted and exercised in 2002:

   Name         Granted (g)           Price       Exercised quantity             Exercise
price
          Market price
at
date of exercise
    
















A Burgmans (a) 18 000     €66.90     9 000     €42.79     €71.69  
    1 800     €67.85                    
  (b) 50     €67.90     16     €43.00     €68.50  
  (c) 120 000     583 p   60 000     407 p   633 p
    12 000     624 p                  
















N W A FitzGerald (a) 18 000     €66.90                    
    3 600     €67.85                    
  (b) 50     €67.90                    
  (c) 120 000     583 p   92 320     283 p   577 p
    24 000     624 p   59 112     254 p   577 p
                104 808     283 p   577 p
                96 852     307 p   577 p
















A C Butler (a) 11 250     €66.90                    
    2 250     €67.85                    
  (b) 50     €67.90                    
  (c) 75 000     583 p                  
    15 000     624 p                  
  (d)             4 652     371 p   589 p
















P J Cescau (a) 11 250     €66.90                    
    3 000     €67.85                    
  (b) 50     €67.90                    
  (c) 75 000     583 p                  
    20 040     624 p                  
















K B Dadiseth (a) 11 250     €66.90                    
    600     €67.85                    
  (c) 75 000     583 p   2 992     254 p   634 p
    4 000     624 p                  
  (d) 2 744     603 p                  
















A R van Heemstra (a) 11 250     €66.90     9 000     €42.79     €71.55  
    1 800     €67.85                    
  (b) 50     €67.90                    
  (c) 75 000     583 p   43 276     343 p   577 p
    12 000     624 p   60 000     407 p   630 p
















R H P Markham (a) 11 250     €66.90                    
    1 800     €67.85                    
  (b) 50     €67.90                    
  (c) 75 000     583 p                  
    12 000     624 p                  
















C B Strauss (e) 18 000     $59.00     7 200     $25.69     $58.34  
    1 800     $65.70                    
  (f) 120 000     $8.36                    
    12 000     $9.32                    
















No options lapsed unexercised during the year. The market price of the ordinary shares at the end of the year was for NV 58.55 and $61.71 and for PLC 591p and $38.25, and the range during the year was between 49.65 and72.20 and $50.10 and $66.90, and between 473p and 659p and $29.86 and $39.44 respectively. Options outstanding above and below the market prices at 31 December 2002 are set out in the table on page 57.

For footnotes please refer to page 57.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002



Back to Contents

Remuneration report
59

Report of the Directors

Directors conditional share awards under the TSR Long-Term Incentive Plan
Conditional rights to ordinary shares in PLC and NV were granted, vested or lapsed in 2002 as follows:

Name
   Share type
   
   1 January
    
    
   Granted
(1)   
    
  Grant price
(2)   
    
   Vested
    
    
   Lapsed
    
    
   31 December
    
    
Performance period
for 2002 award
    
    
End date of final performance period
 



























A Burgmans NV     6 472     5 980     583p    
 
 
    12 452    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  
  PLC     48 360     42 319     €66.90    
 
 
    90 679    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  



























N W A FitzGerald NV     6 472     5 980     583p    
 
 
    12 452    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  
  PLC     48 360     42 319     €66.90    
 
 
    90 679    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  



























A C Butler NV     4 045     3 737     583p    
 
 
    7 782    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  
  PLC     30 225     26 450     €66.90    
 
 
    56 675    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  



























P J Cescau NV     4 045     3 737     583p    
 
 
    7 782    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  
  PLC     30 225     26 450     €66.90    
 
 
    56 675    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  



























K B Dadiseth NV     4 045     3 737     583p    
 
 
    7 782    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  
  PLC     30 225     26 450     €66.90    
 
 
    56 675    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  



























A R van Heemstra NV     4 045     3 737     583p    
 
 
    7 782    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  
  PLC     30 225     26 450     €66.90    
 
 
    56 675    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  



























R H P Markham NV     4 045     3 737     583p    
 
 
    7 782    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  
  PLC     30 225     26 450     €66.90    
 
 
    56 675    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  



























C B Strauss NV(3)     3 223     2 977     $59.09    
 
 
    6 200    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  
  PLC(4)     23 580     21 032     $8.3625    
 
 
    44 612    
01/01/02-31/12/04
    31/12/04  



























                                                     
(1) Number of conditional rights to NV and PLC shares granted in 2002. The precise number of shares that will vest in March 2005 will depend on the TSR ranking of Unilever, during the performance period shown above, against a peer group of 20 comparator companies and will vary between 0% and 200% of the original number of conditional shares granted.
(2) Price of shares at date of grant on 21 March 2002.
(3) NV New York shares.
(4) The award was made in the form of American Depository Receipts (1 ADR equivalent to 4 PLC shares). The number of ADRs granted in 2002 was 5 258 (equivalent to 21 032 PLC shares) at a price of $33.45.

Advisory Directors
The Advisory Directors are not formally members of the Boards of NV and PLC and are therefore excluded when reference is made to directors in this report.

The remuneration of the Advisory Directors is decided by the Boards. Advisory Directors receive an annual fee and are reimbursed expenses incurred in attending meetings. They do not receive any performance related bonuses, pension provisions, share options or other forms of benefit as Advisory Directors. They do not have service contracts. The annual fees paid to each Advisory Director in 2002 were as follows:

Advisory Directors fees paid in 2002:

Paid in euros      
Name Fees €  



B Collomb 55  000  
Professor W Dik 55  000  
O Fanjul 55  000  
F H Fentener van Vlissingen 55  000  
H Kopper 55  000  
H O C R Ruding 27  500  
J van der Veer 41  250  



 
Paid in pounds    
Name Fees  £   



Lord Brittan 35  000  
Lady Chalker 35  000  
C X Gonzalez 35  000  
Senator G J Mitchell 35  000  
C R Shoemate 35  000  
Lord Simon 35  000  



 

 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

60  Remuneration report

In addition, Advisory Directors benefited directly or indirectly from the following payments made in 2002:

Lady Chalker: £40 800 paid to Africa Matters Limited for advice provided to Unilevers Africa Business Group by her and other consultants from that company;

C X Gonzalez: US $15 000 paid to him for advice provided to Unilevers Latin America Region Advisory Council; and

Senator G J Mitchell: US $75 000 paid to him for advice provided to Unilevers North American businesses.

As at 28 February 2003 the interests of the Advisory Directors in the share capital of NV and PLC were as follows:

 
NV
(1)
PLC(2)





Lord Brittan        
  
Lady Chalker       2 526  
B Collomb 111     
  
Professor W Dik        
  
O Fanjul 692     
  
F H Fentener van Vlissingen 10  385    
  
C X Gonzalez       60 000
(3)
H Kopper        
  
Senator G J Mitchell 1  000    
  
C R Shoemate 2  000    
  
Lord Simon       2 857  
J van der Veer 5 600    
  





Aggregate interests 19  788   65 383  





 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1) Ordinary €0.51 shares of NV.
(2) Ordinary 1.4p shares of PLC.
(3) Held as American Depositary Receipts (ADRs).

As at 28 February 2002, the aggregate interests of the Advisory Directors in the share capital of NV and PLC were 14 188 Ordinary

0.51 shares of NV and 5 383 Ordinary 1.4p shares of PLC.

The voting rights of the Advisory Directors are the same as for other holders of the class of share indicated.

The Report has been approved by the Boards and has been signed on their behalf by the Joint Secretaries, J A A van der Bijl and S G Williams.

 

By order of the Board

 

J A A van der Bijl
S G Williams

Joint Secretaries of Unilever N.V. and Unilever PLC

4 March 2003

Auditable part of remuneration report
In compliance with the UK Directors Remuneration Report Regulation 2002, and under Title 9, Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, the auditable part of the remuneration report comprises Directors pensions on pages 52 and 53,Directors interests: share capital on page 55, Directors emoluments on page 56,Directors share options on pages 57 and 58, Directors conditional share awards under the TSR Long-Term Incentive Plan on page 59 and Advisory Directors on pages 59 and 60.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Report of the Audit Committee 61

Report of the Directors

The role of the Audit Committee is to assist the Unilever Board in fulfilling its oversight responsibilities regarding the integrity of Unilever’s financial statements, risk management and internal control, compliance with legal and regulatory requirements, the external auditors’ performance, qualifications and independence, and the performance of the internal audit function. During the year ended 31 December 2002 the principal activities of the Committee were as follows:

Financial Statements
The Committee considered reports from the Financial Director on the quarterly and annual financial statements. It also reviewed proposed changes in accounting principles in response to the changes in Netherlands, UK and US law and UK GAAP.

Audit of the Annual Accounts
PricewaterhouseCoopers, Unilevers external auditors, reported in depth to the Committee on the scope and outcome of the annual audit, and managements response. Their reports included accounting matters, governance and control, and accounting developments.

Risk Management and Internal Control Arrangements
The Committee reviewed Unilever’s overall approach to risk management and control, and its processes, outcomes and disclosure, including specifically:

Corporate Audits interim and year-end reports on the Status of Risk Management & Control, and managements response.
   
The Corporate Risk Committees annual report, which included its recommendation for the Board’s statement on internal control, its analysis of the 2002 risk assessment process, and the corporate risks identified for 2003.
   
The reports from the Code of Business Principles Compliance Committee.
   
   Controls over trade marketing investments.

External Auditors
The report from PricewaterhouseCoopers confirming their independence and objectivity was reviewed by the Committee. It also reviewed the audit, audit-related, tax and consulting services provided by PricewaterhouseCoopers, and compliance with Unilevers policy, introduced in January 2002, under which the types of engagements for which the external auditors can be used are prescribed.

The Committee oversaw the external auditor tender process which was conducted during the year, and made its formal recommendation to the Board, which was adopted. (See page 45 for further details of the tender.)

Internal Audit Function
The Committee engaged in discussion and review of the Corporate Audit Departments audit plan for the year, together with its budget and resource requirements.

Audit Committee Charter
The Committees charter has been updated to reflect recent developments in corporate governance in the UK, the European Union and the US. The revised charter enhances the Committees role and responsibilities, and in particular makes it responsible for overseeing Unilevers relations with the external auditors.

The Audit Committee Charter can be viewed on Unilevers external website at www.unilever.com.

 


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

62 Financial statements Contents

 

Statement of directors’ responsibilities 63
Report of independent auditors 65
Accounting information and policies 66
Consolidated profit and loss account 69
Consolidated statement of total recognised
   gains and losses 70
Consolidated cash flow statement 70
Consolidated balance sheet 71
Notes to the consolidated accounts 72
   1 Segmental information 72
   2 Operating costs 77
   3 Staff costs and employees 77
   4 Exceptional items 77
   5 Interest 78
   6 Taxation on profit on ordinary activities 78
   7 Combined earnings per share 79
   8 Dividends on ordinary capital 80
   9 Goodwill and intangible assets 80
   10 Tangible fixed assets 81
   11 Fixed investments 81
   12 Stocks 82
   13 Debtors 82
   14 Net funds/(debt) 83
   15 Financial instruments 85
   16 Trade and other creditors 86
   17 Pensions and similar obligations 87
   18 Deferred taxation 94
   19 Restructuring and other provisions 95
   20 Capital and reserves 96
   21 Called up share capital 97
   22 Profit retained 98
   23 Other reserves 98
   24 Commitments and contingent liabilities 99
   25 Acquisition and disposal of group companies 99
   26 Reconciliation of group operating profit to  
   operating cash flows 101  
   27 Analysis of cash flows for headings netted in the cash flow statement
   28 Analysis of net funds/(debt) 103
   29 Equity-based compensation plans 103
   30 Summarised accounts of the NV and PLC
   parts of the Group 112
Five year record 113
Additional information for US investors 118
Principal group companies and fixed investments 128
Company accounts – Unilever N.V. 132
Notes to the company accounts – Unilever N.V. 133
Further statutory information – Unilever N.V. 134
Company accounts – Unilever PLC 135
Notes to the company accounts – Unilever PLC 136
Further statutory information and other
   information – Unilever PLC 137

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Statement of directors responsibilities
63

 

Financial Statements

 

Annual accounts
The directors are required by Title 9, Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985 to prepare accounts for each financial year which give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Unilever Group, NV and PLC as at the end of the financial year and of the profit or loss for that year.

The directors consider that in preparing the accounts, the Group, NV and PLC have used the most appropriate accounting policies, consistently applied and supported by reasonable and prudent judgements and estimates, and that all United Kingdom accounting standards which they consider to be applicable have been followed, except as noted under Accounting standards on page 66.

The directors have responsibility for ensuring that NV and PLC keep accounting records which disclose with reasonable accuracy their financial position and which enable the directors to ensure that the accounts comply with the relevant legislation. They also have a general responsibility for taking such steps as are reasonably open to them to safeguard the assets of the Group and to prevent and detect fraud and other irregularities.

This statement, which should be read in conjunction with the Report of independent auditors set out on page 65, is made with a view to distinguishing for shareholders the respective responsibilities of the directors and of the auditors in relation to the accounts.

A copy of the financial statements of the Unilever Group is placed on our website at www.unilever.com. The maintenance and integrity of the website is the responsibility of the directors, and the work carried out by the auditors does not involve consideration of these matters. Accordingly, the auditors accept no responsibility for any changes that may have occurred to the financial statements since they were initially placed on the website. Legislation in the United Kingdom and the Netherlands governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.

Going concern
The directors continue to adopt the going concern basis in preparing the accounts. This is because the directors, after making enquiries and following a review of the Groups budget for 2003 and 2004, including cash flows and borrowing facilities, consider that the Group has adequate resources to continue in operation for the foreseeable future.

Internal and disclosure controls and procedures
Unilever has a well established control environment, which is well documented and regularly reviewed. This incorporates risk management, internal control procedures and disclosure controls and procedures which are designed to provide reasonable assurance that assets are safeguarded, the risks facing the business are being controlled and all information required to be disclosed is reported to the Groups senior management, including where appropriate the Chairmen and Financial Director, within the required timeframe. Our procedures cover financial, operational, social and environmental risks and regulatory matters. The Boards of NV and PLC have also established a clear organisational structure, including delegation of appropriate authorities. The Groups control environment is supported through a Code of Business Principles, which sets standards of professionalism and integrity for its operations worldwide.

The Boards have overall responsibility for establishing key procedures designed to achieve systems of internal control and disclosure control and for reviewing and evaluating their effectiveness. The day-to-day responsibility for implementation of these procedures and ongoing monitoring of risk and the effectiveness of controls rests with the Groups senior management at individual operating company and Business Group level. Business Groups, each of which has its own Risk Committee, review, on an ongoing basis, the risks faced by their group and the related internal control arrangements and provide written reports to the Corporate Risk Committee. This is comprised mainly of Board members and chaired by the Financial Director. The Corporate Risk Committee is a committee of the Board and maintains oversight, on behalf of the Boards, of the controls in place to identify, evaluate and manage risk. It reports regularly to the Boards, which retain ultimate responsibility, and to the Audit Committee.

Unilevers corporate internal audit function plays a key role in providing an objective view and continuous reassurance of the effectiveness of the risk management and related control systems throughout Unilever to both operating management and the Boards. The Group has an independent Audit Committee, entirely comprised of Advisory Directors. This Committee meets regularly with corporate internal audit and the external auditors.

Unilever has a comprehensive budgeting system with an annual budget approved by the Boards, which is regularly reviewed and updated. Performance is monitored against budget and the previous year through monthly and quarterly reporting routines. The Group reports to shareholders quarterly.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

64 Statement of directors responsibilities

 

Unilever’s system of risk management has been in place throughout 2002 and up to the date of this report, and complies with the recommendations of ‘Internal Control – Guidance for Directors on the Combined Code’, published by the Internal Control Working Party of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England & Wales in September 1999. The Boards have carried out an annual review of the effectiveness of the systems of risk management and internal control during 2002, and have ensured that the necessary actions have been taken to address any weaknesses or deficiencies arising out of that review.

Based on an evaluation by the Board, which comprises the Chairmen, the Financial Director and the Groups senior management, each Chairman and the Financial Director concluded that the design and operation of the Groups disclosure controls and procedures as at 31 December 2002 were reasonably effective and that subsequently there have been no significant changes in the Groups internal controls or in other factors that could significantly affect those controls.

It is Unilevers policy to bring acquired companies within the Groups governance procedures as soon as is practicable and, in any event, by the end of the first full year of operation.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Report of independent auditors
65

Financial Statements

 

Report of the auditors to the members of Unilever N.V. and Unilever PLC
We have audited the accounts, which have been prepared under the historical cost convention, set out on page 66 to 112, 118 to 133 and 135 to 136. We have also audited the auditable part of the directors remuneration report as set out on page 60.

Respective responsibilities of directors and auditors
As described on pages 63 and 64, the directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F. This includes responsibility for preparing the accounts in accordance with applicable accounting standards. Our responsibility is to audit the accounts in accordance with applicable law, auditing standards and listing rules in the Netherlands and United Kingdom.

We report to you our opinion as to whether the accounts give a true and fair view and are properly prepared in accordance with Title 9, Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985. We also report whether the auditable part of the directors remuneration report is properly prepared in accordance with the applicable requirements in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom. We would also report to you if, in our opinion, the directors report was not consistent with the accounts, if proper accounting records had not been kept, if we had not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit, or if information required regarding directors remuneration and transactions were not disclosed.

We read the other information contained in the Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F and consider the implications for our audit report if we become aware of any material misstatements or inconsistencies with the accounts.

As auditors of Unilever PLC we review whether the statement on pages 44 and 45 reflects the Companys compliance with the seven provisions of the Combined Code specified for our review by the United Kingdoms Financial Services Authority and we report if it does not. We are not required to consider whether the directors statements on internal control cover all risks and controls or to form an opinion on the effectiveness of the Groups corporate governance procedures or its risk and control procedures.

Basis of opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom and the United States. An audit includes an examination, on a test basis, of evidence relevant to the amounts and disclosures in the accounts and the auditable part of the directors remuneration report. It also includes an assessment of the most important estimates and judgements made by the directors in the preparation of the accounts, and of whether the accounting policies are appropriate to the Groups circumstances, consistently applied and adequately disclosed.

We planned and performed our audit so as to obtain all the information and explanations which we considered necessary in order to provide us with sufficient evidence to give reasonable assurance that the accounts and the auditable part of the directors remuneration report are free from material misstatement, whether caused by fraud or other irregularity or error. In forming our opinion we also evaluated the overall adequacy of the presentation of information in the accounts.

Netherlands and United Kingdom opinion
In our opinion, the accounts give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Unilever Group, Unilever N.V. and Unilever PLC at 31 December 2002 and of the profit, total recognised gains and cash flows of the Group for the year then ended. In our opinion the accounts of the Unilever Group, and of Unilever N.V. and Unilever PLC respectively, have been properly prepared in accordance with Title 9, Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985. In our opinion, the auditable part of the directors remuneration report has been properly prepared in accordance with the applicable requirements in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom.

United States opinion
In our opinion, the accounts present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Unilever Group at 31 December 2002 and 2001, and the results of its operations, total recognised gains and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2002, in accordance with the accounting information and policies on pages 66 to 68.

The accounting principles applied vary in certain significant respects from accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. The effect of the major differences in the determination of net profit and capital and reserves is shown on pages 118 and 119.

As discussed in note 18 to the consolidated accounts, the Group changed its method of accounting for deferred taxes in 2002 in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United Kingdom. The change has been accounted for by restating comparative information at 31 December 2001 and 2000, and for the years then ended.

PricewaterhouseCoopers Accountants N.V.
Rotterdam, The Netherlands
As auditors of Unilever N.V.

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Chartered Accountants and Registered Auditors
London, England
As auditors of Unilever PLC

4 March 2003


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

 

66 Accounting information and policies

 

Unilever
The two parent companies, NV and PLC, together with their group companies, operate as nearly as is practicable as a single entity (the Unilever Group, also referred to as Unilever or the Group). NV and PLC have the same directors and are linked by a series of agreements, including an Equalisation Agreement, which are designed so that the position of the shareholders of both companies is as nearly as possible the same as if they held shares in a single company.

The Equalisation Agreement provides for both companies to adopt the same accounting principles and requires as a general rule the dividends and other rights and benefits (including rights on liquidation) attaching to each Fl. 12 (5.445) nominal of ordinary share capital of NV to be equal in value at the relevant rate of exchange to the dividends and other rights and benefits attaching to each £1 nominal of ordinary share capital of PLC, as if each such unit of capital formed part of the ordinary capital of one and the same company. For additional information please refer to Control of Unilever on page 138.

Basis of consolidation
Because of the operational and contractual arrangements referred to above and the internal participating interests set out in note 21 on page 97, NV and PLC and their group companies constitute a single group under Netherlands and United Kingdom legislation for the purposes of presenting consolidated accounts. Accordingly, the accounts of the Unilever Group are presented by both NV and PLC as their respective consolidated accounts. These accounts are supplemented in notes 22 and 23 on page 98 and note 30 on page 112 by additional information for the NV and PLC parts of the Group in which group companies are consolidated according to respective ownership.

Companies legislation
The consolidated accounts of the Unilever Group comply with Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985. The consolidated accounts of the Unilever Group also comply with accounting standards generally accepted in the United Kingdom, as allowed by Article 362.1 of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, unless such standards conflict with the Civil Code in the Netherlands which would in such case prevail. The company accounts, the notes to those accounts and the further statutory information given for each of NV and PLC comply with legislation in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom respectively. As explained under Group companies below and on page 67, in order to give a true and fair view, the presentation of the consolidated capital and reserves differs from that specified by the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985.

Accounting standards
The accounts are prepared under the historical cost convention and comply in all material respects with legislation in the Netherlands and with United Kingdom Accounting Standards.

The accounting policies of the Unilever Group are set out on pages 66 to 68. Our accounting policy for the treatment of exceptional items is given on page 77. Material variations

from United States generally accepted accounting principles are set out on pages 118 to 127.

United Kingdom Urgent Issues Task Force Abstracts 13 and 17 (UITFs 13 and 17) require that NV or PLC shares held by employee trusts to satisfy options should be classified by the sponsoring company as fixed assets, and, as explained in note 29 on page 111, that certain costs in relation to these shares be recognised in the profit and loss account. Netherlands law requires such shares and certain related costs to be accounted for within capital and reserves. In order to comply with Netherlands law and the Equalisation Agreement, the requirements of UITF 13 and certain aspects of UITF 17 have not been followed. All shares held internally are accounted for in accordance with Netherlands law. The effects of this departure are shown in note 23 on page 98 and note 29 on page 111.

United Kingdom Financial Reporting Standard 17 Retirement Benefits (FRS 17) mandates that certain disclosures relating to retirement benefits be made in financial statements for accounting periods ending on or after 22 June 2001. These disclosures are shown in note 17 on page 89. Unilever will adopt the full requirements of the standard, which will change the basis of accounting for retirement benefits, from 1 January 2003. This will have a significant impact on Unilevers reported results.

United Kingdom Financial Reporting Standard 19 (FRS 19) Deferred Tax requires that full provision be made for most timing differences between the recognition of profits for accounting purposes and the recognition of profits for tax purposes. Prior to the implementation of the standard, Unilever used a form of full provisioning for such timing differences and therefore the standard has been adopted by the Group for the year ended 31 December 2002 with no material impact on reported net profit. The effect of the implementation of this standard on the balance sheet is shown in note 18 on page 94 and note 20 on page 96.

Recent changes in reporting requirements under US GAAP are discussed on page 122.

OECD Guidelines
In preparing its Annual Review and Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F Unilever adheres to the disclosure recommendations of the OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises.

Group companies
Group companies are those companies in whose share capital NV or PLC holds an interest directly or indirectly, and whose consolidation is required for the accounts to give a true and fair view.

In order that the consolidated accounts should present a true and fair view, it is necessary to differ from the presentational requirements of the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985 by including amounts attributable to both NV and PLC shareholders in the capital and reserves shown in the balance sheet. The Companies Act would require presentation of the capital and reserves attributable



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Accounting information and policies
67

 

Financial Statements

 

to NV and PLC shareholders as minority interests in the respective consolidated accounts of PLC and NV. This presentation would not give a true and fair view of the effect of the Equalisation Agreement, under which the position of all shareholders is as nearly as possible the same as if they held shares in a single company.

Net profit and result for the year retained are presented on a combined basis on page 69, with the net profit attributable to NV and PLC shareholders shown separately. Movements in profit retained are analysed between those attributable to NV and PLC shareholders in note 22 on page 98.

Foreign currencies
Exchange differences arising in the accounts of individual companies are dealt with in their respective profit and loss accounts. Those arising on trading transactions are taken to operating profit; those arising on cash, current investments and borrowings are classified as interest.

In preparing the consolidated accounts, the profit and loss account, the cash flow statement and all other movements in assets and liabilities are translated at annual average rates of exchange. The balance sheet, other than the ordinary share capital of NV and PLC, is translated at year-end rates of exchange. In the case of hyper-inflationary economies, the accounts are adjusted to remove the influences of inflation before being translated.

The ordinary share capital of NV and PLC is translated at the rate contained in the Equalisation Agreement of £1 = Fl. 12 (equivalent to5.445). The difference between this and the value derived by applying the year-end rate of exchange is taken to other reserves (see note 23 on page 98).

The effects of exchange rate changes during the year on net assets at the beginning of the year are recorded as a movement in profit retained, as is the difference between profit of the year retained at average rates of exchange and at year-end rates of exchange.

Goodwill and intangible assets
No value is attributed to internally generated intangible assets. Goodwill (being the difference between the fair value of consideration paid for new interests in group companies, joint ventures and associated companies and the fair value of the Groups share of their net assets at the date of acquisition) and identifiable intangible assets purchased after 1 January 1998 are capitalised and amortised in the profit and loss account over the period of their expected useful life, up to a maximum of 20 years. Periods in excess of five years are used only where the directors are satisfied that the life of these assets will clearly exceed that period. Goodwill and intangible assets purchased prior to 1 January 1998 were written off in the year of acquisition as a movement in profits retained.

On disposal of a business acquired prior to 1 January 1998, purchased goodwill written off on acquisition is reinstated in arriving at the profit or loss on disposal.

The treatment of goodwill and intangibles under US GAAP is discussed on pages 118 to 120.

Goodwill and intangible assets are subject to review for impairment in accordance with United Kingdom Financial Reporting Standard (FRS) 11 Impairment of Fixed Assets and Goodwill and United States Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) 142Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets. Any impairment is charged to the profit and loss account as it arises.

Tangible fixed assets
Tangible fixed assets are stated at cost less depreciation. Depreciation is provided on a straight-line basis at percentages of cost based on the expected average useful lives of the assets. Estimated useful lives by major class of assets are as follows:

Freehold buildings  
33-40 years
(no depreciation on freehold land)  
Leasehold land and buildings
*33-40 years
Plant and equipment  
3-20 years
Motor vehicles  
3-6 years
* or life of lease if less than 33 years    

Tangible fixed assets are subject to review for impairment in accordance with FRS 11 and United States SFAS 144 Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets. Any impairment is charged to the profit and loss account as it arises.

Current cost information is given in note 10 on page 81.

Fixed investments
Joint ventures are undertakings in which the Group has a long-term participating interest and which are jointly controlled by the Group and one or more other parties. Associated companies are undertakings in which the Group has a participating interest and is able to exercise significant influence.

Interests in joint ventures and associated companies are stated in the consolidated balance sheet at the Groups share of their aggregate assets and liabilities.

Other fixed investments are stated at cost less any amounts written off to reflect a permanent impairment.

Current assets
Stocks are valued at the lower of cost and estimated net realisable value. Cost is mainly average cost, and comprises direct costs and, where appropriate, a proportion of production overheads.

Debtors are stated after deducting adequate provision for doubtful debts.

Current investments are liquid funds temporarily invested and are stated at their realisable value. The difference between this and their original cost is taken to interest in the profit and loss account.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

68 Accounting information and policies

 

Retirement benefits
The expected costs of providing retirement pensions under defined benefit plans, as well as the costs of other post-retirement benefits, are charged to the profit and loss account over the periods benefiting from the employees services. Variations from expected cost are normally spread over the average remaining service lives of current employees.

Contributions to defined contribution pension plans are charged to the profit and loss account as incurred.

Liabilities arising under defined benefit plans are either externally funded or provided for in the consolidated balance sheet. Any difference between the charge to the profit and loss account in respect of funded plans and the contributions payable to each plan is recorded in the balance sheet as a prepayment or provision.

Deferred taxation
Full provision is made for deferred taxation on all significant timing differences arising from the recognition of items for taxation purposes in different periods from those in which they are included in the Group accounts. Full provision is made at the rates of tax prevailing at the year end unless future rates have been enacted or substantively enacted. Deferred tax assets and liabilities have not been discounted.

Provision is made for taxation which will become payable if retained profits of group companies and joint ventures are distributed to the parent companies only to the extent that we are committed to such distributions.

Provisions
Provisions are recognised when either a legal or constructive obligation, as a result of a past event, exists at the balance sheet date and where the amount of the obligation can be reasonably estimated.

Derivative financial instruments
The types of derivative financial instruments used by Unilever are described in note 15 on pages 85 and 86 and in the Financial review on pages 37 to 39. Hedge accounting, as described below, is applied.

Changes in the value of forward foreign exchange contracts are recognised in the results in the same period as changes in the values of the assets and liabilities they are intended to hedge. Interest payments and receipts arising from interest rate derivatives such as swaps and forward rate agreements are matched to those arising from underlying debt and investment positions.

Payments made or received in respect of the early termination of derivative financial instruments are spread over the original life of the instrument so long as the underlying exposure continues to exist.

Research, development and market support costs
Expenditure on research and development and on market support costs such as advertising is charged against the profit of the year in which it is incurred.

Group turnover and Turnover
Group turnover comprises sales of goods and services after deduction of discounts and sales taxes. It includes sales to joint ventures and associated companies but does not include sales by joint ventures and associated companies or sales between group companies. Turnover includes the Group share of the turnover of joint ventures, but does not include our share of the turnover of associates.

Revenue is recognised when the risks and rewards of the underlying products and services have been substantially transferred to the customer.

Transfer pricing
The preferred method for determining transfer prices for own manufactured goods is to take the market price. Where there is no market price, the companies concerned follow established transfer pricing guidelines, where available, or else engage in arms length negotiations.

Trademarks owned by the parent companies and used by operating companies are, where appropriate, licensed in return for royalties or a fee.

General services provided by central advisory departments, business groups, divisions and research laboratories are charged to operating companies on the basis of fees.

Leases
Lease payments, which are principally in respect of operating leases, are charged to the profit and loss account on a straight-line basis over the lease term, or over the period between rent reviews where these exist.

Shares held by employee share trusts
The assets and liabilities of certain PLC trusts, NV and group companies which purchase and hold NV and PLC shares to satisfy options granted are included in the Group accounts. The book value of shares held is deducted from capital and reserves, and trust borrowings are included in the Groups borrowings. The costs of the trusts are included in the results of the Group. These shares are excluded from the calculation of earnings per share.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Consolidated profit and loss account 69
   For the year ended 31 December 
Unilever Group
 
 
Financial Statements
 
  million
2002
  million
2001
  million
2000
 







Turnover 1 48 760   52 206   48 066  
             
Less: Share of turnover of joint ventures 1 (490 ) (692 ) (484 )







             
Group turnover 1 48 270   51 514   47 582  
             
Cost of sales 2 (24 030 ) (26 962 ) (25 221 )







             
Gross profit 24 240   24 552   22 361  
             
Distribution, selling and administrative costs 2 (19 199 ) (19 378 ) (19 180 )







             
Group operating profit 1 5 041   5 174   3 181  
             
   Group operating profit BEIA 1 7 165   7 149   5 729  
   Exceptional items (879 ) (588 ) (2 113 )
   Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles 1 (1 245 ) (1 387 ) (435 )
             
Add: Share of operating profit of joint ventures 84   84   57  







             
Operating profit 1 5 125   5 258   3 238  
             
   Operating profit BEIA 1 7 260   7 269   5 794  
   Exceptional items 4 (874 ) (588 ) (2 113 )
   Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (1 261 ) (1 423 ) (443 )
             
Share of operating profit of associates 1 34      
Other income from fixed investments 11 (7 ) 12   (4 )
Interest 5 (1 173 ) (1 646 ) (632 )







             
Profit on ordinary activities before taxation 3 979   3 624   2 602  
Taxation on profit on ordinary activities 6 (1 538 ) (1 547 ) (1 282 )







             
Profit on ordinary activities after taxation 2 441   2 077   1 320  
Minority interests (312 ) (239 ) (215 )







             
Net profit 2 129   1 838   1 105  
             
Attributable to: NV 22 1 681   817   675  
  PLC 22 448   1 021   430  
Dividends (1 701 ) (1 581 ) (1 458 )
             
Preference dividends (42 ) (51 ) (44 )
Dividends on ordinary capital 8 (1 659 ) (1 530 ) (1 414 )







Result for the year retained 428   257   (353 )







             







Combined earnings per share 7            
Euros per €0.51 of ordinary capital 2.14   1.82   1.07  
Euro cents per 1.4p of ordinary capital 32.05   27.27   16.08  
             
On a diluted basis the figures would be:            
Euros per €0.51 of ordinary capital 2.07   1.77   1.05  
Euro cents per 1.4p of ordinary capital 31.10   26.54   15.69  







All amounts are related to continuing operations as defined by United Kingdom Financial Reporting Standard 3.

References in the consolidated profit and loss account, consolidated statement of total recognised gains and losses, consolidated cash flow statement and consolidated balance sheet relate to notes on pages 72 to 112, which form an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

Accounting policies of the Unilever Group are set out on pages 66 to 68.

Variations from United States generally accepted accounting principles and Regulation S-X are outlined on pages 118 to 127.

In accordance with Article 402 of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, the profit and loss account of the entity NV on page 132 mentions only the income from fixed investments after taxation and other income and expenses as separate items.

Amounts reported in 2000 for exceptional items within operating profit and for taxation on profit on ordinary activities have been restated to comply with the requirements of FRS 19. See note 18 on page 94.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

70 Consolidated statement of total
  recognised gains and losses
  For the year ended 31 December
Unilever Group
 
  million
2002
  million
2001
  million
2000
 







Net profit 2 129   1 838   1 105  
Unrealised gain on partial disposal of a group company 25 56      
Currency retranslation (1 582 ) (1 065 ) (247 )







Total recognised gains for the year 603   773   858  
Adjustment related to prior year restatement 18 (202 )    







Total recognised gains since last annual accounts 401   773   858  







Amounts reported against currency retranslation in 2000 and 2001 have been restated to comply with the requirements of FRS 19. See note 18 on page 94.

Consolidated cashflow statement
For the year ended 31 December
Unilever Group
 
  million
2002
  million
2001
  million
2000
 







Cash flow from group operating activities 26 7 883   7 497   6 738  
             
Dividends from joint ventures 83   82   38  
Returns on investments and servicing of finance 27 (1 386 ) (1 887 ) (798 )
Taxation (1 817 ) (2 205 ) (1 734 )
Capital expenditure and financial investment 27 (1 706 ) (1 358 ) (1 061 )
Acquisitions and disposals 27 1 755   3 477   (27 373 )
Dividends paid on ordinary share capital (1 580 ) (1 420 ) (1 365 )







             
Cash flow before management of liquid resources and financing 3 232   4 186   (25 555 )
Management of liquid resources 27 (592 ) 1 106   2 464  
Financing 27 (2 591 ) (5 098 ) 22 902  







Increase/(decrease) in cash in the period 49   194   (189 )







Reconciliation of cashflow to movement in net funds/(debt)

  million
2002
  million
2001
  million
2000
 







Net funds/(debt) at 1 January 28 (23 199 ) (26 468 )  684  







Increase/(decrease) in cash in the period 49   194   (189 )
Cash flow from (increase)/decrease in borrowings 2 600 5 095   (22 920 ) 
Cash flow from increase/(decrease) in liquid resources 592   (1 106 )  (2 464 ) 







Change in net funds resulting from cash flows 3 241 4 183   (25 573 ) 
Borrowings within group companies acquired (77 ) (1 ) (3 113 ) 
Borrowings within group companies sold 20   3   2  
Liquid resources within group companies acquired     13  
Liquid resources within group companies sold (1 )    
Non-cash movements 1 467 (408 ) 455  
Currency retranslation 1 583 (508 ) 1 064  







(Increase)/decrease in net debt in the period 6 233 3 269   (27 152 ) 







Net funds/(debt) at 31 December 28 (16 966 ) (23 199 )  (26 468 ) 







Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Consolidated balance sheet 71
   As at 31 December 
Unilever Group
 
 
Financial Statements
 
  million
2002
  million
2001
 





Fixed assets 28 389   35 088  
Goodwill and intangible assets 9 20 274   24 964  
Tangible fixed assets 10 7 436   9 240  
Fixed investments 11 679   884  
         
   Interest in joint ventures 11 274   708  
   Interest in associates 11 1    
   Other fixed investments 11 404   176  
Current assets        
Stocks12 4 500   5 343  
Debtors13 8 231   10 034  
   Debtors due within one year 13 5 875   7 185  
   Debtors due after more than one year 13 2 356   2 849  
Current investments 14 1 226   439  
Cash at bank and in hand 14 2 252   1 862  





Total current assets 16 209   17 678  
Creditors due within one year (20 602 ) (23 212 )
Borrowings 14 (9 511 ) (11 279  
Trade and other creditors 16 (11 091 ) (11 933 )
         
Net current assets (4 393 ) (5 534 )





Total assets less current liabilities 23 996   29 554  





Creditors due after more than one year 11 574   15 026  
Borrowings 14 10 933   14 221  
Trade and other creditors 16 641   805  
Provisions for liabilities and charges 5 927   6 871  
Pensions and similar obligations 17 4 220   4 602  
Deferred taxation18 504   910  
Restructuring and other provisions 19 1 188   1 359  
Interest in associates 11 15    
Minority interests 628   664  
Capital and reserves 20 5 867   6 993  
Attributable to: NV: Called up share capital 21 420   420  
  Share premium account 1 397   1 397  
  Other reserves 23 (1 498 ) (1 077 )
  Profit retained 22 5 381   4 149  





  5 700   4 889  





PLC:    Called up share capital 21 222   222  
  Share premium account 144   154  
  Other reserves 23 (595 ) (540 )
  Profit retained 22 396   2 268  





  167   2 104  





Total capital employed 23 996   29 554  





Capital and reserves include amounts relating to preference shares in NV which under United Kingdom Financial Reporting Standard 4 are classified as non-equity. Minority interests in group companies are substantially all equity interests.

The 2001 amounts for goodwill, debtors due after more than one year, provisions for deferred taxation and profit retained have been restated to comply with the requirements of FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.

Commitments and contingent liabilities are shown in note 24 on page 99.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

72 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

1 Segmental information

  million

Europe
  € million
North
America
  € million
Africa, Middle
East & Turkey
  € million
Asia &
Pacific
  € million
Latin
America
  million

Total
 
Analysis by geographical area













2002                        
Group turnover (a) 19 573   12 446   3 139   7 679   5 433   48 270  
Share of turnover of joint ventures 84   122   86   186   12   490  













Turnover (a) 19 657   12 568   3 225   7 865   5 445   48 760  













Group operating profit BEIA 2 990   1 995   341   1 080   759   7 165  
Exceptional items (729 ) (66 ) (39 ) 14   (59 ) (879 )
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (511 ) (494 ) (16 ) (17 ) (207 ) (1 245 )













Group operating profit 1 750   1 435   286   1 077   493   5 041
Share of operating profit of joint ventures 22   32   9   21     84  













Operating profit 1 772   1 467   295   1 098   493   5 125













Operating profit BEIA (b) (f) 3 006   2 027   353   1 115   759   7 260













Share of operating profit of associates (c) 12   14   1   5   2   34  













Net operating assets (d) 9 954   8 945   1 097   1 124   3 614   24 734


























2001                        
Group turnover (a) 20 119   13 767   3 191   7 846   6 591   51 514  
Share of turnover of joint ventures 101   113   264   200   14   692  













Turnover (a) 20 220   13 880   3 455   8 046   6 605   52 206  













Group operating profit BEIA 2 946   1 941   346   1 045   871   7 149  
Exceptional items 254   (285 ) (139 ) (157 ) (261 ) (588 )
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (511 ) (564 ) (4 ) (26 ) (282 ) (1 387 ) 













Group operating profit 2 689   1 092   203   862   328   5 174  
Share of operating profit of joint ventures 21   32   12   18   1   84  













Operating profit 2 710   1 124   215   880   329   5 258  













Operating profit BEIA (b) (f) 2 967   1 973   380   1 077   872   7 269  













Net operating assets (d) 11 243   12 091   1 082   1 525   6 256   32 197  


























2000                        
Group turnover (a) 18 967   11 631   3 296   8 038   5 650   47 582  
Share of turnover of joint ventures 108   77   216   53   30   484  













Turnover (a) 19 075   11 708   3 512   8 091   5 680   48 066  













Group operating profit BEIA 2 402   1 476   338   901   612   5 729  
Exceptional items (d) (566 ) (1 249 ) (16 ) (109 ) (173 ) (2 113 )
Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (143 ) (179 ) (1 ) (16 ) (96 ) (435 )













Group operating profit (d) 1 693   48   321   776   343   3 181  
Share of operating profit of joint ventures 18   24   8   5   2   57  













Operating profit (d) 1 711   72   329   781   345   3 238  













Operating profit BEIA (b) (f) 2 420   1 500   351   909   614   5 794  













Please refer to footnotes on page 76.

 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 73
Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements

1 Segmental information continued

   Analysis by operation (e) € million
Savoury
and
dressings
     € million
Spreads and
cooking
products
     € million
Health &
wellness and
beverages
     € million
Ice cream
and
frozen foods
     € million
Home care &
professional
cleaning
     € million

Personal
care
     € million
 
Other

operations
     € million  


Total
 

















2002                                
Group turnover 9 272   6 145   4 064   7 456   8 565   12 236   532   48 270  
Share of turnover of joint ventures 231   71   151     14   9   14   490  

















Turnover 9 503   6 216   4 215   7 456   8 579   12 245   546   48 760  

















Group operating profit BEIA 1 497   991   578   880   955   2 221   43   7 165  
Exceptional items (24 ) (181 ) (105 ) (237 ) (183 ) (149 )   (879 )
Amortisation of goodwill                                
and intangibles (1 051 ) (17 ) (119 ) (27 ) (17 ) (13 ) (1 ) (1 245 )

















Group operating profit 422   793   354   616   755   2 059   42   5 041  
Share of operating profit of                                
joint ventures 28   19   36     (1 ) 3   (1 ) 84  

















Operating profit 450   812   390   616   754   2 062   41   5 125  

















Operating profit BEIA (b) (f) 1 539   1 006   615   880   954   2 224   42   7 260  

















Share of operating profit                                
of associates (c)         34       34  

















Net operating assets (d) 16 959   1 120   3 015   1 674   858   719   389   24 734  


































2001                                
Group turnover 9 597   6 681   4 150   7 727   10 432   12 307   620   51 514  
Share of turnover of joint ventures 402   90   149     35   3   13   692  

















Turnover 9 999   6 771   4 299   7 727   10 467   12 310   633   52 206  

















Group operating profit BEIA 1 628   1 066   531   797   885   2 217   25   7 149  
Exceptional items 347   (260 ) (128 ) (322 ) (201 ) (49 ) 25   (588 )
Amortisation of goodwill                                
and intangibles (1 182 ) (9 ) (136 ) (29 ) (18 ) (11 ) (2 ) (1 387 )

















Group operating profit 793   797   267   446   666   2 157   48   5 174  
Share of operating profit of                                
joint ventures 21   20   41     1   2   (1 ) 84  

















Operating profit 814   817   308   446   667   2 159   47   5 258  

















Operating profit BEIA (b) (f) 1 685   1 086   572   797   886   2 219   24   7 269  

















Net operating assets (d) 22 788   651   3 025   2 496   1 540   1 312   385   32 197  


































2000                                
Group turnover 5 950   6 670   3 430   7 848   10 258   12 567   859   47 582  
Share of turnover of joint ventures 124   79   195   21   26   22   17   484  

















Turnover 6 074   6 749   3 625   7 869   10 284   12 589   876   48 066  

















Group operating profit BEIA 792   909   412   636   917   2 034   29   5 729  
Exceptional items (d) (170 ) (22 ) (18 ) (394 ) (323 ) (1 190 ) 4   (2 113 )
Amortisation of goodwill                                
and intangibles (326 ) (64 ) (3 ) (17 ) (16 ) (7 ) (2 ) (435 )

















Group operating profit (d) 296   823   391   225   578   837   31   3 181  
Share of operating profit of                                
joint ventures 13   16   28   2       (2 ) 57  

















Operating profit (d) 309   839   419   227   578   837   29   3 238  

















Operating profit BEIA (b) (f) 813   925   440   638   917   2 034   27   5 794  

















Please refer to footnotes on page 76.

 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

74 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

1 Segmental information continued
Additional segmental information as required by US GAAP
Segmental information is provided in accordance with SFAS 131 on the basis of product categories. For management reporting purposes Unilever uses a number of measures of segment performance at constant average rates of exchange (that is, the same rates as in the preceding year). The internal management measure of profit which is most consistent with operating profit reported in the accounts is ‘Trading Result’. This measure differs from operating profit, mainly because it excludes amortisation of goodwill and intangibles and certain exceptional items and includes depreciation on the basis of replacement cost. There are a number of additional adjustments, including the application of an inflation charge on working capital and certain other statistical items which are added back in order to arrive at operating profit. Tangible fixed assets are measured at depreciated replacement cost for management reporting purposes.

   Analysis by operation (e) € million
Savoury
and
dressings
     € million
Spreads and
cooking
products
     € million
Health &
wellness and
beverages
     € million
Ice cream
and

frozen foods
     € million
Home care &
professional
cleaning
     € million 

Personal
care
     € million 

Other

operations
     € million  


Total
 

















2002                                
Group turnover                                
At constant 2001 exchange rates 9 887 6 401 4 308 7 646 9 422 13 264 571   51 499  
Exchange rate adjustments (615 ) (256 ) (244 ) (190 ) (857 ) (1 028 ) (39 ) (3 229 )

















At current 2002 exchange rates 9 272 6 145 4 064 7 456 8 565 12 236 532   48 270  

















Trading result at constant                                
2001 exchange rates:                                
   Before exceptional items 1 602 1 021 641   943   979   2 322 16   7 524  
   Exceptional items (160 ) (174 ) (106 ) (226 ) (193 ) (166 ) 14   (1 011 )
At constant 2001 exchange rates 1 442 847   535   717   786   2 156 30   6 513  
Exchange rate adjustments (80 ) (13 ) (31 ) (13 ) (61 ) (180 ) (3 ) (381 )

















At current 2002 exchange rates 1 362 834   504   704   725   1 976 27   6 132  















   
Amortisation of goodwill                                
and intangibles                             (1 245 )
Other adjustments                             154  

















Group operating profit                             5 041  


































2001                                
Group turnover                                
At constant 2000 exchange rates 9 699   6 811   4 220   7 792   10 848   12 681   632   52 683  
Exchange rate adjustments (102 ) (130 ) (70 ) (65 ) (416 ) (374 ) (12 ) (1 169 ) 

















At current 2001 exchange rates 9 597   6 681   4 150   7 727   10 432   12 307   620   51 514  

















Trading result at constant                                
2000 exchange rates:                                
   Before exceptional items 1 674   1 038   556   818   863   2 286   25   7 260  
   Exceptional items 348   (265 ) (128 ) (329 ) (203 ) (31 ) 36   (572 )
At constant 2000 exchange rates 2 022   773   428   489   660   2 255   61   6 688  
Exchange rate adjustments (5 ) (2 ) (1 ) 5   (30 ) (74 ) (2 ) (109 )

















At current 2001 exchange rates 2 017   771   427   494   630   2 181   59   6 579  















   
Amortisation of goodwill                                
and intangibles                             (1 387 )
Other adjustments                             (18 )

















Group operating profit                             5 174  


































2000                                
Group turnover                                
At constant 1999 exchange rates 5 512   6 160   3 184   7 398   9 439   11 321   779   43 793  
Exchange rate adjustments 438   510   246   450   819   1 246   80   3 789  

















At current 2000 exchange rates 5 950   6 670   3 430   7 848   10 258   12 567   859   47 582  

















Trading result at constant                                
1999 exchange rates:                                
   Before exceptional items 755   829   390   666   825   1 845   24   5 334  
   Exceptional items (d) (166 ) 1   (19 ) (385 ) (306 ) (1 058 )  3   (1 930 )
At constant 1999 exchange rates (d) 589   830   371   281   519   787   27   3 404  
Exchange rate adjustments 56   45   30   19   34   45   (1 ) 228  

















At current 2000 exchange rates (d) 645   875   401   300   553   832   26   3 632  















   
Amortisation of goodwill                                
and intangibles                             (435 )
Other adjustments                             (16 )

















Group operating profit (d)                             3 181  

















Please refer to footnotes on page 76.                                

 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts
75
   Unilever Group
 

Financial Statements

Segmental information continued

Analysis by operation (e)
€ million
Savoury
and
dressings
 
€ million
Spreads and
cooking
products
 
€ million
Health &
wellness and
beverages
 
€ million
Ice cream
and
frozen foods
 
€ million
Home care &
professional
cleaning
 
€ million

Personal
care
 
€ million

Other
operations
 
€ million


Total
 

















                                 
Depreciation and amortisation                                
2002                                
At constant 2001 exchange rates 1 395   213   238   325   476   271   87   3 005  
Exchange rate adjustments (104 ) (9 ) (18 ) (10 ) (39 ) (19 ) (4 ) (203 )

















At current 2002 exchange rates 1 291   204   220   315   437   252   83   2 802  














     
Other adjustments                             (220 )
                             

                              2 582  

















2001                                
At constant 2000 exchange rates 1 500   276   227   376   391   292   86   3 148  
Exchange rate adjustments (30 ) (24 ) (5 ) 21   (11 ) (5 ) (1 ) (55 )

















At current 2001 exchange rates 1 470   252   222   397   380   287   85   3 093  














     
Other adjustments                             (248 )
                             

                              2 845  

















2000                                
At constant 1999 exchange rates 423   297   71   399   433   364   75   2 062  
Exchange rate adjustments 60   12   6   22   26   26   4   156  

















At current 2000 exchange rates 483   309   77   421   459   390   79   2 218  














     
Other adjustments                             (264 )
                             

                              1 954  

















                                 

















Capital expenditure                                
2002                                
At constant 2001 exchange rates 216   171   178   280   231   274   30   1 380  
Exchange rate adjustments (14 ) (5 ) (11 ) (10 ) (16 ) (23 ) (3 ) (82 )

















At current 2002 exchange rates 202   166   167   270   215   251   27   1 298  

















2001                                
At constant 2000 exchange rates 245   157   108   313   374   327   28   1 552  
Exchange rate adjustments 29   (13 ) (8 ) (21 ) (14 ) (9 ) (3 ) (39 )

















At current 2001 exchange rates 274   144   100   292   360   318   25   1 513  

















2000                                
At constant 1999 exchange rates 119   142   62   335   345   220   30   1 253  
Exchange rate adjustments 11   8   6   21   29   25   3   103  

















At current 2000 exchange rates 130   150   68   356   374   245   33   1 356  

















                                 

















Total assets                                
2002                                
Total assets by operation 19 717 3 610 4 095 3 851 3 581 4 066 2 662 41 582  
Corporate                             3 778  
Other adjustments                             (762 )

















                              44 598  

















2001 (d)                                
Total assets by operation 27 326   2 844   3 811   5 004   4 716   5 328   1 918   50 947  
Corporate                             2 672  
Other adjustments                             (853 )

















                              52 766  

















Please refer to footnotes on page 76.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

76
Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

1 Segmental information continued

Additional geographic analysis
million
United
Kingdom &
Netherlands
 
€ million

United
States
 
million


Other
 
million


Total
 









Group turnover (a)                
2002                
At constant 2001 exchange rates 5 444   11 992   34 063   51 499  
Exchange rate adjustments (38 ) (571 ) (2 620)   (3 229)  









At current 2002 exchange rates 5 406   11 421   31 443   48 270  









2001                
At constant 2000 exchange rates 5 794   12 278   34 611   52 683  
Exchange rate adjustments (89 ) 348   (1 428)   (1 169)  









At current 2001 exchange rates 5 705   12 626   33 183   51 514  









2000                
At constant 1999 exchange rates 5 077   9 153   29 563   43 793  
Exchange rate adjustments 300   1 466   2 023   3 789  









At current 2000 exchange rates 5 377   10 619   31 586   47 582  









                 









Tangible fixed assets                
2002 979   1 564   4 893   7 436  
2001 1 634   2 131   5 475   9 240  









Footnotes to note 1:

(a) The analysis of turnover by geographical area is stated on the basis of origin. Turnover on a destination basis would not be materially different. Inter-segment sales between operational segments and between geographical areas are not material. For the United Kingdom and the Netherlands, the combined Group operating profit was €578 million (2001: €1 226 million; 2000: €716 million).
(b) In 2002 the Group’s share of amortisation of goodwill and intangibles in joint ventures was €(16) million (2001: €(36) million; 2000: €(8) million), of which €(3) million (2001: €(22) million; 2000: €(5) million) arose in Africa, Middle East and Turkey and €(13) million (2001: €(14) million; 2000: €(3) million) arose in Asia and Pacific. Of the total amortisation €(13) million (2001: €(36) million; 2000: €(8) million) arose in the savoury and dressings segment, €(2) million arose in the spreads and cooking products segment and €(1) million arose in the health & wellness and beverages segment. These amounts are taken into account in the calculation of operating profit BEIA.
(c) Nil in 2001 and 2000.
(d) The 2001 amounts for goodwill within net operating assets and amounts reported in 2000 for exceptional items within operating profit have been restated to comply with the requirements of FRS 19. See note 18 on page 94. For the definition of net operating assets see page 115.
(e) Analysis for Foods operations has been reclassified over new categories, as noted on page 24.
(f) In 2002 the Group’s share of exceptional items in joint ventures was €5 million (2001: €nil; 2000: €nil), of which €6 million arose in Europe and €(1) million arose in Asia and Pacific. Of the total exceptional items €(1) million arose in the savoury and dressings segment and €6 million arose in the spreads and cooking products segment. These amounts are taken into account in the calculation of operating profit BEIA.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 77
   Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements

 

2  Operating costs

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Cost of sales (24 030 ) (26 962 )  (25 221 ) 
Distribution and selling costs (12 175 ) (12 543 )  (12 045 ) 
Administrative expenses (a) (7 024 ) (6 835 )  (7 135 ) 







Operating costs (43 229 ) (46 340 )  (44 401 ) 







(a) Includes amortisation of goodwill and intangibles.

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Operating costs include:            
Staff costs 3 (7 008 ) (7 131 ) (6 905 )
Raw materials and packaging (18 086 ) (19 924 ) (18 085 )
Amortisation of goodwill and            
intangibles (b) (1 245 ) (1 387 ) (435 )
Depreciation of tangible fixed assets (c) (1 337 ) (1 458 ) (1 519 )
Advertising and promotions (6 839 ) (6 648 ) (6 545 )
Research and development (1 166 ) (1 178 ) (1 187 )
Remuneration of auditors:            
   Audit fees (15 ) (16 ) (14 )
   Audit related services (d) (13 ) (11 ) (10 )
   Other payments to PricewaterhouseCoopers for non-audit services:            
      Tax (d) (6 ) (5 ) (4 )
      General consulting (d) (16 ) (60 ) (42 )
             
Lease rentals:            
   Minimum lease payments (503 ) (548 ) (563 )
   Contingent lease payments (15 ) (28 ) (8 )







  (518 ) (576 ) (571 )
   Less: Sub-lease income 8   10   12  







  (510 ) (566 ) (559 )







of which:            
   Plant and machinery (141 ) (147 ) (148 )
   Other (369 ) (419 ) (411 )







   
(b)  Includes exceptional amount of €(22) million in 2002 and €(8) million in 2001.
(c)  Includes exceptional amount of €(256) million in 2002 and €(263) million in 2001.
(d)  Details of our policy on the non-audit work we allow our auditors to perform are given within the Corporate governance section on page 45.

3  Staff costs and employees

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Staff costs:            
Remuneration of employees (5 834 ) (6 021 )  (5 828 ) 
Emoluments of directors as managers (17 ) (18 ) (13 )
Pensions and other            
post-retirement benefits 17 (416 ) (326 ) (305 )
Social security costs (741 ) (766 ) (759 )







Total staff costs (7 008 ) (7 131 )  (6 905 ) 







Details of the remuneration of directors and Advisory Directors which form part of these accounts are given in the auditable part of the Remuneration report on pages 49 to 60.

The average number of employees during the year was:

  '000   ’000   ’000  
  2002   2001   2000  







Europe 65   75   74  
North America 22   30   27  
Africa, Middle East and Turkey 52   49   48  
Asia and Pacific 84   84   79  
Latin America 35   41   33  







Total 258   279   261  







4 Exceptional items

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Included in operating profit            
Restructuring (1 215 ) (1 515 )  (1 150 ) 
Other, principally business disposals (a) 341   927   (963 )







Total (874 ) (588 ) (2 113 ) 







               
(a) Restated for FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.            

These amounts are mainly included in administrative expenses.

Exceptional items are those items within ordinary activities which, because of their size or nature, are disclosed to give a proper understanding of the underlying result for the period. These include restructuring charges in connection with reorganising businesses (comprising impairment of fixed assets, costs of severance, and other costs directly attributable to the restructuring), and profits and losses on disposal of businesses. United Kingdom FRS 3 would require profits and losses on disposal of most businesses to be excluded from operating profit. However, because the business disposals above and the restructuring costs are part of a series of linked initiatives, separate presentation would not give a true and fair view and therefore we have included all exceptional items arising from these initiatives on a single line in operating profit. Costs associated with restructuring, such as training and information technology development costs, are recognised as they arise and are not treated as exceptional.

The exceptional items in 2002, 2001 and 2000 principally relate to a series of linked initiatives (the ‘Path to Growth’), announced on 22 February 2000 to align the organisation behind plans for accelerating growth and expanding margins and to restructuring arising from the integration of Bestfoods.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

78 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

 

4  Exceptional items continued
The total net cost of these programmes is estimated to be €6.2 billion over five years, most of which is expected to be exceptional restructuring costs. Provisions for these costs and asset write downs are being recognised as necessary consultations are completed and plans finalised.

In 2002, €1.3 billion of net costs have been incurred under Path to Growth programmes of which a net €1.1 billion is exceptional. To date, which is three years into the five year programme, the total cost incurred is €5.2 billion of which €4.5 billion is exceptional.

Other exceptional items include the release of provisions (€98 million) against environmental exposures when events showed that the provisions were no longer required. These provisions were originally recorded on the acquisition of the Bestfoods business.

In 2001 exceptional items included €1.4 billion of Path to Growth net costs and €811 million gain on the sale of brands to secure regulatory approval for the acquisition of Bestfoods.

In 2000 other exceptional items included a profit of €143 million on the disposal of the European bakery business and a loss of €980 million on the agreed disposal of Elizabeth Arden. The latter amount has been restated as a result of the implementation of FRS 19; there was no impact on net profit arising from this restatement. See note 18 on page 94.

5  Interest

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Total interest payable            
and similar charges (1 446 ) (1 914 ) (1 008 )
             
Group interest payable            
and similar charges:            
   Bank loans and overdrafts (186 ) (451 ) (221 )
   Bonds and other loans (1 228 ) (1 463 ) (787 )
Share of interest payable            
of joint ventures (5 )    
Share of interest payable            
of associates (27 )    
Group interest receivable            
and similar income 247   210   374  
             
Exchange differences 26   (3 ) 12  







  (1 173 ) (1 707 ) (622 )
Less: interest capitalised on            
businesses held for resale   61   27  
Add: exceptional interest     (37 )







Total (1 173 ) (1 646 ) (632 )







Exceptional interest in 2000 principally comprised fees paid on the unused financing facility put in place prior to the acquisition of Bestfoods.

6  Taxation on profit on ordinary activities

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Parent and group companies (a)(b) (1 515 ) (1 522 ) (1 271 )
Joint ventures (19 ) (25 ) (11 )
Associates (4 )    







Total (1 538 ) (1 547 )  (1 282 ) 







Of which:            
Adjustments to previous years            
      United Kingdom taxes 11   (3 ) (5 )
      Other taxes 245   61   36  







(a) United Kingdom            
Corporation Tax at 30.0% (173 ) (381 ) (451 )
less: double tax relief 66   140   334  







United Kingdom taxes (107 ) (241 ) (117 )
plus: non-United Kingdom taxes (1 408 ) (1 281 )  (1 154 ) 







  (1 515 ) (1 522 )  (1 271 ) 







(b) Of which, tax on exceptional            
items amounted to 241   232   404  







Deferred taxation has been included            
on a full provision basis for:            
   Accelerated depreciation 50   87   119  
   Other 242   (207 ) 153  







  292   (120 ) 272  







Where appropriate, amounts have been restated for FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.

Europe is Unilever’s domestic tax base. The reconciliation between the computed rate of income tax expense which is generally applicable to Unilever’s European companies and the actual rate of taxation charged, expressed in percentages of the profit of ordinary activities before taxation is as follows:

  %   %   %  
  2002   2001   2000  







Computed rate of tax (see below) 33   33   32  
Differences due to:            
Other rates applicable to non-European countries 3   (1 ) 2  
Incentive tax credits (3 ) (3 ) (2 )
Withholding tax on dividends 1   3   3  
Adjustments to previous years (6 ) (2 ) (2 )
Non-deductible goodwill impairment     10  
Non-deductible goodwill amortisation 9   12   4  
Other 2   1   2  







Actual rate of tax            
   (current and deferred) 39   43   49  
Actual rate of deferred tax for:            
   Accelerated depreciation 1   2   5  
   Other 6   (6 ) 6  







Actual rate of current tax 46   39   60  







In the above reconciliation, the computed rate of tax is the average of the standard rate of tax applicable in the European countries in which Unilever operates, weighted by the amount of profit on ordinary activities before taxation generated in each of those countries.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 79
   Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements

 

6  Taxation on profit on ordinary activities continued
The total charge in future periods will be affected by any changes to the corporate tax rates in force in the countries in which the Group operates. The current tax charges will also be affected by changes in the excess of tax depreciation over book depreciation and the use of tax credits.

Analyses of European and non-European profit on ordinary activities before taxation, and of the actual taxation charge thereon, are as follows:

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Profit on ordinary activities before taxation            
Europe:            
Parent and group companies 2 062   2 429   1 792  
Joint ventures 19   21   14  
Associates 12      







  2 093   2 450   1 806  







Outside Europe:            
Group companies 1 831   1 111   754  
Joint ventures 60   63   42  
Associates (5 )    







  1 886   1 174   796  







Total 3 979   3 624   2 602  







 

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Taxation on profit on ordinary activities            
Europe:            
Parent and group companies            
Taxes payable (723 ) (760 ) (942 )
Deferred taxation 95   (114 ) 293  
of which:            
Accelerated depreciation 113   62   116  
Other (18 ) (176 ) 177  
Joint ventures (6 ) (6 ) (5 )
Associates (5 )    







  (639 ) (880 ) (654 )







Outside Europe:            
Group companies            
Taxes payable (1 084)   (642 ) (722 )
Deferred taxation 197   (6 ) 100  
of which:            
Accelerated depreciation (63 ) 25   3  
Other 260   (31 ) 97  
Joint ventures (13 ) (19 ) (6 )
Associates 1      







  (899 ) (667 ) (628 )







Total (1 538 ) (1 547 ) (1 282 )







7  Combined earnings per share

       
  2002   2001   2000  







Per €0.51 share of NV ordinary capital:            
Basic earnings per share 2.14   1.82   1.07  
Basic earnings per share before exceptional items and amortisation of goodwill and intangibles 4.06   3.55   3.21  
Diluted earnings per share 2.07   1.77   1.05  







             
             
  € cents   € cents   € cents  
  2002   2001   2000  







Per 1.4p share of PLC ordinary capital:            
Basic earnings per share 32.05   27.27   16.08  
Basic earnings per share before exceptional items and amortisation of goodwill and intangibles 60.86   53.29   48.20  
Diluted earnings per share 31.10   26.54   15.69  







Basis of calculation:
The calculations of combined earnings per share are based on the net profit attributable to ordinary capital divided by the average number of share units representing the combined ordinary capital of NV and PLC in issue during the year, after deducting shares held to meet Unilever employee share options which are not yet exercised. For the calculation of combined ordinary capital the exchange rate of £1 = Fl. 12 = €5.445 has been used, in accordance with the Equalisation Agreement.

Earnings per share before exceptional items and amortisation of goodwill and intangibles is provided because the directors believe it better explains the ongoing trends in the Group’s performance during the duration of the Path to Growth programme.

The calculations of diluted earnings per share are based on (a) conversion into PLC ordinary shares of the shares in a group company which are convertible in the year 2038 as described in ‘Control of Unilever’ on page 141, and (b) the exercise of share options, details of which are set out in note 29 on pages 103 to 111.

Calculation of average number of share units:

  Millions of €0.51 share units  
  2002   2001   2000  







Average ordinary capital: NV 571.6   571.6   571.6  
Average ordinary capital: PLC 436.7   436.7   436.7  
less: shares held by employee share trusts and companies (31.6 ) (25.5 ) (19.1 )







Combined average number of share units for all bases except diluted earnings per share 976.7   982.8   989.2  
add: shares issuable in 2038 23.6   23.6   23.6  
add: shares under option 35.3   23.5   17.2  
less: shares issuable at fair value (29.0 ) (19.9 ) (15.7 )







Adjusted combined average number of share units for diluted earnings per share basis 1 006.6   1 010.0   1 014.3  








 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

80 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

 

7 Combined earnings per share continued

  Millions of 1.4p share units  
2002   2001   2000







Average ordinary capital: NV 3 810.5   3 810.5   3 810.5  
Average ordinary capital: PLC 2 911.5   2 911.5   2 911.5  
less: shares held by employee share            
trusts and companies (210.4 ) (169.7 ) (127.2 )







Combined average number of share units for all bases except diluted earnings per share   6 511.6       6 552.3       6 594.8    
add: shares issuable in 2038 157.5   157.5   157.5  
add: shares under option 235.3   156.3   114.6  
less: shares issuable at fair value (193.6 ) (132.7 ) (105.1 )







Adjusted combined average numberof share units for diluted earnings per share basis   6 710.8       6 733.4       6 761.8    







             

Calculation of earnings:

           
  million   million   million  
2002 2001 2000







             
Net profit 2 129   1 838   1 105  
less: preference dividends (42 ) (51 ) (44 )







Net profit attributed to ordinary capital for basic and diluted earnings per share calculations   2 087       1 787       1 061    
add: exceptional items net of tax 661   334   1 709  
add: amortisation of goodwill and            
intangibles net of tax 1 216   1 371   409  







Net profit attributed to ordinary capital before exceptional items and amortisation   3 964       3 492       3 179    







             

8    Dividends on ordinary capital

           
  million   million    € million  
2002 2001 2000







Dividends on ordinary capital            
Interim (537 ) (491 ) (475 )
Final (1 122 ) (1 039 ) (939 )







Total (1 659 ) (1 530 ) (1 414 )







             
           
2002 2001 2000







Dividends per €0.51 share of NV ordinary capital                  
Interim 0.55   0.50   0.48  
Final 1.15   1.06   0.95  







Total 1.70   1.56   1.43  







  Pence   Pence   Pence  
2002 2001 2000







Dividends per 1.4p share of PLC ordinary capital                  
Interim 5.21   4.65   4.40  
Final 10.83   9.89   8.67  







Total 16.04   14.54   13.07  







Full details of dividends for the years 1998 to 2002 are given on page 147.

 

9 Goodwill and intangible assets
No value is attributed to internally generated intangible assets. Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets purchased after 1 January 1998 are capitalised and amortised in operating profit over the period of their expected useful life, up to a maximum of 20 years. Goodwill and intangible assets purchased prior to 1 January 1998 were written off in the year of acquisition as a movement in profits retained.

Goodwill and intangible assets are subject to review for impairment in accordance with United Kingdom FRS 11 ‘Impairment of Fixed Assets and Goodwill’ and United States SFAS 142. Any impairment is charged to the profit and loss account as it arises.

Intangible assets principally consist of trademarks.

  million   € million  
2002 2001





At cost less amortisation        
Goodwill (a) 15 328   18 715  
Intangible assets 4 946   6 249  





  20 274 24 964  





         
 Movements during 2002  € million 
Goodwill
(a) € million
Intangible

assets
   





Cost        
1 January 20 093 6 702
Additions/reductions   18  
Acquisitions/disposals 282   (227 )
Currency retranslation (3 030 ) (890 )





31 December 17 345 5 603





Amortisation        
1 January (1 378 ) (453 )
Disposals 11   19  
Charged to profit and loss account (b) (932 ) (313 )
Currency retranslation 282   90  





31 December (2 017 )  (657 )





Net book value 31 December 15 328 4 946





   
(a) Restated for FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.
(b) Including exceptional write down arising on restructuring of €22 million.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 81
   Unilever Group  

 

Financial Statements

 

10 Tangible fixed assets
Tangible fixed assets are stated at cost less depreciation.
Depreciation is provided on a straight-line basis at percentages of cost based on the expected average useful lives of the assets. Estimated useful lives by major class of assets are as follows:

Freehold buildings 33-40 years
(no depreciation on freehold land)  
Leasehold land and buildings *33-40 years
Plant and equipment 3-20 years
Motor vehicles 3-6 years
*or life of lease if less than 33 years  

Tangible fixed assets are subject to review for impairment in accordance with United Kingdom FRS 11 and United States SFAS 144. Any impairment in the value of such fixed assets is charged to the profit and loss account as it arises.

  million   million  
2002 2001





At cost less depreciation:        
Land and buildings (a) 2 622 3 106  
Plant and machinery 4 814   6 134  





Total 7 436 9 240  





(a) includes: freehold land
282
383
 
  leasehold land        
  (mainly long-term leases) 63   84  





Approximate current replacement cost of tangible fixed assets net of accumulated current cost depreciation   8 535      10 529    





On a current replacement cost basis the depreciation charge to the profit and loss account would have been increased by    (220 )    (248 )





Commitments for capital expenditure at 31 December  244     298   





Movements during 2002 million
Land and
buildings
  € million
Plant and machinery
 





Gross        
1 January 4 570 13 597
Currency retranslation (556 ) (1 501 )
Capital expenditure 182   1 116
Disposals (255 ) (918 )
Acquisitions/disposals of group companies (176 ) (761 )
Other adjustments 85   (85 )





31 December 3 850 11 448





Depreciation        
1 January (1 464 )  (7 463 ) 
Currency retranslation 184   855  
Disposals 136   696  
Acquisitions/disposals of group companies 81   450  
Charged to profit and loss account (b) (124 ) (1 213 )
Other adjustments (41 ) 41  





31 December (1 228 )  (6 634 )





Net book value 31 December 2 622 4 814





Includes payments on account and assets in course of construction  64     495   





(b) Including a charge of €300 million in respect of certain fixed assets written down to net realisable value in connection with restructuring projects, €256 million of which was exceptional.

11 Fixed investments
Joint ventures are undertakings in which the Group has a long-term participating interest and which are jointly controlled by the Group and one or more other parties. Associated companies are undertakings in which the Group has a participating interest and is able to exercise significant influence.

Interests in joint ventures and associated companies are stated in the consolidated balance sheet at the Group’s share of their aggregate assets and liabilities.

Other fixed investments are stated at cost less any amounts written off to reflect a permanent impairment.

  million
2002
  million
2001
 





Share of gross assets of joint ventures 370   855  
Share of gross liabilities of joint ventures (96 ) (147 )





Interest in net assets of joint ventures 274   708  
Interest in net assets of associates 1    





Total joint ventures and associates 275   708  
Other fixed investments 404   176  





Total fixed investments 679   884  






Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

82 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

 

11 Fixed investments continued

The following tables show the movements during the year in connection with joint ventures, associates and other fixed investments:

Joint ventures – movements during 2002 million   million  
Goodwill Other





1 January 513   195  
Acquisitions/disposals (225 ) (100 )
Amortisation (16 )  
Currency retranslation (61 ) (19 )
Additions/reductions   (8 )
Share of profit retained   (5 )





31 December 211   63  





         
 Associates – movements during 2002 € million    million   
Goodwill Other





1 January    
Acquisitions/disposals 178   (195 )
Amortisation (6 )  
Currency retranslation (18 ) 20  
Additions/reductions   1  
Share of profit retained   6  





  154   (168 )
Of which: Net liabilities of JohnsonDiversey reclassified to provisions for liabilities and charges (€15 million net)   (154 )   169    





31 December   1  





Associated companies primarily comprise our investments in JohnsonDiversey Holdings Inc. and Langholm Capital. Other Unilever Ventures investments are included under Other fixed investments below. For further details of these investments see page 10.

Other fixed investments – movements during 2002   million  




1 January   176  
Acquisitions/disposals   215  
Currency retranslation   (51 )
Additions/reductions   64  




31 December    404  




         
Analysis of listed and unlisted investments million   million  
2002 2001





Investments listed on a recognised stock exchange  19     21   
Unlisted investments 660   863  





Total fixed investments 679   884  





Market value of listed investments 19   21  





Unlisted investments include the Senior Discount Note issued by JohnsonDiversey as part consideration for the purchase of the DiverseyLever business.

Sales agency fees payable to JohnsonDiversey are approximately €85 million per annum; interest receivable of €17 million was accrued during 2002.

  million   million   million  
2002 2001 2000







Other income from fixed investments                  
Income from other fixed investments 8   2   2  
Profit/(loss) on disposal (15 ) 10   (6 )







  (7 ) 12   (4 )







The following related party balances existed with associates at 31 December:

  million   million  
2002 2001





Trading balances receivable 38    
Financing balances receivable 247    





12 Stocks

  € million   € million  
2002   2001  





Raw materials and consumables 1 720   2 105  
Finished goods and goods for resale 2 780   3 238  





Total stocks 4 500   5 343  





13 Debtors

  million   million  
2002 2001





Due within one year:        
Trade debtors 4 112   5 344  
Prepayments and accrued income 573   548  
Other debtors 1 190   1 293  





  5 875   7 185  





Due after more than one year:        
Prepayments to funded pension schemes17 840   917  
Deferred taxation (a)18 1 292   1 610  
Other debtors 224   322  





  2 356   2 849  





Total debtors 8 231   10 034  





(a) Restated for FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.

The following information is required by schedule 210.12-09 under Regulation S-X of the United States Securities and Exchange Commission:

  million   million   million  
2002 2001 2000







Provision for doubtful debtors            
Movements during the year:            
1 January 328   307   279  
Charged to profit and loss account 155   96   84  
Charged to other accounts (a) (24 ) 13   54  
Deductions (165 ) (88 ) (110 )







31 December 294   328   307  







(a) Includes currency retranslation of opening balances.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 83
Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements
 

14 Net funds/(debt)

  € million   € million  
  2002   2001  





Current investments        
Listed 62   43  
Unlisted 1 164   396  





  1 226   439  





Cash at bank and in hand        
On call and in hand 1 602   1 576  
Repayment notice required 650   286  





  2 252   1 862  





Borrowings        
Bank loans and overdrafts (1 844 ) (2 893 ) 
Bonds and other loans (18 600 ) (22 607 ) 





  (20 444 ) (25 500 ) 





Total net funds/(debt) (16 966 ) (23 199 ) 





Current investments include short-term deposits, government securities and A- or higher rated money and capital market instruments.

  € million   € million  
  2002   2001  





Borrowings – additional details        
The repayments fall due as follows:        
Within one year:        
Bank loans and overdrafts 1 514   2 719  
Bonds and other loans 7 997   8 560  





Total due within one year 9 511   11 279  





After one year but within two years 1 734   5 090  
After two years but within three years 2 047   1 736  
After three years but within four years 1 807   2 257  
After four years but within five years 1 807   1 917  
After five years:   By instalments    
  Not by instalments 3 538   3 221  





Total due after more than one year 10 933   14 221  





Total amount repayable by instalments any of        
which are payable after five years 2    





Secured borrowings – mainly bank loans        
and overdrafts 44   24  





Of which secured against tangible fixed assets 6   15  





The tables set out below and on page 84 take into account the various interest rate swaps and forward foreign currency contracts entered into by the Group, details of which are set out in note 15 on pages 85 and 86. Details of specific bonds and other loans are also given below.

  € million   € million  
  2002   2001  





NV        
Floating rate notes 2002 (US $)   2 541  
Floating rate notes 2003 (€) 1 000 999  
Floating rate notes 2003 (US $) 477   564  
Floating rate notes 2003 (Japanese Yen) 402   430  
4.750% Bonds 2004 (€) 998   997  
7.250% Bonds 2004 (US $) 238   282  
6.500% Bonds 2004 (€) 159   159  
7.125% Bonds 2004 (€) 228   228  
6.625% Notes 2005 (US $) 191   226  
3.375% Bonds 2005 (Swiss Francs) 343   337  
5.125% Bonds 2006 (€) 998   997  
5.125% Notes 2006 (US $) 474   561  
4.250% Bonds 2007 (€) 996    
5.000% Bonds 2007 (US $) 617    
Commercial paper (€) 962   797  
Commercial paper (£) 234   1 007  
Commercial paper (US $) 595   1 055  
Commercial paper (Swiss Francs) 93   168  
Other 788   433  





Total NV 9 793 11 781  





         
PLC        
Eonia indexed note 2002 (€)   500  
Floating rate notes 2002 (€)   1 000  
Floating rate notes 2002 (£)   213  
5.375% Notes 2003 (€) 1 250 1 249  
Commercial paper (€) 59    
Commercial paper (£) 98    
Other (a)   (6 )





Total PLC 1 407 2 956  





         
Other group companies:        
United States:        
6.750% Notes 2003 (US $) 1 429 1 694  
6.875% Notes 2003 (US $) 95   113  
6.875% Notes 2005 (US $) 1 427 1 694  
6.150% Bonds 2006 (US $) 277   325  
7.125% Bonds 2010 (US $) 1 657 1 977  
7.000% Bonds 2017 (US $) 135   160  
7.250% Bonds 2026 (US $) 270   319  
6.625% Bonds 2028 (US $) 209   246  
5.900% Bonds 2032 (US $) 943    
5.000% Bonds 2045 (Swiss Francs) 138   135  
5.600% Bonds 2097 (US $) 87   103  
Commercial paper (US $) 351   838  
Other 41   82  
         
Thailand:        
3.300% Bonds 2007 (Thai baht) 144    
         
Other countries 197   184  





Total other group companies 7 400 7 870  





Total bonds and other loans 18 600 22 607  





(a) The negative amount shown in 2001 relates to the exchange difference on the currency swap used to swap certain euro borrowings into sterling.

 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

84 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group
 
 
 

14 Net funds/(debt) continued
Unilever had the following undrawn committed facilities at 31 December 2002:

revolving 364-day bilateral credit facilities of in aggregate US $3 403 million (2001: US $3 020 million) with a 364-day term out;
revolving 5 year bilateral credit facilities of in aggregate US $334 million (2001: nil);
revolving 364-day notes commitments of US $400 million (2001: US $200 million) with the ability to issue notes with a maturity up to 364 days;
364-day bilateral money market commitments of in aggregate US $2 080 million (2001: US $1 775 million), under which the underwriting banks agree, subject to certain conditions, to subscribe for notes with maturities of up to three years.

In addition, operating companies have a variety of facilities, most of which are uncommitted.

The average interest rate on short-term borrowings in 2002 was 5% (2001: 7%).

The interest rate profiles of the Group’s financial assets and liabilities analysed by principal currency are set out in the table below.

Interest rate profile and currency analysis of
financial assets

  € million           € million   € million  
  Fixed   Fixed   Fixed   Floating      
  rate   rate   rate   rate   Total  











      Weighted   Weighted          
      average   average          
      interest   fixing          
      rate   period          











Assets – 2002                    
Euro (b) 512   10.9 % 1.4 years   670   1 182  
Sterling           123   123  
US Dollar 246   10.7 % 10.3 years   445   691  
Indian Rupee           568   568  
Other           1 122   1 122  











Total (a) 758           2 928   3 686  











Assets – 2001                    
Euro (b) 806   11.0 % 1.3 years   (202 ) 604  
Sterling           334   334  
US Dollar           79   79  
Indian Rupee           558   558  
Other           726   726  











Total 806           1 495   2 301  











(a) Includes certain non equity assets held within fixed investments.
(b) The fixed interest rate of 10.9% in 2002 (2001: 11.0%) relates to one leg of a cross-currency interest rate swap of an intercompany loan: a corresponding interest charge is included in the US dollar fixed rate liabilities.

Interest rate profile and currency analysis of
financial liabilities

  € million           € million   € million  
  Fixed   Fixed   Fixed   Floating      
  rate   rate   rate   rate   Total  











      Weighted   Weighted          
      average   average          
      interest   fixing          
      rate   period          











Liabilities – 2002                    
Euro 32   4.8 % 4.7 years   221   253  
Sterling 367   6.3 % 1.4 years   1 017   1 384  
US Dollar 11 363   6.2 % 6.7 years   4 542   15 905  
Thai baht 262   3.7 % 2.9 years   128   390  
Other 247   5.1 % 24.0 years   2 265   2 512  











Total 12 271           8 173   20 444  











Liabilities – 2001                    
Euro 68   6.0 % 3.1 years   1 728   1 796  
Sterling 1 429   7.2 % 0.7 years   320   1 749  
US Dollar 11 687   6.7 % 5.4 years   7 288   18 975  
Other 252   5.0 % 24.2 years   2 728   2 980  











Total 13 436           12 064   25 500  












 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 85
Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements
 

15 Financial instruments
The Group has comprehensive policies in place, approved by the directors, covering the use of derivative financial instruments. These instruments are used for hedging purposes. Established controls are in place covering all financial instruments. These include policies, guidelines, exposure limits, a system of authorities and independent reporting. Performance is closely monitored with independent reviews undertaken by internal audit. The accounting policies governing these instruments are in line with generally accepted practice in the UK and the Netherlands and follow hedge accounting principles described in the accounting policies on page 68. The use of leveraged instruments is not permitted. Details of the instruments used for interest rate and foreign exchange exposure management, together with information on related exposures, are given below.

Except for the description of Unilever’s currency exposures, all debtors and trade and other creditors have been excluded from the analysis below and from the interest rate and currency profiles in note 14 on page 84 either due to the exclusion of short-term items, as permitted by United Kingdom Financial Reporting Standard 13, or because the amounts are not material.

Unilever operates an interest rate management policy aimed at optimising net interest and reducing volatility. Derivatives are used to manage the interest rate exposure of debt and cash positions. The Group’s financial position is largely fixed by fixed rate long-term debt issues and straightforward derivative financial instruments such as interest rate swaps. In general, cash is invested short-term at floating interest rates.

At the end of 2002 interest rates were fixed on approximately 80% of the projected net debt for 2003 and 47% for 2004 (compared with 54% for 2002 and 47% for 2003 at the end of 2001).

Nominal values of interest rate derivative instruments are shown in the table below. These nominal values do not reflect the actual level of use of financial instruments when compared with the nominal value of the underlying debt. This is because certain financial instruments have consecutive strike and maturity dates on the same underlying debt in different time periods. Whilst the nominal amounts reflect the volume of activity, they are not indicative of the amount of credit risk to which the Group is exposed. For details of our policy for managing credit risk see page 38.

  € million   € million  
 
Nominal amounts
 
 
at 31 December
 
  2002   2001  





Interest rate swaps 15 804   21 360  





The following table shows the extent to which the Group had unrecognised gains and losses in respect of interest rate instruments at the beginning and end of the year. It shows the movement in the market value of these instruments during the year ended 31 December 2002.

  € million   € million   € million  
          Total net  
          gains/  
  Gains   Losses   (losses)  







Unrecognised gains and losses:            
Balance at 1 January 151   (293 ) (142 )
Brought forward balance            
recognised in current year 61   (234 ) (173 )







Brought forward balance not            
recognised in current year 90   (59 ) 31  
Current year items not recognised            
in current year 210   (145 ) 65  







Balance at 31 December 2002 300   (204 ) 96  







Expected to be dealt with next year 129   (147 ) (18 )
Expected to be dealt with later 171   (57 ) 114  







The following table shows the extent to which the Group has recognised but deferred gains and losses in respect of interest rate instruments at the beginning and end of the year. It also shows the amount which has been included in the profit and loss account for the year and those gains and losses which will be reflected in the profit and loss account in 2003 or in subsequent years.

  € million   € million   € million  
          Total net  
          gains/  
  Gains   Losses   (losses)  







Deferred gains and losses:            
Balance at 1 January 10   (82 ) (72 )
Brought forward balance            
recognised in current year 5   (29 ) (24 )







Brought forward balance not            
recognised in current year 5   (53 ) (48 )
Current year items not recognised            
in current year   5   5  







Balance at 31 December 2002 5   (48 ) (43 )







To be recognised in the profit and            
loss account for next year 5   (25 ) (20 )
To be recognised in the profit and            
loss account later   (23 ) (23 )








 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

86 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

15 Financial instruments continued
Under the Group’s foreign exchange policy, transaction exposures, which usually have a maturity of less than one year, are generally hedged; this is primarily achieved through the use of forward foreign exchange contracts. The market value of these instruments at the end of 2002 represented a recognised unrealised gain of €572 million (2001: loss of €157 million) which was largely offset by recognised unrealised losses on the underlying assets and liabilities.

  € million   € million  
 
Nominal amounts
 
 
at 31 December
 
  2002   2001  






Foreign exchange contracts – buy 3 627   6 053  
    – sell 11 076   13 812  






Total 14 703   19 865  






Our policy for financing the net investments in our subsidiaries is discussed in the Financial Review on page 37 and 38. At the end of 2002 some 75% (2001: 67%) of Unilever’s total capital and reserves were denominated in the currencies of the two parent companies, euros and sterling.

Counterparty exposures are minimised by dealing with a limited range of financial institutions with secure credit ratings, and by working within agreed counterparty limits. There is no significant concentration of credit risk with any single counterparty.

Master netting agreements are in place for the majority of interest rate derivative instruments. The risk in the event of default by a counterparty is determined by the extent to which market prices have moved since the contracts were made. The Group believes that the risk of incurring such losses is remote.

The following table summarises the fair values and carrying amounts of the various classes of financial instruments as at 31 December:

  € million     € million       € million   € million    
    Fair value Carrying amount
  2002 2001   2002   2001










Financial assets:                  
Other fixed investments 404   176     404   176  
Current investments 1 226   439     1 226   439  
Cash 2 252   1 862     2 252   1 862  










  3 882   2 477     3 882   2 477  










Financial liabilities:                  
Bank loans and overdrafts (1 849 ) (2 899 )   (1 844 ) (2 893 )
Bonds and other loans (19 675 ) (23 125 )   (18 600 ) (22 607 )










  (21 524 ) (26 024 )   (20 444 ) (25 500 )










Derivatives:                  
Interest rate swaps                  
   – assets 300   151     152   134  
   – liabilities (204 ) (293 )   (6 ) (10 )
Foreign exchange                  
contracts – assets 780   190     780   190  
      – liabilities (208 ) (347 )   (208 ) (347 )










The fair values of listed fixed investments are based on their market values. The fair values of unlisted fixed investments are not materially different from their carrying amounts. The carrying amount of current investments is based on their market value. Cash, bank loans and overdrafts have fair values which approximate to their carrying amounts because of their short-term nature. The fair values of forward foreign exchange contracts represent the unrealised gain or loss on revaluation of the contracts to year-end exchange rates. The fair values of bonds and other loans, interest rate swaps and forward rate agreements are based on the net present value of the anticipated future cash flows associated with these instruments. Short-term debtors and creditors have fair values which approximate to their carrying values.

In November 2001, NV entered into a forward purchase contract with a counterparty bank to buy 10 000 000 PLC shares at 559p per share in November 2006. If the PLC share price falls by more than 5% below 559p, cash collateral for the difference must be placed with the counterparty bank.

Currency exposures
Group Treasury manages the foreign exchange exposures that arise from Unilever’s financing and investing activities in accordance with Unilever policies.

The objectives of Unilever’s foreign exchange policies are to allow operating companies to manage foreign exchange exposures that arise from trading activities effectively within a framework of control that does not expose Unilever to unnecessary foreign exchange risks. Operating companies are required to cover substantially all foreign exchange exposures arising from trading activities and each company operates within a specified maximum exposure limit. Business Groups monitor compliance with these policies.
Compliance with the Group’s policies means that the net amount of monetary assets and liabilities at 31 December 2002 that are exposed to currency fluctuations is not material.

16 Trade and other creditors

  € million   € million  
  2002   2001  





Due within one year:        
Trade creditors 4 414   4 882  
Social security and sundry taxes 458   534  
Accruals and deferred income 2 889   3 196  
Taxation on profits 857   977  
Dividends 1 138   1 057  
Others 1 335   1 287  





  11 091   11 933  





Due after more than one year:        
Accruals and deferred income 147   246  
Taxation on profits 365   377  
Others 129   182  





  641   805  





Total trade and other creditors 11 732   12 738  






Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 87
Unilever Group
 
   
Financial Statements

17 Pensions and similar obligations

Description of Plans
In most countries the Group operates de
fined benefit pension plans based on employee pensionable remuneration and length of service. The majority of these plans are externally funded; for the unfunded plans, provisions are maintained in the Group balance sheet. The Group also provides other post-retirement benefits, mainly post-retirement medical benefits in the United States. These plans are predominantly unfunded, with provisions maintained in the Group balance sheet.

The Group also operates a number of defined contribution plans, the assets of which are held in independently administered funds. The pension costs charged to the profit and loss account in respect of these plans represent the contributions payable by the Group to these funds.

Accounting policies
The Group currently accounts for pensions under the United Kingdom accounting standard SSAP 24. The objective of the standard is to spread pension costs systematically over the service lives of employees and for the regular costs to be a reasonably stable percentage of pay. Other post-retirement arrangements are currently accounted for in accordance with United States accounting standards SFAS 106 and SFAS 112 which apply principles similar to those for pensions in the UK. All plans are subject to regular actuarial review using the projected unit method, either by external consultants or by actuaries employed by Unilever. The actuarial assumptions used to calculate the bene
fit obligations vary according to the country in which the plan is situated. In line with the accounting objective, assumptions are generally set reflecting long-term expectations and asset values are smoothed relative to market values.

The UK Accounting Standards Board also requires companies to provide disclosures based on FRS 17, the objective of which is to present the pension and other post retirement benefit plans’ assets and liabilities at their fair value at the balance sheet date. Unilever will fully adopt FRS 17 as the basis for pension accounting from 1 January 2003. FRS 17 disclosures are given on pages 89 to 91.

SSAP 24– Pension and similar obligations

 Profit and loss account
€ million
2002
  
€ million
2001
  
€ million
2000
 







Charged to operating profit in staff costs:            
Defined benefit plans            
      Regular costs (354 ) (381 ) (324 )
      Special termination benefits (96 ) (78 ) (88 )
      Exceptional increase in irrecoverable surplus (46 )    
      Financing charge on pension provisions (136 ) (110 ) (117 )
      Amortisation of surplus/deficits 339   370   309  
Defined contribution plans (26 ) (24 ) (8 )
Other post-retirement benefits (97 ) (103 ) (77 )







Total pensions and other post-retirement benefits 3 (416 ) (326 ) (305 )







Pension costs, and contributions paid by the Group to the funded plans, have been reduced in recent years, mainly due to surpluses in the Group’s two biggest funds. These surpluses are recognised by amortisation through the profit and loss account using the mortgage method.

Balance Sheet
Pensions and similar obligations in the balance sheet are predominantly long-term liabilities comprising:

  € million   € million  
  2002   2001  





Unfunded pension plans 1 320   1 414  
Funded pension plans 987   987  
Other post-retirement benefit plans 1 073   1 284  





SSAP 24 pre-tax net liability 3 380   3 685  





Comprising:        
Asset balances reclassified as debtors due after more than one year 13 (840 ) (917 )
Provisions for liabilities and charges 4 220   4 602  





Movements during the year:        
      1 January 4 602      
      Currency retranslation (258 )    
      Profit and loss account 416      
      Payments (400 )    
      Acquisitions/disposals (74 )    
      Other adjustments (66 )    





      31 December 4 220      





Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

88 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

17 Pensions and similar obligations continued

Additional information
Group policy is that plans are formally valued at least every three years. The results of the valuations for the principal pension plans (that represent 90% of all defined benefit pension plans by market value of assets and net provisions) have been updated to the year end to provide the following aggregated information:

  € million   € million     € million   € million  
  31 December   31 December     31 December   31 December  
  2002   2001     2002   2001  
          Other post retirement  
      Pension plans         benefit plans  










Actuarial value of assets at the last valuation date 15 515   16 762     2   3  
Provisions 3 147   3 318     1 073   1 284  
Prepayments (840 ) (917 )      
Liabilities 16 590   16 306     1 042   1 210  
Financing level % (a) 107 % 118 %   103 % 106 %
Actual market value of assets 12 725   16 976     2   3  










(a) Actuarial value of assets plus net provision as % of liabilities.

The actuarial value of assets is generally a smoothed market value determined by spreading gains and losses relative to the actuarial basis over a three-to-five-year period.

Assumptions
The long-term average assumptions used for valuing the principal pension plans, weighted by liabilities, were:

  31 December   31 December  
  2002   2001  





Interest rate 6.0 % 7.0 %
Inflation 2.4 % 3.0 %
Salary increases 3.7 % 4.3 %
Pension increases 2.2 % 2.9 %





Assumptions for the remaining defined benefit plans vary considerably depending on the economic conditions of the country where they are situated.

For the most significant plans (representing over 75% of all defined benefit plans by liabilities) the assumptions at 31 December 2002 were:

  United Kingdom   Netherlands   United States   Germany  









Interest rate 5.4 % 6.5 % 6.5 % 5.8 %
Inflation 2.2 % 2.5 % 2.5 % 2.0 %
Salary increases 3.7 % 3.3 % 4.5 % 2.8 %
Pension increases 2.5 % 2.5 % 0.0 % 2.0 %









Pension contributions to funded pension plans are reviewed regularly. Following the latest reviews in the UK, the Netherlands and Germany, decisions have been made to recommence contributions in both the UK and Germany and the cash impact of this is expected to be €46 million in 2003.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts
89
   Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements

17 Pensions and similar obligations continued
FRS 17 Disclosures
With the objective of presenting pensions and other post retirement benefit plans’ assets and liabilities at their fair value on the balance sheet, assumptions for FRS 17 are set by reference to market conditions at the balance sheet date. As such, there will be differences between the assumptions used in SSAP 24 and those under FRS 17 and the values placed on assets and liabilities.

Assumptions
The major market-based actuarial assumptions, weighted by liabilities, used to value the principal defined benefit pension plans and plans providing other post-retirement benefits and the expected long-term rates of return on assets, weighted by asset value, were:

 
Principal
defined benefit
pension plans
 
31 Dec 2002
Other
post retirement
benefit plans
   
Principal
defined benefit
pension plans
 
31 Dec 2001
Other
post retirement
benefit plans
   
Principal
defined benefit
pension plans
 
31 Dec 2000
Other
post retirement
benefit plans
 















Discount rate 5.70 % 6.50 %   6.00 % 7.25 %   6.20 % 7.50 %
Inflation assumption 2.30 % n/a     2.25 % n/a     2.50 % n/a  
Rate of increase in salaries 3.60 % 4.30 %   3.50 % 4.50 %   3.80 % 4.50 %
Rate of increase for pensions in payment 2.20 % n/a     2.00 % n/a     2.10 % n/a  
Rate of increase for pensions in deferment (where provided) 2.60 % n/a     1.50 % n/a     2.30 % n/a  
Long-term medical cost inflation(a) n/a   4.90 %   n/a   5.00 %   n/a   5.00 %
Expected long-term rates of return:                            
   Equities 8.20 %       9.00 %       8.40 %    
   Bonds 4.90 %       5.50 %       5.30 %    
   Others 5.40 %       6.00 %       5.30 %    















   
(a) The valuations of other benefit plans generally assume a higher initial level of medical cost inflation, which falls from 10% to the long-term rate within the next five years.

Assumptions for the remaining defined benefits plans vary considerably depending on the economic conditions of the country where they are situated.

For the most significant pension plans, representing over 75% of all defined benefit plans by liabilities, the assumptions at 31 December 2002 were:

  United Kingdom   Netherlands   United States   Germany  









Discount rate 5.50 % 5.40 % 6.50 % 5.40 %
Inflation assumption 2.25 % 2.25 % 2.50 % 2.00 %
Rate of increase in salaries 3.75 % 3.00 % 4.50 % 2.75 %
Rate of increase for pensions in payment 2.50 % 2.25 % 0.00 % 2.00 %
Rate of increase for pensions in deferment (where provided) 2.50 % 2.25 % 0.00 % 0.00 %
Expected long-term rates of return:                
   Equities 8.00 % 8.30 % 8.30 % 8.30 %
   Bonds 4.90 % 4.70 % 4.30 % 4.70 %
   Others 5.80 % 5.60 % 4.30 % 4.90 %









Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

90   Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

17 Pensions and similar obligations continued
Balance Sheet
The assets, liabilities and surplus/deficit position of the pension and other post retirement benefit plans and the expected rates of return on the principal plan assets, at the balance sheet date, were:

  € million   € million   %     € million   € million   %  
     
Pension
plans
      31 December 2002       31 December 2001
Other post
retirement
benefit
plans
    
Long-term
rates of
return
expected
      
Pension
plans
    
Other post
retirement
benefit
plans
    
Long-term
rates of
return
expected
 














Assets of principal plans:                          
   Equities 7 281   8.2 %   10 494     9.0 %
   Bonds 3 383   4.9 %   4 138     5.5 %
   Other 1 644   5.4 %   1 808     6.0 %
Assets of other plans 417   2   8.2 %   536   3   8.0 %














Total plan assets 12 725 2         16 976   3      














Present value of liabilities: (a)                          
   Principal plans (15 305 )         (15 547 )      
   Other plans (1 675 ) (1 042 )       (1 781 ) (1 171 )    














Total present value of liabilities (16 980 ) (1 042 )       (17 328 ) (1 171 )    














Aggregate net surplus/(deficit) of the plans (4 255 ) (1 040 )       (352 ) (1 168 )    
Irrecoverable surplus (b) (87 )         (265 )      
Related deferred tax asset/(liability) 1 058 388         (74 ) 467      














Net pension asset/(liability) (3 284 ) (652 )       (691 ) (701 )    














                           
Of which in respect of                          
                           
Funded plans in surplus:                          
   Aggregate surplus 677           2 454        
   Irrecoverable surplus (b) (87 )         (265 )      
   Related deferred tax liability (209 )         (740 )      
   Net pension asset 381           1 449        
                           
Funded plans in deficit:                          
   Aggregate deficit (2 575 )         (607 )      
   Related deferred tax asset 808           199        
   Net pension liability (1 767 )         (408 )      
                           
Unfunded plans:                          
   Aggregate liability (2 357 ) (1 040 )       (2 199 ) (1 168 )    
   Related deferred tax asset 459   388         467   467      
   Net pension liability (1 898 ) (652 )       (1 732 ) (701 )    














   
(a)   The basis for valuation of risk benefits has been changed following the issue of UITF 35. The effect has been to increase the liabilities of the principal plans by €500 million as at 31 December 2002 (2001: €508 million).
(b)   The surplus in the plans is only recoverable to the extent that the Group can benefit from either refunds formally agreed or future contribution reductions.

If the above amounts had been recognised in the financial statements, the Group’s net assets and profit retained would be:

  € million   € million       € million   € million  
31 December 2002
31 December 2001
Net assets   Profit retained Net assets   Profit retained










Unilever Group as reported 6 495   5 777     7 657   6 417  
Excluding SSAP 24 net pre-tax liability 3 380   3 344     3 685   3 647  
Excluding associated deferred tax asset (691 ) (679 ) (843 ) (830 )
Including FRS 17 net liability after tax (3 936 ) (3 903 ) (1 392 ) (1 373 )




 




Net assets/profit retained including FRS 17 pension liability 5 248   4 539     9 107   7 861  










Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts
91
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

17 Pensions and similar obligations continued
Profit and loss account
Had FRS 17 been adopted in the preparation of the Group’s financial statements, the profit and loss account would have been as follows:

  € million    € million  
2002 2001





Charged to operating profit:        
Defined benefit pension and other benefit plans:        
   Current service cost (364 ) (384 )
   Special termination benefits (96 ) (79 )
   Past service cost 9   (16 )
   Gains on settlements/curtailments 119   9  
   Operating gain on irrecoverable surplus 7    
Defined contribution plans (26 ) (24 )





Total operating cost (351 ) (494 )





Charged to interest:        
Interest on retirement benefits (1 072 ) (1 121 )
Exceptional financing loss on recoverable surplus   (128 )
Expected return on assets 1 180 1 291  





Total interest cost 108   42  





Net impact on the profit and loss account (before tax) (243 ) (452 )





Statement of total recognised gains and losses
Had FRS 17 been adopted in the preparation of the Group’s financial statements, the following amounts would have been recognised in the statement of total recognised gains and losses:

  € million    € million  
2002 2001





Actual return less expected return on pension and other benefit plan assets (3 276 ) (2 343 )
Experience gains/(losses) arising on pension plan and other benefit plan liabilities (95 ) 197  
Changes in assumptions underlying the present value of the pension and other benefit plan liabilities (952 ) (198 )





         
Actuarial gain/(loss) to be recognised in statement of total recognised gains and losses (4 323)   (2 344 )





         

Reconciliation of change in surplus/deficit
Movements in surplus/deficit during the year:

  € million    € million   
2002 2001





Surplus/(deficit) at beginning of the year (1 520 ) 1 126  
Movements in year        
Current service cost (364 ) (384 )
Special termination benefits (96 ) (79 )
Past service costs 9   (16 )
Settlements/curtailments 119   9  
Other finance income 108   42  
Actuarial gain/(loss) (4 323 ) (2 344 )
Contributions 400   138  
Currency retranslation 372   (12 )





Surplus/(deficit) at end of the year (5 295 ) (1 520 )





         

History of experience gains and losses

  %    %  
2002 2001





Actual return less expected return on plan assets:        
   % of plan assets at beginning of year (19 ) (12 )
         
Experience gains/(losses) on plan liabilities:        
   % of present value of plan liabilities at beginning of year (1 ) 1  
         
Total actuarial gain/(loss):        
   % of present value of plan liabilities at beginning of year (23 ) (13 )





Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

92 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

17 Pensions and similar obligations continued
US GAAP disclosures
Under US GAAP, the actuarial assumptions used to calculate the benefit obligations are set by reference to market conditions at the balance sheet date, in a similar manner to that used under FRS 17. The accounting methodology however is not the same as under FRS 17 since certain cost items are amortised rather than recognised immediately.

The following tables summarise the balance sheet impact, as well as the benefit obligations, assets, funded status and economic assumptions associated with the key defined benefit pension plans and the other post retirement benefit plans as computed in accordance with SFAS 87 and SFAS 106. At 31 December 2002 these key defined benefit pension plans (‘key pension plans’) represented approximately 90% (2001: 76%; 2000: 76%) of all pension plans while 100% of the other post retirement benefit plans are represented (2001: 100%; 2000: 100%), based on the market value of the funds plus the provisions held in the Group’s accounts.

  million   million     million   million  
 
Key
pension
plans
2002
 
Key
pension
plans
2001
   
Other post
retirement
benefit plans
2002
 
Other post
retirement
benefit plans
2001










Change in benefit obligations                  
Benefit obligations at 1 January 12 750 12 047     1 171 1 132  
Extension of coverage (a) 2 261        
Service cost 315   252     20   20  
Interest cost 864   737     78   83  
Plan member contributions 8   1        
Amendments   90     (4 )  
Plan mergers 170   41        
Actuarial (gains)/losses 1 215 291     33    
Acquisitions/disposals (57 ) (11 )   (22 ) (12 )
Settlements/curtailments (321 ) (31 )     (3 )
Special termination benefits   29       1  
Benefits paid (1 204 ) (873 )   (88 ) (89 )
Currency retranslations (786 ) 177     (176 ) 39  










Benefit obligations at 31 December 15 215 12 750     1 012 1 171  










Change in plan assets                  
Fair value of plan assets at 1 January 13 560 15 401     3   3  
Extension of coverage (a) 2 320        
Plan mergers 154          
Actual return on plan assets (1 953 ) (928 )   (1 )  
Acquisitions/(disposals) (10 ) (11 )      
Settlements (249 ) (31 )      
Employer contribution/surplus refunds 36   (144 )   88   88  
Plan member contributions 8   1        
Benefits paid (1 118 ) (873 )   (88 ) (89 )
Currency retranslations (651 ) 145       1  










Fair value of plan assets at 31 December 12 097 13 560     2   3  










Funded status at 31 December (3 118 ) 810     (1 010 ) (1 168 ) 
Unrecognised net transition liability/(asset) (178 ) (247 )     3  
Unrecognised net actuarial loss/(gain) 3 285 (1 119 )    (34 ) (85 )
Unrecognised prior service cost 178   201     1   5  
Other (SFAS 112 liabilities) n/a   n/a     (30 ) (39 )










Net amount recognised at 31 December 167   (355 )   (1 073 ) (1 284 ) 










Amount recognised in the statement of financial position consists of:                  
Prepaid benefit cost 1 543 813        
Accrued benefit liability (1 376 ) (1 168 )    (1 069 ) (1 283 ) 
Additional minimum liability (2 454 ) (20 )      
Intangible asset 94   4        
Accumulated other comprehensive income 2 360 16     (4 ) (1 )










Net amount recognised at 31 December 167   (355 )   (1 073 ) (1 284 ) 










   
(a)   With effect from 1 January 2002 a number of additional pension plans were included in the SFAS 87 valuation exercise. This increases the overall coverage provided by the key pension plans from 76% to 90%.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts
93
   Unilever Group
 

 

Financial Statements

17 Pensions and similar obligations continued

 
%
 
%
 
%
   
%
 
%
 
%
 
 
Key
Pension plans
2002
 
Key
Pension plans
2001
 
Key
Pension plans
2000
   
Other post
retirement
benefit plans
2002
 
Other post
retirement
benefit plans
2001
 
Other post
retirement
benefit plans
2000
 














Weighted-average assumptions as at 31 December                          
Discount rate 5.70   6.00   6.25     6.50   7.25   7.50  
Expected return on plan assets 6.90   7.75   7.25     n/a   n/a   n/a  
Salary increases 3.60   3.75   3.75     4.30   4.50   4.50  
Pension increases 2.20   2.50   2.50     n/a   n/a   n/a  














The valuations of other benefit plans typically assume that medical cost inflation will fall from its current level (assumed to be approximately 10% in 2003) over the next few years and reach a constant level of 4.9% (2001: 5%; 2000: 5%) within five years.

 
€ million
 
€ million
 
€ million
   
€ million
 
€ million
 
€ million
 
Key
Pension plans
2002
Key
Pension plans
2001
Key
Pension plans
2000
Other post
retirement
benefit plans
2002
Other post
retirement
benefit plans
2001
Other post
retirement
benefit plans
2000














Components of net periodic benefit cost                          
Service cost (gross) 324   253   231     20   20   16  
Interest cost 864   737   698     78   83   64  
Expected return on plan assets (1 189 ) (1 007 )  (932 )        
Expected employee contributions (9 ) (1 )          
Amortisation of prior service cost 33   24   26          
Amortisation of transition (asset) (63 ) (63 ) (66 )        
Amortisation of actuarial loss/(gain) (45 ) (81 ) (58 )   (6 ) (2 ) (2 )














Total before SFAS 88 events (85 ) (138 ) (101 )   92   101   78  
Adjustments for SFAS 88 events (118 ) 43   19     (23 ) (2 ) (1 )














Net periodic benefit cost (203 ) (95 ) (82 )   69   99   77  














The projected benefit obligation, accumulated benefit obligation, and fair value of plan assets for the pension plans with accumulated benefit obligations in excess of plan assets were €11 015 million, €10 188 million, and €7 334 million respectively, as of 31 December 2002 and €2 171 million, €2 035 million, and €1 308 million respectively, as of 31 December 2001.

The Group also maintains a number of smaller defined benefit plans. Approximately €1 129 million (2001: €1 685 million) is provided for on their behalf in the Group balance sheet. In 2002, €158 million (2001: €202 million; 2000: €151 million) was charged in the accounts. These amounts would not have been materially different under SFAS 87.

In addition to the special termination benefits included in the table above, during 2002, the Group also charged €96 million (2001: €49 million; 2000: €56 million) in respect of pension or similar obligations arising on terminations of employment.

Expected return on plan assets
Beginning 1 January 2002 the Group changed its method for determining the expected return on plan assets under US GAAP by changing the value placed on the plan assets. The value now used is the fair value at the balance sheet date instead of a market related value calculated by smoothing asset gains and losses over a five year period. Management believe that using the actual fair value at the balance sheet date provides a better representation of the financial position of the Group. The impact of this change in methodology on reported results is given on pages 114 and 121.

Post-retirement health care benefits
Assumed health care cost trend rates have a significant effect on the amounts reported for the health care plans. A one-percentage-point change in assumed health care cost trend rates would have the following effects:

 
million
1% point
increase
 
million
1% point
decrease
 





Effect on total of service and interest cost components 7   (6 )
Effect on post-retirement benefit obligations 68   (62 )





Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

94
Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

18 Deferred taxation
United Kingdom Financial Reporting Standard 19 (FRS 19) ’Deferred Tax’, which requires full provision to be made for deferred taxes, has been adopted with effect from 1 January 2002. The impact on the balance sheet of adoption of this standard has been reflected in all periods covered by these accounts by means of a prior period adjustment. As Unilever has previously provided for deferred taxes on a full provision basis in accordance with Netherlands law, FRS 19 does not have a material impact on reported net profit.

FRS 19 does not allow deferred tax to be provided on the revaluation of fixed assets and therefore deferred tax so provided in respect of the revaluation of Bestfoods’ tangible fixed assets has been adjusted against goodwill in the comparative figures. Deferred tax was provided in respect of the planned remittance of unremitted earnings of Bestfoods’ subsidiaries; FRS 19 does not allow such provision unless the dividend has been declared. These deferred tax liabilities have also been adjusted against goodwill in the comparative figures. In addition, where (prior to 1998) tax-deductible goodwill was written off directly to reserves, FRS 19 does not allow a deferred tax asset to be created at acquisition. Instead, a deferred tax liability must be created over the life of the goodwill. The consequent reversal of deferred tax assets and creation of deferred tax liabilities has been adjusted in the comparative figures. These two adjustments result in a reduction of shareholders’ equity as at 31 December 2001 of € 202 million.

The implementation of FRS 19 has also changed the accounting treatment in the year ended 31 December 2000 for our (then) anticipated disposal of Elizabeth Arden. The effect of implementing FRS 19 means that operating profit for that year is reduced by €121 million, whilst the tax charge on ordinary activities is also reduced by €121 million. This adjustment has been made in the comparative figures for the year ended 31 December 2000. There is no impact on reported net profit.

Capital and reserves at 31 December 2001 have been reduced in aggregate by €202 million (2000: €195 million). In the 2001 closing balance sheet, goodwill has been reduced by €133 million (2000: €77 million) while debtors have been reduced by €60 million (2000: €91 million) through a reduction in deferred tax assets. Deferred tax liabilities at the end of 2001 have been increased by €9 million (2000: €27 million).

There are no material unrecognised deferred tax assets.

 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Deferred taxation on:        
Accelerated depreciation 877   1 009  
Stock reliefs 41   55  
Pension and similar provisions (691 ) (843 )
Short-term and other timing differences (1 015 ) (921 )





  (788 ) (700 )
Less asset balances reclassified as debtors        
due after more than one year 13 1 292   1 610  





  504   910  





Movements in deferred taxation:        
1 January 910      
Currency retranslation 187      
Acquisition/disposal of group companies 17      
Profit and loss account (292 )    
Other movements (318 )    





31 December 504      





Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts
95
   Unilever Group
 

 

Financial Statements

19 Restructuring and other provisions
Provisions are recognised when either a legal or constructive obligation, as a result of a past event, exists at the balance sheet date and where the amount of the obligation can be reasonably estimated.

 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Restructuring provisions 633   773  
Other provisions 555   586  





Total 1 188   1 359  





Movements in restructuring provisions:        
1 January 773      
Currency retranslation (54 )    
Acquisition/disposal of group companies 5      
Profit and loss account:        
   New charges 575      
   Releases (56 )    
Utilisation (610 )    





31 December 633      





Movements in other provisions:        
1 January 586      
Currency retranslation (100 )    
Acquisition/disposal of group companies 179      
Profit and loss account (80 )    
Utilisation (30 )    





31 December 555      





Restructuring provisions at the end of 2002 relate to the Path to Growth initiatives described in note 4 on page 77. These amounted to €0.6 billion the cash impact of which is expected to be a cash outflow of €0.4 billion in 2003 and €0.2 billion thereafter. Other provisions principally comprise balances held in respect of legal, environmental and other exposures. The cash impact of these balances is expected to be a cash outflow of €0.2 billion in 2003, and €0.4 billion thereafter.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

96
Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

20 Capital and reserves
From 1 January 2002, Unilever has adopted UK Financial Reporting Standard 19 (FRS 19) ‘Deferred Tax’ which requires full provision to be made for deferred taxes. The impact of the adoption of FRS 19 was as follows:

 
€ million
As at
31 December
2001
 
€ million
As at
31 December
2000
 
€ million
As at
31 December
1999
 







Shareholders’ equity as previously reported 7 195   8 169   7 761  
Accounting policy change (202 ) (195 ) (306 )







Shareholders’ equity as restated 6 993   7 974   7 455  







The table below presents combined disclosure of movements in capital and reserves of NV and PLC for the years 2002, 2001 and 2000 in order to show these changes for the Unilever Group as a whole. This information does not reflect the separate legal status of NV and PLC; information on capital and reserves attributable to each of NV and PLC is given in notes 21 and 23 on pages 97 and 98.

 
million
Called up
share capital
 
million
Share premium
account
 
million
Other reserves
 
million
Profit retained
 
million
Total
 











2002 (a)                    
1 January 2002 642   1 551 (1 617 ) 6 417   6 993  
Result for the year retained       428   428  
Goodwill movements       458   458  
Unrealised gain on partial disposal of a group company       56   56  
Currency retranslation   (10 ) 75   (1 582 ) (1 517 )
Change in book value of shares or certificates held                    
in connection with share options     (551 )   (551 )
31 December 2002 642   1 541 (2 093 ) 5 777   5 867  











2001 (a)                    
1 January 2001 642   1 548   (1 167 ) 6 951   7 974  
Result for the year retained       257   257  
Goodwill movements       274   274  
Currency retranslation   3   (14 ) (1 065 ) (1 076 )
Change in book value of shares or certificates held                    
in connection with share options     (436 )   (436 )
31 December 2001 642   1 551   (1 617 ) 6 417   6 993  











2000 (a)                    
1 January 2000 642   1 547   (971 ) 6 237   7 455  
Result for the year retained       (353 ) (353 )
Goodwill movements (b)       1 314   1 314  
Currency retranslation   1   (12 ) (247 ) (258 )
Change in book value of shares or certificates held                    
in connection with share options     (184 )   (184
31 December 2000 642   1 548   (1 167 ) 6 951   7 974  











As required by UK Financial Reporting Standard 4 capital and reserves can be analysed as follows:

 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Equity:        
   Ordinary capital 4 365   5 491  





Non-equity:        
   7% Cumulative Preference 13   13  
   6% Cumulative Preference 73   73  
   4% Cumulative Preference 34   34  
   5 euro cents Cumulative Preference 1 382   1 382  





Total non-equity 1 502   1 502  





Total capital and reserves 5 867   6 993  





(a) Restated for FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.
(b) Includes 980 million written back in 2000 in respect of the agreed disposal of Elizabeth Arden.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 97
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

21  Called up share capital


million
Authorised
2002
  million
Authorised
2001
    Preferential share capital
NV
  Nominal value
per share
 

Number of
shares issued
 

  million
Issued,

called up and
fully paid 2002
  million
Issued,
called up and fully paid 2001
 















                     34   34     7% Cumulative Preference   €453.78   29 000   13   13  
                     91   91     6% Cumulative Preference   €453.78   161 060   73   73  
                     34   34     4% Cumulative Preference   €45.38   750 000   34   34  
                     29   29     5 euro cents Cumulative Preference   €0.05   211 473 785   10   10  















               188   188                 130   130  















                             
          Ordinary share capital                  
          NV                  
               508   508     Ordinary   €0.51   571 575 900   290   290  
                        1   1     Ordinary (Shares numbered                  
          1 to 2 400 – ‘Special Shares’)   €453.78   2 400   1   1  
                               Internal holdings eliminated in consolidation (€453.78 shares)         (1 ) (1 )















               509   509                 290   290  















          Total NV share capital           420   420  















                             
      £ million    £ million      Ordinary share capital              £ million    £ million   
            2002 2001 PLC     2002 2001















         136.2   136.2     Ordinary:   1.4 p 2 911 458 580   40.8   40.8  
                  0.1   0.1     Deferred   £1 stock   100 000   0.1   0.1  
                               Internal holdings eliminated in consolidation (£1 stock)         (0.1 ) (0.1 )















         136.3   136.3     Total PLC share capital           40.8   40.8  















          Euro equivalent in millions (at £1 = €5.445)           222   222  















For NV share capital, the euro amounts shown above and elsewhere in this document are representations in euros on the basis of Article 67c of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, rounded to two decimal places, of underlying amounts of share capital in Dutch guilders, which have not been converted into euros in NV’s Articles of Association. Until conversion formally takes place by amendment of the Articles of Association the entitlements to dividends and voting rights are based on the underlying Dutch guilder amounts.

The 7%, 6% and 4% preference shares of NV are entitled to dividends at the rates indicated. The €0.05 preference shares of NV are entitled to a dividend of 65% of the six months Euribor interest rate on their notional value of €6.580 each. A nominal dividend of 1/4 % is paid on the deferred stock of PLC.

The 4% cumulative preference capital of NV is redeemable at par at the Company’s option either wholly or in part.

The Company has agreed that it will not buy back the €0.05 cumulative preference share capital of NV before 9 June 2004. At any time after this date, at the Company’s option, €6.534 of the notional value of the preference shares is convertible into ordinary NV shares and the remaining notional value is then redeemable. The Company expects to exercise the conversion right if any preference shares remain outstanding after 1 December 2004.

The other classes of preferential share capital of NV and the deferred stock of PLC are not redeemable.

For information on the rights of shareholders of NV and PLC and the operation of the Equalisation Agreement see ‘Control of Unilever’ on pages 138 to 141.

Internal holdings
The ordinary shares numbered 1 to 2 400 (inclusive) in NV and deferred stock of PLC are held as to one half of each class by N.V. Elma – a subsidiary of NV – and one half by United Holdings Limited – a subsidiary of PLC. This capital is eliminated in consolidation. It carries the right to nominate persons for election as directors at general meetings of shareholders. The subsidiaries mentioned above have waived their rights to dividends on their ordinary shares in NV. For more information see ‘Control of Unilever’ on pages 138 to 141.

Share options
The Group operates a number of equity-based compensation plans involving options over ordinary shares of NV and PLC. Full details of these plans are given in note 29 on page 103.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

98 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group
   
   

22  Profit retained

  € million   € million   € million     € million   € million   € million  
NV NV NV   PLC PLC PLC
2002 2001 2000   2002 2001 2000














Net profit 1 681   817   675     448   1 021   430  
Preference dividends (42 ) (51 ) (44 )        
Dividends on ordinary capital (941 ) (868 ) (803 )   (718 ) (662 ) (611 )







 





Result for the year retained 698   (102 ) (172 )   (270 ) 359   (181 )
Goodwill movements 158   192   1 005     300   82   309  
Unrealised gain on partial disposal of a group company         56      
Adjustment arising from change in ownership of group companies (a)  1 646                 (1 646 )           
Currency retranslation (1 270 ) (815 ) (384 )   (312 ) (250 ) 137  







 





Net movement during the year 1 232   (725 ) 449     (1 872 )  191   265  
Profit retained – 1 January (b) 4 149   4 874   4 425     2 268   2 077   1 812  







 





Profit retained – 31 December 5 381   4 149   4 874     396   2 268   2 077  







 





Of which retained by:                          
Parent companies 6 591   3 508   2 375     1 590   1 552   1 499  
Other group companies (1 179 ) 630   2 494     (1 205 )  713   576  
Joint ventures and associates (31 ) 11   5     11   3   2  







 





  5 381   4 149   4 874     396   2 268   2 077  







 





Cumulative goodwill written off directly to reserves (5 298 )  (5 456 )  (5 648 )    (2 099 )  (2 399 )  (2 481 ) 







 





 
(a) Arising from the legal integration of Bestfoods into Unilever, following which a number of group companies are partly held by Unilever United States, Inc. and therefore are ultimately owned jointly by NV and PLC. As a result of this, goodwill of €1 646 million arising in PLC has been eliminated in reserves on consolidation.
(b) Profit retained has been restated following the adoption of FRS 19. Profit retained at 1 January 2000 has been reduced in aggregate by €306 million (of which €245 million relates to NV and €61 million relates to PLC). Movements in profit retained since 1 January 2000 have been restated as appropriate. See note 18 on page 94.

23 Other reserves

  € million   € million   € million   € million   € million   € million  
  NV   NV   NV   PLC   PLC   PLC  
  2002   2001   2000   2002   2001   2000  













Adjustment on translation of PLC‘s ordinary                        
capital at £1 = Fl. 12 = €5.445       (159 ) (155 ) (157 )
Capital redemption reserve       18   18   18  
Book value of shares or certificates held in                        
connection with share options(a) (1 498)   (1 077)   (553 ) (454 ) (403 ) (475 )













  (1 498)   (1 077)   (553 ) (595 ) (540 ) (614 )













(a) Under UITF 13 these shares would be classified as fixed assets.

The change in book value of shares or certificates held in connection with share options on the other reserves of NV was €(421) million (2001: €(524) million; 2000: €(189) million) and for PLC was €(51) million (2001: €72 million; 2000: €(7) million).

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 99
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

24  Commitments and contingent liabilities

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Long-term lease commitments under operating leases in respect of:            
Land and buildings 1 399
 
1 419
 
1 777
 
Other tangible fixed assets 475   615   793  







  1 874   2 034   2 570  







The commitments fall due as follows:            
Within 1 year 321   392   488  
After 1 year but within 2 years 301   330   414  
After 2 years but within 3 years 260   273   347  
After 3 years but within 4 years 226   249   308  
After 4 years but within 5 years 204   217   266  
After 5 years 562   573   747  







  1 874   2 034   2 570  







Other commitments 516   407   310  
Of which payable within one year 226   108   82  







 

In addition to the above Unilever has long-term global and regional supply contracts for a variety of materials and services. Amounts contracted under these arrangements are approximately €3 billion, including €750 million over seven years for global telecommunications services and €500 million over four years for advertising in the UK.

Contingent liabilities amounted to some €511 million (2001: €443 million) of which €176 million (2001: €202 million) relates to guarantees. These guarantees are not expected to give rise to any material loss. Guarantees given by parent or group companies relating to liabilities included in the consolidated accounts are not included. Other contingent liabilities arise in respect of litigation against companies in the Group, investigations by competition and regulatory authorities and obligations under environmental legislation in various countries. These are not expected to give rise to any material loss.

25  Acquisition and disposal of group companies
Acquisitions
The net assets and results of acquired businesses are included in the consolidated accounts from their respective dates of acquisition. The following tables set out the effect of acquisitions of group companies in 2002 on the consolidated balance sheet. Acquisition accounting (purchase accounting) has been applied in all cases. The fair values currently established for all acquisitions made in 2002 are provisional. The goodwill arising on these transactions has been capitalised and is being amortised over 20 years.

The following acquisition tables include the impact of the restructuring of the Bestfoods Robertsons (Holdings) Limited LLC joint venture (‘Unilever Bestfoods Robertsons’). On 1 April 2002, Unilever disposed of its assets in Unifoods South Africa and Hudson & Knight South Africa to Unilever Bestfoods Robertsons, a joint venture between Unilever and Robertsons in which Unilever had a 50% equity stake. In exchange, Unilever received a 9% equity interest in Unilever Bestfoods Robertsons thereby obtaining control.

This transaction has been accounted for in accordance with United Kingdom Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract 31 (‘UITF 31’) ‘Exchange of businesses or other non-monetary assets for an interest in a subsidiary, joint venture or associate’. The net effect of this transaction was to dispose of a 41% interest in the Unifoods South Africa and Hudson & Knight South Africa businesses in return for the acquisition of an additional 9% interest in Unilever Bestfoods Robertsons. The unrealised gain on disposal of the 41% interest was €56 million and, in accordance with UITF 31, has been recognised in the Statement of Total Recognised Gains and Losses.

      € million       € million       € million       € million      
  Provisional   Provisional
Balance sheets adjustments to   fair values
of acquired align accounting Provisional at date of
businesses policies revaluations acquisition









2002 acquisitions                
Fixed assets 122   (4 )   118  
Current assets 116     (1 ) 115  
Creditors (74 )   (1 ) (75 )
Provisions for liabilities and charges (10 ) (1 )   (11 )
Minority interest   (42 )   (42 )









  154   (47 ) (2 ) 105  
Adjustment to reflect 50% net assets previously owned             (68 )









Net assets acquired             37  









 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

100 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group
   
   

25  Acquisition and disposal of group companies continued

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Acquisitions            
Net assets acquired 37   49   3 910  
Adjustments to acquisitions made in 2000   5 546    
Goodwill arising in subsidiaries 116   (5 407 ) 26 019  
Goodwill arising in joint ventures   (51 ) 632  







Consideration 153   137   30 561  







Of which:            
Cash 27 57   132   27 777  
Cash balances of businesses acquired   1   231  
Current investments, cash deposits and borrowings of businesses acquired 77   1   3 100  
Non-cash items and deferred consideration (57 ) 3   (547 )
Fair value of Unilever business contributed 76      







Disposals
The results of disposed businesses are included in the consolidated accounts up to their date of disposal. In 2001, disposed businesses principally comprised Unipath and Batchelors/Oxo in the United Kingdom, Royco in the Netherlands and Elizabeth Arden and Gortons in the USA.

Included in the following table is the disposal of the DiverseyLever business. On 3 May 2002, Unilever disposed of its DiverseyLever business to JohnsonDiversey Inc. in exchange for cash, loan notes and a 33.3% stake in JohnsonDiversey’s parent, JohnsonDiversey Holdings Inc. The net consideration received, including our share of the net debt of JohnsonDiversey Holdings Inc. group was €1 053 million. Johnson Professional Holdings Inc. also contributed its own professional cleaning business to JohnsonDiversey Inc.

This transaction has been accounted for in accordance with UITF 31. The net effect of this transaction was to dispose of a 66.6% interest in DiverseyLever and to acquire a 33.3% interest in Johnson Professional’s professional cleaning business.

Unilever’s acquired share of net assets of the Johnson professional cleaning business has been recorded at fair value, with the difference between this and the fair value of the consideration given in return being recorded as goodwill. The goodwill arising of €178 million is being amortised over 20 years. Unilever retained an interest in DiverseyLever which is included at its pre-transaction carrying amount.

To the extent that the fair value of the consideration received by Unilever exceeds the book value of the Diversey Lever business disposed, Unilever has recognised a gain of €98 million, after taking into account certain provisions recorded in respect of the disposal. Unilever’s 33.3% interest in JohnsonDiversey Holdings Inc. is accounted for by Unilever as an associated undertaking.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 101
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

25  Acquisition and disposal of group companies continued
Disposals

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Goodwill and intangible assets 274   6    
Other fixed assets 531   273   276  
Current assets 776   351   203  
Creditors (330 ) (112 ) (219 )
Provisions for liabilities and charges (100 ) (11 ) (51 )
Minority interest 3   (2 ) 8  







  1 154 505   217  
33% interest in DiverseyLever (114 )    







Net assets sold 1 040 505   217  
Specific provisions related to the disposal 159      
Attributable goodwill 458   223   258  
Profit on sale attributable to Unilever 249   927   167  







Consideration 1 906 1 655   642  







Of which:            
Cash 27 1 834 1 650   626  
Cash balances of businesses sold 27 (34 ) (9 ) 11  
Current investments, cash deposits and borrowings of businesses sold 19   3   2  
Non cash and deferred consideration 217   11   3  
Fair value of Johnson Professional business acquired (130 )    







During 2001 we completed the disposal of Elizabeth Arden, which is therefore reflected in the table above. A charge of €980 million was recognised in 2000 in respect of an impairment of Elizabeth Arden goodwill previously written off to reserves.

26  Reconciliation of group operating profit to operating cashflows

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Group operating profit 5 041   5 174   3 181  
Depreciation and amortisation 2 582   2 845   1 954  
Changes in working capital:            
   Stocks (98 ) (177 ) 415  
   Debtors 88   (40 ) (28 )
   Creditors 463   440   302  
Pensions and similar provisions less payments (44 ) 114   475  
Restructuring and other provisions less payments (53 ) 173   (204 )
Elimination of (profits)/losses on disposals (143 ) (941 ) 785  
Other adjustments 47   (91 ) (142 )







Cash flow from group operating activities 7 883   7 497   6 738  







Cash flow from group operating activities in 2000 included payments of approximately €550 million to settle share options and similar obligations in Bestfoods consequent to the change of control.

Cash flow from exceptional items included in the group operating profit above comprises:

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Restructuring (406 ) (1 131 ) (485 )
Business disposals 1 834   1 650   626  
Other, including asset disposals 229   429   428  







Total 1 657   948   569  







Of which related to items included in group operating profit in the current year 2 064   1 313      
Of which related to items included in group operating profit in prior years (407 ) (365 )    







Total 1 657   948      







Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

102 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

27  Analysis of cash flows for headings netted in the cash flow statement

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Returns on investments and servicing of finance            
Dividends from other fixed investments 8   7   4  
Interest received 324   191   346  
Interest paid (1 467 ) (1 842 )  (966 )
Preference dividend paid (31 ) (48 ) (41 )
Dividends and other payments to minority shareholders (220 ) (195 ) (141 )







Total (1 386 ) (1 887 )  (798 )







Capital expenditure and financial investment            
Purchase of intangible assets (18 )    
Purchase of tangible fixed assets (1 295 ) (1 536 )  (1 361 ) 
Disposal of tangible fixed assets 233   579   471  
Acquisition/disposal of fixed investments (68 ) 35   13  
Purchase of own shares (employee share plans) (558 ) (436 ) (184 )







Total (1 706 ) (1 358 )  (1 061 ) 







Acquisitions and disposals            
Acquisition of group companies 25 (57 ) (132 ) (27 777 ) 
             
Bestfoods     (23 623 ) 
Other acquisitions (57 ) (132 ) (4 154 ) 
Cash balances of businesses acquired   (1 ) (231 )
             
Bestfoods     (22 )
Other acquisitions   (1 ) (209 )
Consideration paid in respect of acquisitions made in previous years   (1 ) (2 )
Disposal of acquired business held for resale   1 968    
Disposal of group companies 25 1 834 1 650   626  
Cash balances of businesses sold 25 (34 ) (9 ) 11  
Consideration received in respect of disposals made in previous years 12   2    







Total 1 755 3 477   (27 373 ) 







Management of liquid resources            
Purchase of current investments (219 ) (108 ) (217 )
Sale of current investments 30   121   1 428  
(Increase)/decrease in cash on deposit (403 ) 1 093   1 253  







Total (592 ) 1 106   2 464  







Financing            
Issue/purchase of shares by group companies to/(from) minority shareholders 9   (3 ) (18 )
Debt due within one year:            
   Increases 2 698 3 854   15 001  
   Repayments (8 347 ) (13 618 )  (2 716 ) 
Debt after one year:            
   Increases 3 195 4 933   10 692  
   Repayments (146 ) (264 ) (57 )







Total (2 591 ) (5 098 )  22 902  







Included as liquid resources are term deposits of less than one year, government securities and A- or higher rated money and capital market instruments.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 103
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

28 Analysis of net funds/(debt)

 
€ million
 
€ million
 
€ million
 
€ million
 
€ million
 
€ million
 
          Acquisitions/              
          disposals   Other          
  1 January   Cash   (excl. cash &   non-cash   Currency   31 December  
  2002   flow   overdrafts)   changes   movements   2002  













Cash on call and in hand 1 576   (46 )         72   1 602  
Overdrafts (400 ) 95           28   (277 )













      49                  
                         
Borrowings due within one year (10 879 ) 5 649   7   (4 579 ) 568   (9 234 ) 
Borrowings due after one year (14 221 ) (3 049 ) (64 ) 5 346   1 055   (10 933 ) 













      2 600                  
                         
Current investments 439   189   (1 ) 700   (101 ) 1 226  
Cash on deposit 286   403       (39 ) 650  













      592                  













Net funds/(debt) (23 199 ) 3 241   (58 ) 1 467   1 583   (16 966 )


Other non-cash changes include profits and losses on disposal and adjustments to realisable value of current investments; exchange gains and losses on inter-company borrowings and related derivatives; and the reclassification of long-term borrowings falling due within one year at the balance sheet date.

29 Equity-based compensation plans
As at 31 December 2002, the Group had a number of equity-based compensation plans:

(i)  All-Employee Option Plans
Local All-Employee Option Plans have been set up in 16 countries to enhance employee involvement with Unilever and its performance by providing a potential financial benefit linked to the Unilever share price. There are no individual performance targets to be met. The plans permit participation by all permanent employees in the country where the relevant plan applies.

(ii)  Executive Option Plans
The Executive Option Plans were introduced in 1985 to reward key employees throughout the world for their contribution to the enhancement of the Group’s longer-term future and their commitment to the Group over a sustained period. The grant is dependent on performance of the Group and the individual.

(iii)  The Share Matching Plans
If managers invest part of their annual bonus in Unilever shares, the Company will match this with the same number of shares on the condition that they keep all shares for an agreed number of years and will still be employed by Unilever on the vesting date.

(iv)  The TSR Long-Term Incentive Plan
This plan was introduced in 2001 and depending on the TSR ranking (see page 40 and 41) of Unilever in comparison with its peer group it will potentially award top executives on the vesting date three years later with a number of Unilever shares.

(v)  The Restricted Share Plan
Restricted shares are awarded to a select number of executives for special performance. After the agreed number of years the awards will vest provided they are still employed by Unilever at that time.

(vi)  The North American Performance Share Plan
A long-term incentive plan for North American managers awarding Unilever shares if company and personal performance targets are met over a three-year period.

Unilever will not grant share options in total in respect of Executive Option Plans of more than 5% of its issued ordinary capital, and for all Plans together, of more than 10% of its issued ordinary capital. The Board does not apportion these limits to each plan separately.

In recent years we have met the obligations under our share option and award plans by purchasing shares in advance and transferring them, in return for the grant price, to directors and employees as the options are exercised.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

104 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group

29 Equity-based compensation plans continued

The Group applies accounting policies based on Netherlands law and UK GAAP which are consistent with APB Opinion 25 and related interpretations in accounting for these plans. Accordingly, the Group has recognised the following compensation costs: €86 million in 2002, €46 million in 2001 and €6 million in 2000. Had the Group accounted for options under the requirement of SFAS 123, the impact on reported results would have been as follows:

  € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000  







Net profit as reported 2 129   1 838   1 105  
Add back actual compensation costs recognised 86   46   6  
Less pro forma compensation cost under SFAS 123(a) (185 ) (106 ) (57 )
Pro forma net profit under SFAS 123 2 030   1 778   1 054  







         
Euros per €0.51
        Euro cents per 1.4p  












  2002   2001   2000     2002   2001   2000  














Actual earnings per share 2.14   1.82   1.07     32.05   27.27   16.08  
Pro forma earnings per share 2.04   1.76   1.02     30.53   26.36   15.32  
Actual diluted earnings per share 2.07   1.77   1.05     31.10   26.54   15.69  
Pro forma diluted earnings per share 1.97   1.71   1.00     29.62   25.65   14.94  














(a) Included in this amount is2 million (2001: nil; 2000: nil) relating to the HLL Executive Option Plan in India. See also under Executive Option Plans on page 106.

The remaining disclosures required by SFAS 123, including a description of the method and significant assumptions used to estimate the fair values of options and the weighted-average information, are given below for each type of plan, on a combined basis.

(i) All-Employee Option Plans

Unilever has All-Employee Plans in 16 countries, which can be grouped together as follows:

(a) Plans which follow a standard framework: Austria, Belgium, Denmark, Finland, France, Germany, Ireland, Italy, Netherlands, Portugal, Spain, Sweden and Switzerland.
(b) Other plans: North America, South Africa and United Kingdom.

Group (a):
The standard framework for these countries means, in principle, an annual grant of options over NV shares, at the same grant date, exercise price (the market price on the grant date) and grant size (including part-time employees pro rata) and with the same eligibility criteria (all permanent employees in a country). There are no vesting conditions other than being continuously employed by a Group company until the vesting date.

Group (b):
The UK and South Africa plans annually offer options over PLC shares, combined with a compulsory (UK) or optional (South Africa) savings plan. The exercise price is the market price at date of grant, except that prior to 2000 the exercise price of the UK plan was set at either 80% or 90% of the market price with the discount being amortised to remuneration cost over the vesting period.

The North American plan is a share purchase offering, with a compulsory savings plan, under which up to 10% of the salary of eligible employees is withheld. At the end of the period employees can use the savings to buy NV New York shares at a discount of 10%. This discount is amortised to remuneration cost over the vesting period. The maximum number of shares made available under the plan is 8.9 million. Until 2001 the plan had an offering period of two years; the 2002 plan one year.

The table below summarises the main country-specific differences between the plans applicable in 2002:

  Maximum term Vesting period    
Country (year of introduction) Years Years Exercise period Remarks





Austria (2001) 5 3 24 months  
Belgium (2001) 5 4 12 months  
Denmark (2001) 5 3 24 months  
Finland (2001) 5 3 24 months On 3rd, 4th or 5th anniversary
France (2000) 5.5 5 6 months  
Germany (2000) 5 3 24 months  
Ireland (2002) 5 3 24 months  
Italy (2001) 5 3 24 months  
Netherlands (1995) 5 0 5 years Keep shares during the first
        3 years after grant
Portugal (2001) 3.5 3 6 months  
Spain (2001) 5 3 24 months  
Sweden (2001) 5 5 1 day Partly convertible bonds
Switzerland (2001) 5 3 24 months  
UK (1985) 5.5 5 6 months Sharesave plan
South Africa (2001) 3.5 3 6 months Optional sharesave plan
North America (1995) 1 1 1 day Purchase plan





Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 105
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

29  Equity-based compensation plans continued
A summary of the status of the All-Employee Plans as at 31 December 2002, 2001 and 2000 and changes during the years ended on these dates is presented below:

      2002       2001       2000  
      Weighted       Weighted       Weighted  
  Number of   average   Number of   average   Number of   average  
  shares   price   shares   price   shares   price  













NV shares of €0.51                        
Outstanding at 1 January 3 109 260   €60.56   1 634 437   €54.41   690 838   €54.38  
Granted 1 589 107   €67.90   1 853 007   €64.65   1 204 863   €53.05  
Exercised (322 625 ) €58.72   (225 614 )  €51.85   (125 707 )  €40.72  
Forfeited/Expired (a) (349 312 ) €63.24   (152 570 )  €57.10   (135 557 )  €54.94  













Outstanding at 31 December 4 026 430   €63.38   3 109 260   €60.56   1 634 437   €54.41  













Exercisable at 31 December 231 979   €67.90   42 412   €42.99   94 861   €37.58  













PLC shares of 1.4p                        
Outstanding at 1 January 22 002 314   £4.61   26 512 577   £4.14   30 777 318   £4.00  
Granted 4 122 000   £6.06   4 411 833   £5.29   7 960 043   £4.25  
Exercised (5 771 480 ) £3.78   (5 756 768 )  £2.94   (5 717 614 )  £2.74  
Forfeited/Expired (a) (2 347 242 ) £4.90   (3 165 328 )  £4.62   (6 507 170 )  £4.84  













Outstanding at 31 December 18 005 592   £5.17   22 002 314   £4.61   26 512 577   £4.14  













Exercisable at 31 December 430 696   £3.71   250 760   £2.78   192 156   £2.68  













NV New York shares of €0.51                        
Outstanding at 1 January     470 680   $52.43   633 913   $52.43  
Granted 149 431   $54.11          
Exercised     (255 208 )  $52.43      
Forfeited/Expired (a)     (215 472 )  $52.43   (163 233 )  $52.43  













Outstanding at 31 December 149 431   $54.11       470 680   $52.43  













Exercisable at 31 December            













(a)      The number of expired options is immaterial.

  2002   2001   2000  







NV option value information (b)            
Fair value per option (c) €14.66   €15.13   €10.18  
Valuation assumptions            
      Expected option term 3.8 years   3.5 years   4.0 years  
      Expected volatility 26.8%   29.3%   28.6%  
      Expected dividend yield 2.4%   2.2%   4.5%  
Risk-free interest rate 4.5%   4.5%   4.9%  







PLC option value information (b)            
Fair value per option (c) £1.57   £1.31   £1.05  
Valuation assumptions            
      Expected option term 4.7 years   4.7 years   5.0 years  
      Expected volatility 28.5%   28.1%   25.6%  
      Expected dividend yield 2.5%   2.8%   3.3%  
Risk-free interest rate 5.2%   5.4%   5.7%  







NV New York shares option value information (b)            
Fair value per option (c) $8.57      
Valuation assumptions            
      Expected option term 1 year      
      Expected volatility 25.2%      
      Expected dividend yield 2.5%      
Risk-free interest rate 1.2%      







Actual compensation costs recognised (€ million) 2   4   4  







(b) Weighted average of options granted during each period.
(c) Estimated using Black Scholes option pricing method.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

106 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group
   

29  Equity-based compensation plans continued
The exercise prices and remaining life of the All-Employee Option Plans as at 31 December 2002 are as follows:

          Options outstanding   Options exercisable  









          Weighted              
      Number   average       Number      
      outstanding at   remaining   Weighted   exercisable at   Weighted  
  Range of   31 December   contractual   average   31 December   average  
  exercise prices   2002   life   exercise price   2002   exercise price  













NV shares of €0.51 €53.05 - €57.63   897 413   2 years   €53.77      
  €63.65 - €70.00   3 129 017   4 years   €66.28   231 979   €67.90  









PLC shares of 1.4p £3.71 - £4.25   5 832 050   3 years   £4.21   430 696   £3.71  
  £5.14 - £6.20   12 173 542   3 years   £5.63      













NV New York shares of €0.51 $54.11   149 431   1 year   $54.11      













(ii)  Executive Option Plans
The Executive Option Plans are made up of the following plans, which are granted to key employees of the Group on a discretionary basis:

The NV Executive Option Plan
The NV Executive Option Plan provides for the granting of options to purchase shares of Unilever N.V. and, from 1997 onwards, also shares of Unilever PLC, at a price not lower than the market price on the day the options were granted. Options granted until March 2001 become exercisable immediately from the date of grant but cannot be sold within three years; options granted from November 2001 become exercisable after three years. The options have a maximum term of five years for the grants made up to 1998 and of ten years for subsequent grants.

The PLC Executive Option Plan
The PLC Executive Option Plan provides for the granting of options to purchase shares of Unilever PLC and from 1997 onwards, also shares of Unilever N.V., at a price not lower than the market price on the day the options were granted. These options become exercisable after a three-year period from the date of grant and have a maximum term of ten years.

The NA Executive Option Plan
The NA Executive Option Plan provides for the granting of options to purchase a maximum of 40.5 million shares in Unilever N.V. of the New York Registry, and 262.0 million shares of Unilever PLC, at a price not lower than the market value on the day the options are granted. These options become exercisable over a three-year period from the date of grant and have a maximum term of ten years.

In addition, managers working in India can participate in an Executive Option Plan relating to Hindustan Lever Limited’s shares. As these are neither NV nor PLC shares, no figures for this plan are disclosed in this note.

A summary of the status of the Executive Option Plans as at 31 December 2002, 2001 and 2000 and changes during the years ended on these dates is presented below:

      2002       2001       2000  
      Weighted       Weighted       Weighted  
  Number of   average   Number of   average   Number of   average  
  shares   price   shares   price   shares   price  













NV shares of €0.51                        
Outstanding at 1 January 8 198 049 €58.95   4 835 834   €57.68   3 856 658   €54.49  
Granted 3 658 548 €66.84   4 017 741   €58.26   1 659 616   €54.56  
Exercised (373 219 ) €51.37   (372 052 ) €33.83   (615 538 ) €28.88  
Forfeited/Expired (a) (343 981 ) €62.73   (283 474 ) €60.40   (64 902 ) €61.73  













Outstanding at 31 December 11 139 397 €61.71   8 198 049   €58.95   4 835 834   €57.68  













Exercisable at 31 December 4 795 216 €59.84   4 788 521   €58.75   3 418 554   €56.22  













PLC shares of 1.4p                        
Outstanding at 1 January 57 255 712   £4.96   34 455 159   £4.89   26 221 302   £4.98  
Granted 23 811 993   £5.83   26 126 694   £4.97   10 793 301   £4.35  
Exercised (3 931 699 ) £3.96   (1 649 129 ) £3.42   (2 129 344 ) £3.25  
Forfeited/Expired (a) (1 995 236 ) £5.48   (1 677 012 ) £5.11   (430 100 ) £5.56  













Outstanding at 31 December 75 140 770   £5.28   57 255 712   £4.96   34 455 159   £4.89  













Exercisable at 31 December 33 370 192   £5.07   34 846 599   £4.90   25 183 453   £4.72  













Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts 107
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

29  Equity-based compensation plans continued

      2002       2001       2000  
      Weighted       Weighted       Weighted  
  Number of   average   Number of   average   Number of   average  
  shares   price   shares   price   shares   price  













NV New York shares of €0.51                        
Outstanding at 1 January 2 736 921   $49.23   2 030 941   $47.29   1 963 471   $45.41  
Granted 755 295   $59.44   840 937   $52.22   294 645   $51.77  
Exercised (242 276 )  $36.00   (119 965 )  $36.02   (185 740 )  $30.53  
Forfeited/Expired (a) (28 926 )  $57.52   (14 992 ) $59.43   (41 435 )  $65.22  













Outstanding at 31 December 3 221 014   $52.54   2 736 921   $49.23   2 030 941   $47.29  













Exercisable at 31 December 1 888 079   $50.10   1 632 955   $46.29   1 473 860   $42.00  













PLC shares of 1.4p in the form of ADRs (d)                        
Outstanding at 1 January 12 744 844   $7.89   7 491 864   $8.33   5 830 480   $8.82  
Granted 4 994 640   $8.42   5 566 904   $7.25   1 975 788   $6.95  
Exercised (598 300 ) $7.14   (208 116 ) $6.86   (47 572 ) $6.72  
Forfeited/Expired (a) (144 032 ) $8.40   (105 808 ) $8.08   (266 832 )  $9.13  













Outstanding at 31 December 16 997 152   $8.06   12 744 844   $7.88   7 491 864   $8.33  













Exercisable at 31 December 8 175 172   $8.29   5 415 724   $8.57   3 758 584   $8.35  













(a) The number of expired options is immaterial.
(d) 1 ADR is equivalent to 4 PLC shares.
             
  2002   2001   2000  







NV option value information (b)            
Fair value per option (c) €18.74  (e) €16.57  (e) €10.83  (e)
  £11.59  (f) £8.94  (f) £6.25  (f)
  $16.32  (g) $13.96  (g) $15.97  (g)
Valuation assumptions            
   Expected option term 6.0 years   6.3 years   6.3 years  
   Expected volatility 27.6% 28.5 % 24.5 %
   Expected dividend yield 2.4% 2.5 % 4.0 %
Risk-free interest rate 5.0% 4.1 % 5.2 %







PLC option value information (b)            
Fair value per option (c) €2.62  (e) €2.01  (e) €1.82  (e)
  £1.62  (f) £1.24  (f) £1.00  (f)
  $2.23  (g) $1.86  (g) $1.95  (g)
Valuation assumptions            
   Expected option term 6.0 years   6.8 years   6.3 years  
   Expected volatility 27.1% 26.0%   23.9%  
   Expected dividend yield 2.6% 2.9%   3.2%  
Risk-free interest rate 5.3% 4.6%   5.9%  







Actual compensation costs recognised (€ million)      







(b) Weighted average of options granted during each period.
(c) Estimated using Black Scholes option pricing method.
(e) Fair value per option of the NV Executive Option Plan.
(f) Fair value per option of the PLC Executive Option Plan.
(g) Fair value per option of the NA Executive Option Plan.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

108
Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group
   
   

29  Equity-based compensation plans continued

The exercise prices and remaining life of the Executive Option Plans as at 31 December 2002 are as follows:

          Options outstanding Options exercisable  








 
Range of
exercise prices
 
Number
outstanding at
31 December
2002
 
Weighted
average
remaining
contractual
life
 
Weighted
average
exercise price
     
Number
exercisable at
31 December
2002
 
Weighted
average
exercise price
 















NV shares of €0.51
€42.79 - €60.85
 
5 338 303
 
8 years
 
€56.68
     
2 551 726
 
€54.88
 
 
€63.50 - €73.97
 
5 801 094
 
8 years
 
€66.35
     
2 243 490
 
€65.48
 















PLC shares of 1.4p
£2.54 - £3.08
 
1 795 242
 
2 years
 
£2.98
     
1 795 242
 
£2.98
 
 
£3.43 - £4.78
 
24 183 118
 
8 years
 
£4.54
     
16 389 469
 
£4.54
 
 
£5.22 - £6.79
 
49 162 410
 
8 years
 
£5.73
     
15 185 481
 
£5.89
 















NV New York shares of €0.51
$25.67 - $33.89
 
647 995
 
2 years
 
$31.03
     
647 995
 
$31.03
 
 
$41.16 - $56.13
 
1 312 546
 
7 years
 
$51.37
     
706 730
 
$50.73
 
 
$58.76 - $76.69
 
1 260 473
 
8 years
 
$64.82
     
533 354
 
$72.44
 















PLC shares of 1.4p in the form
$5.56 - $7.73
 
8 619 296
 
7 years
 
$7.08
     
4 604 564
 
$6.97
 
of ADRs (d)
$8.35 - $10.85
 
8 377 856
 
8 years
 
$9.07
     
3 570 608
 
$10.00
 
















(d) 1 ADR is equivalent to 4 PLC shares.

 

(iii) The Share Matching Plans
Under these plans managers can invest up to 25% of their gross bonus in Unilever shares. The Company matches this with the same number of shares on condition that all shares are held for the agreed period (five years for awards made until 2001, three years from 2002 onwards), and that the manager has not resigned from Unilever at the end of this period. The North American managers participate in the North American Share Bonus Plan, the others in the Variable Pay in Shares Plan. The numbers below include the numbers under the plan for the directors described in the Remuneration report on page 50.

A summary of the status of the Share Matching Plans as at 31 December 2002, 2001 and 2000 and changes during the years ended on these dates is presented below:

         2002                  2001                  2000     
    Weighted   Weighted   Weighted
  Number of average Number of average Number of average
  shares price shares price shares price















NV shares of €0.51                            
Outstanding at 1 January 77 613   €0.00     26 302   €0.00     4 891   €0.00  
Awarded 148 990   €0.00     51 526   €0.00     21 411   €0.00  
Exercised (143 ) €0.00              
Forfeited/Expired (a) (1 056 ) €0.00     (215 ) €0.00        















Outstanding at 31 December 225 404   €0.00     77 613   €0.00     26 302   €0.00  















Exercisable at 31 December                















                             
PLC shares of 1.4p                            
Outstanding at 1 January 570 703   £0.00     198 676   £0.00     36 779   £0.00  
Awarded 1 065 406   £0.00     373 646   £0.00     161 897   £0.00  
Exercised (1 053 ) £0.00              
Forfeited/Expired (a)  (7 670 ) £0.00     (1 619 )  £0.00        















Outstanding at 31 December 1 627 386   £0.00     570 703   £0.00     198 676   £0.00  















Exercisable at 31 December                
















(a) The number of expired share awards is immaterial.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts
109
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

29 Equity-based compensation plans continued

     Number of shares      2002
Weighted
average
price
     Number of shares     
2001
Weighted
average
price
 
Number of
shares
 
2000
Weighted
average
price
 













NV New York shares of €0.51                        
Outstanding at 1 January 29 255   $0.00   5 034   $0.00      
Awarded 87 743 $0.00   24 221   $0.00   5 034   $0.00  
Exercised            
Forfeited/Expired (a) (513 ) $0.00          













Outstanding at 31 December 116 485 $0.00   29 255   $0.00   5 034   $0.00  













Exercisable at 31 December            













                         
PLC shares of 1.4p in the form of ADRs (d)                        
Outstanding at 1 January 214 752 $0.00   37 264   $0.00      
Awarded 599 064 $0.00   177 488   $0.00   37 264   $0.00  
Exercised            
Forfeited/Expired (a) (3 568 ) $0.00          













Outstanding at 31 December 810 248 $0.00   214 752   $0.00   37 264   $0.00  













Exercisable at 31 December            














(a) The number of expired share awards is immaterial.     
(d) 1 ADR is equivalent to 4 PLC shares.

  2002   2001   2000  







NV share award value information (b)            
Fair value per share award €69.14   €61.73   €52.68  
  $58.68   $56.54   $49.13  







PLC share award value information (b)            
Fair value per share award £6.17   £5.22   £4.22  
  $8.58   $7.70   $6.63  







Actual compensation costs recognised (€ million) 12   2    








(b) Weighted average of share awards granted during each period.

(iv) The TSR Long-Term Incentive Plan
This plan was introduced in 2001 and grants were made to Board members and some senior executives. The level of award which will vest will vary in accordance with the Total Shareholder Return in comparison with a peer group (see description on page 40). If the ranking is below the median, the award will lapse; the higher the ranking above the median, the higher the award.

A summary of the status of the TSR Long-Term Incentive Plan as at 31 December 2002 and 2001 and changes during the year ended on these dates is presented below:

      2002       2001  
      Weighted       Weighted  
  Number of   average   Number of   average  
  shares   price   shares   price  









NV shares of €0.51                
Outstanding at 1 January 71 564 €0.00      
Awarded 118 445 €0.00   71 564   €0.00  
Exercised        
Forfeited/Expired (a) (1 495 ) €0.00      









Outstanding at 31 December 188 514 €0.00   71 564   €0.00  









Exercisable at 31 December        









                 
PLC shares of 1.4p                
Outstanding at 1 January 533 481 £0.00      
Awarded 837 973 £0.00   533 481    £0.00  
Exercised        
Forfeited/Expired (a) (10 580 ) £0.00      









Outstanding at 31 December 1 360 874   £0.00   533 481    £0.00  









Exercisable at 31 December        










(a) The number of expired share awards is immaterial.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

110 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group
   
   

29 Equity-based compensation plans continued

  2002   2001  





NV share award value information (b)        
Fair value per share award (h) €26.94   €57.33  





PLC share award value information (b)        
Fair value per share award (h) £2.41   £5.11  





Actual compensation costs recognised (€ million) 11   2  





(b) Weighted average of share awards granted during each period.
(h) Estimated using adapted binomial pricing model based on cross-volatilities of peer group TSR.

(v)  The Restricted Share Plan
In specific once-off cases a number of executives are awarded the right to receive NV and PLC shares at a specified date in the future, on the condition that they will still be employed by Unilever at that time. No directors participate in this plan.

A summary of the status of the Restricted Share Plan as at 31 December 2002, 2001 and 2000 and changes during the years ended on these dates is presented below:

 
Number of
shares
 
2002
Weighted
average
price
 
 
Number of
shares
 
2001
Weighted
average
price
 
 
Number of
shares
 
2000
Weighted
average
price
 













NV shares of €0.51                        
Outstanding at 1 January 381 328   €0.00   165 046   €0.00      
Awarded 37 380 €0.00   256 662   €0.00   165 046   €0.00  
Exercised (160 405 ) €0.00   (40 380 )  €0.00      
Forfeited/Expired (a) (7 696 ) €0.00          













Outstanding at 31 December 250 607 €0.00   381 328   €0.00   165 046   €0.00  













                         
PLC shares of 1.4p                        
Outstanding at 1 January 2 815 138   £0.00   1 220 226   £0.00      
Awarded 275 502 £0.00   1 894 148   £0.00   1 220 226    £0.00  
Exercised (1 178 708 ) £0.00   (299 236 ) £0.00      
Forfeited/Expired (a) (57 116 ) £0.00          













Outstanding at 31 December 1 854 816   £0.00   2 815 138   £0.00   1 220 226    £0.00  













(a)      The number of expired share awards is immaterial.                        
              2002   2001   2000  













NV share award value information (b)                        
Fair value per share award             €64.21   €67.40   €53.72  













PLC share award value information (b)                        
Fair value per share award             £5.65    £5.73    £4.45  













Actual compensation costs recognised (€ million)             6   6   2  














(b) Weighted average of share awards granted during each period.

(vi) The North American Performance Share Plan
This long-term incentive plan for North American managers awards Unilever shares if company and personal performance targets are met over a three-year period. It was introduced in 2001 to replace a former long-term incentive plan which had cash awards rather than shares.

A summary of the status of the North American Performance Share Plan as at 31 December 2002 and 2001 and changes during the years ended on these dates is presented below:

 
 
 
Number of
shares
 
2002
Weighted
average
price
   
 
 
Number of
shares
 
2001
Weighted
average
price
 










NV New York shares of €0.51                  
Outstanding at 1 January 625 451   $0.00        
Awarded 639 396   $0.00     625 451   $0.00  
Exercised          
Forfeited/Expired (a) (41 555 ) $0.00        










Outstanding at 31 December 1 223 292   $0.00     625 451   $0.00  










Exercisable at 31 December          










Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the consolidated accounts
111
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

29 Equity-based compensation plans continued

      2002         2001  
      Weighted         Weighted  
  Number of   average     Number of   average  
  shares   price     shares   price  










PLC shares of 1.4p in the form of ADRs (d)                  
Outstanding at 1 January 4 665 064   $0.00        
Awarded 4 769 348   $0.00     4 665 064   $0.00  
Exercised          
Forfeited/Expired (a) (303 880 ) $0.00        










Outstanding at 31 December 9 130 532   $0.00     4 665 064   $0.00  










Exercisable at 31 December          










(a)   The number of expired share awards is immaterial. (d) 1 ADR is equivalent to 4 PLC shares.
  2002   2001  





NV share award value information (b)          
Fair value per share award $59.00   $59.65  





PLC share award value information (b)            
Fair value per share award  $8.35    $8.59  





Actual compensation costs recognised (€ million)   55     32  





(b)     Weighted average of share awards granted during each period.

Employee share option plans: additional information

At 31 December 2002, there were options outstanding to purchase 16 693 951 (2001: 12 446 685) €0.51 ordinary NV shares, and 79 141 530 (2001: 56 763 080) 1.4p ordinary PLC shares in respect of equity-based compensation plans of NV and its subsidiaries and the North American plans, and 3 846 623 (2001: 2 782 756) €0.51 ordinary NV shares and 45 785 840 (2001: 44 038 928) 1.4p ordinary PLC shares in respect of equity-based compensation plans of PLC and its subsidiaries.

To satisfy the options granted, certain NV group companies hold 17 711 169 (2001: 13 679 007) certificates or depositary receipts of ordinary shares of NV and 69 162 782 (2001: 43 038 640) of PLC and a forward equity contract to buy 10 000 000 PLC shares in 2006, and trusts in Jersey and the United Kingdom hold 43 176 360 (2001: 41 531 145) PLC shares. The book value of the shares held by the trusts, together with their borrowings, is taken up in the entity accounts of PLC, as required by United Kingdom UITF Abstract 13. The trustees of these trusts have agreed, until further notice, to waive dividends on these shares, save for the nominal sum of 0.01p per 1.4p ordinary share. Shares acquired during 2002 represent 1.0% of the Group’s called-up capital. The balance at year end is 3.4% (2001: 2.6%).

The book value of €1 952 million (2001: €1 480 million) of all shares held in respect of equity-based compensation plans for both NV and PLC is eliminated on consolidation by deduction from other reserves (see note 23 on page 98). Their market value at 31 December 2002 was €2 058 million (2001: €1 681 million).

At 31 December 2002 the exercise price of 11 163 031 (2001: 1 314 187) NV options and of 13 156 190 (2001: 11 382 978) PLC options was above the market price of the shares.

Shares held to satisfy options are accounted for in accordance with Netherlands law. Any difference between the market value of the shares at the grant date and the exercise price of the related options is charged to the profit and loss account over the vesting period. In accordance with Netherlands law, all other differences between the purchase price of the shares held to satisfy options granted and the exercise price of those options, or sale proceeds in the event that options lapse, are charged to other reserves. Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract 17 in the United Kingdom would require differences between the purchase price of the shares held and the exercise price or sale proceeds to be charged to the profit and loss account. For 2002 this charge would have been €23 million (2001: €13 million). In addition, a further €8 million would have been recognised as an impairment charge for shares held to meet options expiring in the short term which are priced above market value.

Obligations over the following number of shares were granted, exercised, forfeited or expired between 31 December 2002 and 28 February 2003.

      Granted   Exercised, forfeited or expired  







  Shares of 1.4p(i)   Shares of €0.51(ii)     Shares of 1.4p(i)   Shares of €0.51(ii)  










All-Employee Option Plans       437 933   88 271  
Executive Option Plans       794 497   115 782  
Share Matching Plans       4 424   624  
TSR Long-Term Incentive Plan          
Restricted Share Plan 8 640   1 200     623 164   83 487  
North American Performance Share Plan       44 400   5 950  










(i)   When under a North American Plan, in the form of PLC ADRs.
(ii)   When under a North American Plan, in the form of NV New York shares.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

112 Notes to the consolidated accounts
  Unilever Group
   

30 Summarised accounts of the NV and PLC parts of the Group

The following summarised accounts present the profit and loss account and balance sheet of the Unilever Group, analysed between the NV and PLC parts of the Group according to respective ownership.

Profit and loss account for the year ended 31 December

  € million   € million   € million     € million   € million   € million  
  NV   NV   NV     PLC   PLC   PLC  
  2002   2001   2000     2002   2001   2000  














Group turnover 31 828   35 584   32 398     16 442 15 930   15 184  














Group operating profit (a) 3 457   2 938   1 883     1 584 2 236   1 298  
                           
Total income from fixed investments 73   43   55     38   53   (2 )
Interest (812 ) (1 228 ) (442 )   (361 ) (418 ) (190 )














Profit on ordinary activities before taxation 2 718   1 753   1 496     1 261 1 871   1 106  
Taxation (a) (986 ) (892 ) (794 )   (552 ) (655 ) (488 )














Profit on ordinary activities after taxation 1 732   861   702     709   1 216   618  
Minority interests (51 ) (44 ) (27 )   (261 ) (195 ) (188 )














Net profit 1 681   817   675     448   1 021   430  














                           
                           
Balance sheet as at 31 December                          
  € million   € million         € million   € million      
  NV   NV         PLC   PLC      
  2002   2001         2002   2001      














Fixed assets                          
Goodwill and intangibles (a) 15 593   18 899         4 681   6 065      
Tangible fixed assets 4 749   6 065         2 687   3 175      
Fixed investments 394   535         285   349      














  20 736   25 499         7 653   9 589      














Current assets                          
Stocks 2 870   3 520         1 630   1 823      
Debtors 5 888   7 403         2 343   2 631      
                           
Debtors due within one year 4 323   5 418         1 552   1 767      
Debtors due after more than one year (a) 1 565   1 985         791   864      
                           
Cash and current investments 2 459   1 124         1 019   1 177      














  11 217   12 047         4 992   5 631      
                           
Creditors due within one year (14 869 ) (17 128 )       (5 733 ) (6 084 )    
                           
Borrowings (7 293 ) (8 983 )       (2 218 ) (2 296 )    
Trade and other creditors (7 576 ) (8 145 )       (3 515 ) (3 788 )    














Net current assets (3 652)   (5 081 )       (741 ) (453 )    














Total assets less current liabilities 17 084   20 418         6 912   9 136      














Creditors due after more than one year 10 013   11 894         1 561   3 132      
                           
Borrowings 9 536   11 233         1 397   2 988      
Trade and other creditors 477   661         164   144      
                           
Provisions for liabilities and charges (a) 4 448   5 351         1 479   1 520      
Intra-group – NV/PLC (3 106 ) (1 757 )       3 106   1 757      
Minority interests 29   41         599   623      
Capital and reserves (a)(b) 5 700   4 889         167   2 104      














Total capital employed 17 084   20 418         6 912   9 136      














(a)   Amounts restated following the implementation of FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.
(b)   Capital and reserves of PLC have decreased during 2002 due to the elimination of goodwill arising on intercompany transfers as explained in note 22 on page 98.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Five year record
113
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

The financial data below shows key figures which are derived from the audited consolidated accounts of the Unilever Group for the last five years and is qualified by reference to those accounts and notes. Please refer also to the notes on page 114.

From 1 January 2000, Unilever adopted the euro as its principal reporting currency. For the years prior to the introduction of the euro on 1 January 1999, euro values have been derived by converting values previously reported in guilders, using the official conversion rate announced on 31 December 1998 of €1.00 = Fl. 2.20371. The effect of exchange fluctuations over time means that the trends shown may differ significantly from those previously shown in sterling and from those which would arise if these euro amounts had been translated from the historic sterling accounts.

Consolidated profit and loss account (a)(e)  € million
2002
   € million
2001
   € million
2000
   € million
1999
   € million
1998
  











Group turnover 48 270   51 514   47 582   40 977   40 437  











Group operating profit 5 041   5 174   3 181   4 303   4 410  
   Group operating profit BEIA 7 165   7 149   5 729   4 595   4 293  
   Exceptional items (879 ) (588 )  (2 113 ) (269 ) 125  
   Amortisation of goodwill and intangibles (1 245 ) (1 387 ) (435 ) (23 ) (8 )
Income from fixed investments 111   96   53   52   37  
Interest (b) (1 173 ) (1 646 ) (632 ) (14 ) 156  











Profit on ordinary activities before taxation 3 979   3 624   2 602   4 341   4 603  











Profit on ordinary activities after taxation 2 441   2 077   1 320   2 972   3 088  











Net profit 2 129   1 838   1 105   2 771   2 944  











Preference dividends (42 ) (51 ) (44 ) (20 ) (7 )
Normal dividends on ordinary capital (1 659 ) (1 530 )  (1 414 ) (1 245 ) (1 237 )
Special dividends on ordinary capital         (7 430 )











Result for the year retained 428   257   (353 ) 1 506   (5 730 )











Combined earnings per share (c)                    
Euros per €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) of ordinary capital 2.14   1.82   1.07   2.63   2.63  
Euro cents per 1.4p (1998: 1.25p) of ordinary capital 32.05   27.27   16.08   39.48   39.47  











Ordinary dividends                    
NV – euros per €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) of ordinary capital (d) 1.70   1.56   1.43   1.27   1.14  
PLC – pence per 1.4p (1998: 1.25p) of ordinary capital 16.04   14.54   13.07   12.50   10.70  











Special ordinary dividends                    
NV – euros per Fl. 1 of ordinary capital (d)         6.58  
PLC – pence per 1.25p of ordinary capital         66.13  











                     
                     
 Consolidated balance sheet (a)(e)                    
  € million    € million    € million    € million    € million   
2002 2001 2000 1999 1998











Goodwill and intangible assets 20 274   24 964   26 390   643   284  
Other fixed assets and investments 8 115   10 124   10 996   8 963   8 336  
Stocks 4 500   5 343   5 421   5 124   4 747  
Debtors 8 231   10 034   9 726   7 405     6 474  
Acquired businesses held for resale     1 666      
Total cash and current investments 3 478   2 301   3 273   5 473   10 383  











Total assets 44 598   52 766   57 472   27 608   30 224  
Creditors due within one year (f) (20 602 ) (23 212 ) (28 364 ) (12 134 ) (17 976 )











Total assets less current liabilities 23 996   29 554   29 108   15 474   12 248  











                     
Creditors due after one year 11 574   15 026   14 085   2 832   3 042  
Provisions for liabilities and charges 5 927   6 871   6 431   4 608   4 321  
Minority interests 628   664   618   579   408  
Capital and reserves (f) 5 867   6 993   7 974   7 455   4 477  











Total capital employed 23 996   29 554   29 108   15 474   12 248  











Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

114 Five year record
  Unilever Group
   
Consolidated cash flow statement (a)  € million
2002
   € million
2001
   € million
2000
   € million
1999
   € million
1998
  











Cash flow from operating activities 7 883 7 497   6 738   5 654   4 514  
Dividends from joint ventures 83   82   38   28   24  
Returns on investments and servicing of finance (1 386 ) (1 887 ) (798 ) (156 ) 67  
Taxation (1 817 ) (2 205 ) (1 734 ) (1 443 ) (1 261 )
Capital expenditure and financial investment (1 706 ) (1 358 ) (1 061 ) (1 501 ) (1 399 )
Acquisitions and disposals 1 755 3 477   (27 373 ) (362 ) 338  
Dividends paid on ordinary share capital (1 580 ) (1 420 ) (1 365 ) (1 266 ) (1 073 )
Special dividend       (6 093 )  











Cash flow before management of                    
liquid resources and financing 3 232 4 186   (25 555 ) (5 139 ) 1 210  
Management of liquid resources (592 ) 1 106   2 464   5 675   (2 003 )
Financing (2 591 ) (5 098 ) 22 902   (146 ) 42  











Increase/(decrease) in cash in the period 49   194   (189 ) 390   (751 )











                     
Key ratios (g)(e) 2002   2001   2000   1999   1998  











Return on shareholders’ equity (%) 31.7   23.8   12.8   44.7   25.1  
Return on capital employed (%) 10.5   8.8   7.8   22.6   16.2  
Group operating margin (%) 10.4   10.0   6.7   10.5   10.9  
Net profit margin (%) 4.4   3.6   2.3   6.8   7.3  
Net interest cover (times) 4.5   3.2   5.1   319.0    
Net interest cover based on EBITDA before exceptional items (times) 7   5   11   412    
Net gearing (adjusted) (%) 67   72   73      
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges (times) 3.5   2.7   3.2   8.1   9.7  
Funds from operations after interest and tax before exceptional                    
   items over lease adjusted net debt (%) 26   18   14   250    











                     
Selected financial data on a US GAAP basis (a)(h)(i)  € million
2002
   € million
2001
   € million
2000
   € million
1999
   € million
1998
  











                     
Net profit 4 309 1 506   1 266   2 490   2 543  
Capital and reserves 11 699 13 553   15 075   15 375   19 292  











                     
Combined earnings per share (c)                    
   Euros per €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) of ordinary capital 4.36   1.48   1.24   2.36   2.27  
   Euro cents per 1.4p (1998: 1.25p) of ordinary capital 65.51   22.21   18.53   35.45   34.09  
Diluted earnings per share                    
   Euros per €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) of ordinary capital 4.24   1.44   1.20   2.30   2.22  
   Euro cents per 1.4p (1998: 1.25p) of ordinary capital 63.56   21.61   18.07   34.57   33.25  
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges (times) 4.7   2.5   3.2   7.6   8.4  
Net gearing (%) 54.3   62.0   62.8      
Net interest cover (times) 6.1   3.1   5.0   178.4    











Notes


(a)   Amounts previously reported in guilders have been restated and are now reported in euros using the fixed conversion rate of €1.00 = Fl. 2.20371 that became effective on 1 January 1999.
(b)   Interest cost in 2000 includes €37 million of exceptional interest (see note 5 on page 78).
(c)   For the basis of the calculations of combined earnings per share see note 7 on page 79 and 80.
(d)   In 1999 and prior years, NV dividends were declared and paid in guilders. For comparative purposes, guilder values have been converted into euros in this table using the official rate of €1.00 = Fl. 2.20371. Full details of dividends for the years 1998 to 2002 are given on page 147.
(e)   Amounts restated following the implementation of FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.
(f)   Figures for 1998 include the special dividend of €7 267 million assuming all shareholders had taken the cash dividend. Capital and reserves in 1999 reflect the increase of €1 382 million as a result of the issue of the preference shares.
(g)   Return on shareholders’equity is substantially influenced by the Group’s policy prior to 1998, of writing off purchased goodwill in the year of acquisition as a movement in profit retained. Return on capital employed and net gearing are also influenced but to a lesser extent.
(h)   During the year ended 31 December 2002, Unilever recognised for US GAAP reporting purposes SFAS 142 which ceased amortisation of goodwill and indefinite-lived assets. Amortisation expense on goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets on a US GAAP basis for the years ended 31 December 2001, 2000, 1999 and 1998 were €1 748 million, €810 million, €369 million and €356 million respectively.
(i)   During the year ended 31 December 2002, Unilever changed its method of calculating expected return on plan assets for US GAAP purposes by adopting the actual fair market value at the balance sheet date rather than a market related value. Had this methodology been applied in previous years, it would have resulted in an increase in net income for the years ended 31 December 2001, 2000, 1999 and 1998 of €86 million, €210 million, €57 million and €83 million respectively.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Five year record 115
Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements
 
Definitions  

Return on shareholders’ equity Net profit attributable to ordinary shareholders expressed as a percentage of the average capital and reserves attributable to ordinary shareholders during the year.

Return on capital employed   The sum of profit on ordinary activities after taxation plus interest after taxation on borrowings due after more than one year, expressed as a percentage of the average capital employed during the year.

Group operating margin Group operating profit expressed as a percentage of group turnover.

Operating margin Operating profit expressed as a percentage of turnover.

Net profit margin Net profit expressed as a percentage of group turnover.

Net interest cover  Profit on ordinary activities excluding associates before net interest and taxation divided by net interest excluding associates.

Net interest cover based on EBITDA
(before exceptional items) 
Earnings on ordinary activities excluding associates before net interest, taxation, depreciation and amortisation and exceptional items divided by net interest excluding associates.

Net gearing (adjusted)     Net debt (borrowings less cash and current investments) expressed as a percentage of the sum of capital and reserves, minority interests and net debt. In calculating capital and reserves, the book value of shares or certificates held in connection with share option plans is classified as fixed assets, rather than deducted from reserves as required by Netherlands law.

Net operating assets         The total of:
• goodwill and intangible assets of subsidiaries purchased after 1 January 1998
• tangible fixed assets
• stocks
• debtors (excluding deferred taxation)

less:
• trade and other creditors (excluding taxation and dividend creditors)
• provisions for liabilities and charges (excluding deferred taxation and deferred
purchase consideration).

Ratio of earnings to fixed charges     Earnings consist of net profit excluding joint ventures and associates increased by fixed charges and income taxes. Fixed charges consist of interest payable on debt and a portion of lease costs determined to be representative of interest. This ratio takes no account of interest receivable although Unilever’s treasury operations involve both borrowing and depositing funds.

Funds from operations after interest and tax
(before exceptional items) over lease adjusted

net debt
  
Profit on ordinary activities excluding joint ventures and associates before depreciation and amortisation of goodwill and intangibles and exceptional items, and after actual tax paid and other non exceptional non cash items, expressed as a percentage of the lease adjusted net debt. Lease adjusted net debt is calculated by adding to the net debt five times the operational lease costs.

Weighted average cost of capital   The real cost of equity multiplied by the market capitalisation, plus the real after taxation interest cost of debt multiplied by the market value of the net debt, divided by the sum of the market values of debt and equity.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

116 Five year record
  Unilever Group
   
   
   
By geographical area                    
  € million   € million   € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000   1999   1998  











Group turnover                    
Europe 19 573   20 119   18 967   18 040   18 165  
North America 12 446   13 767   11 631   8 838   8 417  
Africa, Middle East and Turkey 3 139   3 191   3 296   3 048   3 034  
Asia and Pacific 7 679   7 846   8 038   6 723   5 803  
Latin America 5 433   6 591   5 650   4 328   5 018  











  48 270   51 514   47 582   40 977   40 437  











Group operating profit                    
Europe 1 750   2 689   1 693   2 131   2 254  
North America 1 435   1 092   48   847   942  
Africa, Middle East and Turkey 286   203   321   302   268  
Asia and Pacific 1 077   862   776   642   457  
Latin America 493   328   343   381   489  











  5 041   5 174   3 181   4 303   4 410  











Net operating assets                    
Europe 9 954   11 243   12 174   3 215   3 025  
North America 8 945   12 091   11 814   1 996   1 738  
Africa, Middle East and Turkey 1 097   1 082   1 075   1 034   936  
Asia and Pacific 1 124   1 525   1 487   1 499   1 282  
Latin America 3 614   6 256   7 526   1 520   1 370  











  24 734   32 197   34 076   9 264   8 351  











Capital expenditure                    
Europe 552   631   605   652   687  
North America 334   355   310   222   182  
Africa, Middle East and Turkey 108   114   116   123   129  
Asia and Pacific 170   217   183   148   158  
Latin America 134   196   142   159   173  











  1 298   1 513   1 356   1 304   1 329  











                     
By operation                    
  € million   € million   € million   € million   € million  
  2002   2001   2000   1999   1998  











Group turnover                    
Foods 26 937   28 155   23 898   20 339   20 919  
Home & Personal Care 20 801   22 739   22 825   19 781   18 783  
Other Operations 532   620   859   857   735  











  48 270   51 514   47 582   40 977   40 437  











Group operating profit                    
Foods 2 185   2 303   1 735   1 788   1 801  
Home & Personal Care 2 814   2 823   1 415   2 361   2 093  
Other Operations 42   48   31   154   516  











  5 041   5 174   3 181   4 303   4 410  











Net operating assets                    
Foods 22 768   28 960   30 341   5 315   4 891  
Home & Personal Care 1 577   2 852   3 565   3 792   3 294  
Other Operations 389   385   170   157   166  











  24 734   32 197   34 076   9 264   8 351  











Capital expenditure                    
Foods 805   810   704   690   775  
Home & Personal Care 466   678   619   577   510  
Other Operations 27   25   33   37   44  











  1 298   1 513   1 356   1 304   1 329  











Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Five year record 117
Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

Exchange rates and European Economic and Monetary Union
Before 1 January 1999, the guilder was a part of the European Monetary System (‘EMS’) exchange rate mechanism. Within this mechanism, exchange rates fluctuated within permitted margins, fixed by central bank intervention. Under the provisions of the Treaty on European Union negotiated at Maastricht in 1991 and signed by the then 12 member states of the European Union in early 1992, the European Monetary Union (‘EMU’) superseded the EMS on 1 January 1999 and the euro was introduced as the single European currency. Since this date, the euro has been the lawful currency of the EMU states. The following 11 member states participate in the EMU and adopted the euro as their national currency with effect from 1 January 1999: Austria, Belgium, Finland, France, Germany, Ireland, Italy, Luxembourg, The Netherlands, Portugal and Spain. Greece adopted the euro as the national currency with effect from 1 January 2001. The legal rate of conversion between the euro and the guilder was announced on 31 December 1998 at €1.00 = Fl. 2.20371. On 1 January 1999 the exchange rate for euro to pound sterling was €1.00 = £0.706.

The information in the following table is based on exchange rates between US dollars and guilders, euros and US dollars, sterling and guilders, and euros and sterling. These translation rates were used in preparation of the accounts.

  2002   2001   2000   1999   1998  











Year end                    
$1 = Fl.                 1.88  
€1 =  $ 1.049   0.885   0.930   1.005      
£1 = Fl.                 3.12  
€1 =  £ 0.651   0.611   0.624   0.621      











Annual average                    
$1 = Fl.                 1.98  
€1 =  $ 0.940   0.895   0.921   1.065      
£1 = Fl.                 3.29  
€1 =  £ 0.628   0.622   0.609   0.659      











   
Noon Buying Rates in New York for cable transfers in foreign currencies as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of
New York were as follows:
 
  2002   2001   2000   1999   1998  











                     
Year end                    
$1 = Fl.                 1.88  
€1  = $ 1.049   0.890   0.939   1.007      











Annual average                    
$1 = Fl.                 1.97  
€1  = $ 0.945   0.895   0.923   1.065      











High                    
$1 = Fl.                 2.09  
€1  = $ 1.049   0.954   1.034   1.181      











Low                    
$1 = Fl.                 1.81  
€1  = $ 0.859   0.837   0.827   1.001      











 
High and low exchange rate values for each of the last six months:
  September   October   November   December   January   February  
  2002   2002   2002   2002   2003   2003  













High:                        
€1 = $ 0.996   0.988   1.014   1.049   1.086   1.088  













Low:                        
€1 = $ 0.969   0.971   0.990   0.993   1.036   1.071  













Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

118 Additional information for US investors
  Unilever Group
   
   

Unilever´s consolidated accounts are prepared in accordance with accounting principles which differ in some respects from those applicable in the United States. The following is a summary of the effect on the Group’s net profit, combined earnings per share and capital and reserves of the application of United States generally accepted accounting principles (US GAAP).

  € million    million    million  
2002 2001 2000







             
Net profit as reported in the consolidated profit and loss account 2 129   1 838   1 105  
             
Attributable to: NV 1 681   817   675  
PLC 448   1 021   430  
US GAAP adjustments:            
   Currency retranslation written back on disposals (22 )   115  
   Goodwill 1 074   (124 ) (45 )
   Identifiable intangibles 284   (118 ) (128 )
   Restructuring costs 34   (18 ) 76  
   Interest (77 ) (55 ) (68 )
   Derivative financial instruments 201   (119 )  
   Pensions and similar liabilities 143     95  
   Gain on partial disposal of a group company 56      
   Taxation effect of above adjustments (35 ) 108   116  







Net increase/(decrease) 1 658   (326 ) 161  







             
Net income under US GAAP before cumulative effect of change            
in accounting principles for pensions and derivative financial instruments 3 787   1 512   1 266  
Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle net of tax charge            
of €249 million in 2002 and tax benefit of €3 million in 2001 522   (6 )  







             
Net income under US GAAP 4 309   1 506   1 266  
             
Attributable to: NV 3 220   540   832  
PLC 1 089   966   434  







             
             
Combined net income per share under US GAAP before cumulative            
effect of change in accounting principles            
   Euros per €0.51 of ordinary capital 3.83   1.49   1.24  
   Euro cents per 1.4p of ordinary capital 57.49   22.30   18.53  
Combined diluted net income per share under US GAAP before            
cumulative effect of change in accounting principles            
   Euros per €0.51 of ordinary capital 3.72   1.45   1.20  
   Euro cents per 1.4p of ordinary capital 55.78   21.70   18.07  
Cumulative effect of change in accounting principles –            
combined net income per share            
   Euros per €0.51 of ordinary capital 0.53   (0.01 )  
   Euro cents per 1.4p of ordinary capital 8.02   (0.09 )  
Cumulative effect of change in accounting principles –            
diluted combined net income per share            
   Euros per €0.51 of ordinary capital 0.52   (0.01 )  
   Euro cents per 1.4p of ordinary capital 7.78   (0.09 )  







 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Additional information for US investors 119
Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements
 
  € million   € million  
  2002   2001  





         
Capital and reserves as reported in the consolidated balance sheet (a) 5 867   6 993  
         
Attributable to:  NV 5 700   4 889  
      PLC 167   2 104  
US GAAP adjustments:        
   Goodwill 2 645   2 436  
   Identifiable intangibles 2 782   3 009  
   Restructuring costs 198   166  
   Interest 355   432  
   Other comprehensive income effect of derivative financial instruments transition adjustment (61 ) (101 )
   Derivative financial instruments 73   (128 )
   Pensions and similar liabilities (975 ) 538  
   Dividends 1 119   1 059  
   Taxation effect of above adjustments (a) (304 ) (851 )





Net increase 5 832   6 560  





         
Capital and reserves under US GAAP 11 699   13 553  
         
Attributable to:  NV 9 902   9 340  
      PLC 1 797   4 213  





(a)     Restated for FRS 19, see note 18 on page 94.

The aggregate amounts included in the consolidated Unilever Group capital and reserves (under Unilever accounting principles) in respect of cumulative currency translation adjustments are as follows:

  € million    € million    € million   
2002 2001 2000







             
Balance 1 January (4 745 ) (3 669 ) (3 411 )
Arising during the year (1 517 ) (1 076 ) (258 )







             
Balance 31 December (6 262 ) (4 745 ) (3 669 )







             
The aggregate amounts of foreign currency transaction gains and (losses) charged in            
the consolidated profit and loss account are: (84 ) (30 ) 8  







The consolidated accounts of the Unilever Group have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles which differ in certain respects from those generally accepted in the United States (US GAAP).

The principal differences are set out below.

Profit or loss on disposal of businesses
Unilever calculates profit or loss on sale of businesses after writing back any goodwill previously written off directly to reserves as a movement in profit retained. Under US GAAP the profit or loss on disposal of the businesses is stated net of the relevant unamortised goodwill included on the balance sheet and the cumulative currency retranslation differences recognised through the statement of total recognised gains and losses.

Under UK GAAP, gains on the partial disposal of group companies involving non-monetary consideration are recorded in the statement of total recognised gains and losses. Under US GAAP, these gains are recorded in the profit and loss account.

Goodwill and other intangibles
Under UK and Netherlands GAAP, goodwill (being the difference between the fair value of consideration paid for new interests in group companies, joint ventures and associated companies and the fair value of the Group’s share of their net assets at the date of acquisition) and identifiable intangible assets purchased after 1 January 1998 are capitalised and amortised in operating profit over the period of their expected useful life, up to a maximum of 20 years. Periods in excess of five years are used only where the directors are satisfied that the life of these assets will clearly exceed that period. Goodwill and intangible assets purchased prior to 1 January 1998 were written off in the year of acquisition as a movement in profits retained.

On disposal of a business acquired prior to 1 January 1998, purchased goodwill written off on acquisition is reinstated in arriving at the profit or loss on disposal.

Under US GAAP prior to 1 January 2002, purchased goodwill and identifiable intangibles were capitalised and amortised over their useful lives. From 1 January 2002, under SFAS 142, the amortisation of goodwill and identifiable intangibles that have indefinite useful lives ceased. Intangible assets that have finite useful lives continue to be amortised over their useful lives.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

120 Additional information for US investors
  Unilever Group
   
   

Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets that have indefinite lives are assessed annually for impairment. Within six months of the initial application of SFAS 142, management completed an impairment assessment and have concluded that there is no impairment of goodwill or identifiable intangible assets with indefinite lives.

An analysis of goodwill by reporting segment is given below:

      Spreads   Health &       Home care and              
  Savoury and   and cooking   wellness and   Ice cream and   professional       Other      
€ million dressings   products   beverages   frozen foods   cleaning   Personal care   operations   Total  

















As at 1 January 2002 16 620   212   1 685   1 135   733   633     21 018  
Currency retranslation (2 540 ) (32 ) (255 ) (171 ) (112 ) (97 )   (3 207 )
Acquisitions/disposals 126   100   (36 ) (17 ) (168 ) 26     31  

















As at 31 December 2002 14 206   280   1 394   947   453   562     17 842  

















 

Had the Group accounted for its goodwill and identifiable intangible assets that have indefinite lives under SFAS 142 for the years ending 31 December 2001 and 2000, the impact on reported results would have been as follows:

  € million   € million  
2001 2000





Net income under US GAAP 1 506   1 266  
Amortisation, net of tax:        
   Goodwill 1 266   624  
   Intangibles 404   141  





         
Adjusted net income under US GAAP 3 176   2 031  





         
Adjusted net income per share 3.18   2.01  
Adjusted diluted net income per share 3.09   1.96  





Indefinite lived intangible assets principally comprise trademarks and have a net book value of €6 726 million as at 31 December 2002. Finite lived intangible assets principally comprise technologies and have a net book value of €567 million, net of accumulated amortisation of €72 million, as at 31 December 2002. Amortisation expense recorded in the year in respect of finite lived intangible assets was €36 million. This expense is not expected to change materially over the next five years.

Restructuring costs
Under Unilever’s accounting policy certain restructuring costs relating to employee terminations are recognised when a restructuring plan has been announced. Under US GAAP, additional criteria must be met before such charges are recognised.

Interest
Unilever treats all interest costs as a charge to the profit and loss account in the current period. Under US GAAP interest incurred during the construction periods of tangible fixed assets is capitalised and depreciated over the life of the assets.

Derivative financial instruments
Transition adjustment

Unilever applied the provisions of SFAS 133 ‘Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities’ in this divergence statement as from 1 January 2001. In accordance with the transition provisions of SFAS 133, an adjustment of €6 million (net of tax of €3 million) was recorded as the cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle to recognise the fair value of all the Group’s derivative financial instruments and hedge items under US GAAP. In addition, Unilever recorded a one-time unrealised loss of €85 million (net of tax of €37 million) to consolidated other comprehensive income under US GAAP. During the year ended 31 December 2002, a reclassification of derivative losses from other comprehensive income to net income of €40 million was recorded as a result of the underlying hedged transactions which impacted earnings.

Hedging policy
Unilever’s accounting policies in respect of derivative financial instruments are described in the accounting information and policies on page 68. Unilever has not designated any of its derivative instruments as qualifying hedge instruments under SFAS 133 and, accordingly, this divergence statement assumes that derivative financial instruments are valued at fair value and that changes in their value are reflected in earnings.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Additional information for US investors 121
   Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements
 

Pensions
Under Unilever´s accounting policy the expected costs of providing retirement pensions are charged to the profit and loss account over the periods benefiting from the employees´ services. Variations from expected cost are similarly spread. Under US GAAP, pension costs and liabilities are calculated in accordance with SFAS 87, which requires the use of a prescribed actuarial method and a prescribed set of measurement principles.

Under US GAAP an additional minimum liability is recognised and a charge made to other comprehensive income when the accumulated benefit obligation exceeds the fair value of plan assets to the extent that this amount is not covered by the net liability recognised in the balance sheet.

With effect from 1 January 2002, and for the purposes of determining the expected return on plan assets, Unilever changed the method of valuing its pension plan assets from a market related value calculated by smoothing gains and losses over a five year period to an actual fair value at the balance sheet date. Management believe that the actual fair value methodology provides a better representation of the financial position and results of Unilever’s pension plans.

The impact of this change in methodology on reported results under US GAAP is given in the table below:

          € million   € million  
        2001   2000  









Net income under US GAAP  
 
 
 
1 506
1 266
 
Change in basis of expected return on plan assets calculation         86   210  









Adjusted net income under US GAAP         1 592   1 476  









                 
 
Euro per €0.51
 
Euro cents per 1.4p
 
  2001   2000   2001   2000  









Adjusted net income per share 1.57   1.45   23.52   21.71  
Adjusted diluted net income per share 1.52   1.41   22.89   21.18  









As required under US APB 20 for a change in accounting policy, a cumulative effect adjustment has been calculated to record the impact of the change as if the fair value methodology had been the accounting policy from the initial adoption of SFAS 87 by Unilever. The cumulative effect adjustment net of tax is €522 million in 2002.

Investments
Unilever accounts for current investments, which are liquid funds temporarily invested, at their market value, which is consistent with UK GAAP.

Unilever accounts for changes in the market value of current investments as interest receivable in the profit and loss account for the year. Under US GAAP, such current asset investments are classified as 'available for sale securities' and changes in market values, which represent unrealised gains or losses, are excluded from earnings and taken to stockholders’ equity. Unrealised gains and losses arising from changes in the market values of securities available for sale are not material.

Unilever accounts for fixed investments other than in joint ventures and associates at cost less any amounts written off to reflect a permanent impairment. Under US GAAP such investments are held at fair value. The difference is not material.

Dividends
The proposed final ordinary dividends are provided for in the Unilever accounts in thefinancial year to which they relate. Under US GAAP such dividends are not provided for until they become irrevocable.

Deferred taxation
Unilever has restated its deferred tax charge for the year ended 31 December 2000, and its deferred tax balances as at 31 December 2001 to comply with the new UK accounting standard FRS 19, as described in note 18 on page 94. Under FRS 19, deferred tax is not recognised on fair value adjustments made to assets acquired; under US GAAP, deferred tax is recorded on all fair value adjustments. Also, as described on page 94, FRS 19 has changed the treatment of deferred tax on tax-deductible goodwill previously written off to reserves. Such goodwill is reinstated, net of amortisation, under US GAAP, and the tax effect of such restatement has been adjusted accordingly.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

122 Additional information for US investors
  Unilever Group
   
   

Classification differences between UK and US GAAP
Revenue recognition
Under US GAAP, certain sales incentive expenses which have been included in operating costs under Unilever’s accounting would be deducted from turnover. The decrease in turnover for the years to 31 December 2002, 2001 and 2000 is €1 337 million, €1 279 million and €1 237 million respectively. There is no impact on Unilever’s net profit.

Cashflow statement
Under US GAAP, various items would be reclassified within the consolidated cashflow statement. In particular, interest received, interest paid and taxation would be part of net cash flow from operating activities, and dividends paid would be included within net cash flow from financing. In addition, under US GAAP, cash and cash equivalents comprise cash balances and current investments with an original maturity at the date of investment of less than three months. Under Unilever’s presentation, cash includes only cash in hand or available on demand less bank overdrafts. Movements in those current investments which are included under the heading of cash and cash equivalents under US GAAP form part of the movement entitled ‘Management of liquid resources’ in the cash flow statements. At 31 December 2002, the balance of such investments was €45 million (2001: €9 million; 2000: €58 million).

Recently issued accounting pronouncements
In August 2001, FASB issued SFAS 143, ‘Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations’. This statement is effective from January 2003 and requires obligations associated with the retirement of a tangible long-lived asset to be recorded as a liability upon acquisition of the asset. SFAS 143 would not have a material impact on Unilever’s financial position or results of operations.

In July 2002, the FASB issued SFAS 146, ‘Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities’. This standard will require Unilever to recognise certain costs associated with disposal activities when they are incurred, rather than at the date of a commitment to a disposal plan. SFAS 146 is effective for disposal activities initiated after 31 December 2002. Given the nature of disposal plans, it is not possible to determine in advance the impact it might have on Unilever’s financial position at a particular date or Unilever’s results of operations for a particular period in the future. For 2002, the impact is shown against restructuring costs in the US GAAP reconciliation statements on pages 118 and 119.

In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS 148, ’Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation –Transition and Disclosure – an Amendment of SFAS No. 123’. This standard provides two additional transition methods for companies electing to adopt the fair value accounting provisions of SFAS 123, ‘Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation’, but does not change the fair value measurement principles of SFAS 123. When Unilever adopts the fair value method for accounting for stock options, we expect to use full retrospective restatement. The impact of this is shown in the table on page 104.

In November 2002, the FASB issued Financial Interpretation No. 45 (FIN 45), ‘Guarantor’s and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including Direct Guarantees’. Under this interpretation, a guarantor must recognise the fair value of the obligation undertaken in issuing a guarantee. The initial recognition and initial measurement provisions of this interpretation are applicable on a prospective basis to guarantees issued or modified after 31 December 2002. FIN 45 is not expected to have a material impact on Unilever’s financial position or results of operations.

In January 2003, the FASB issued Financial Interpretation No. 46 (FIN 46), ‘Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities’. Under this interpretation, certain entities known as variable interest entities must be consolidated by the primary beneficiary of the entity. The measurement principles of this interpretation will be effective for Unilever’s 2003 financial statements. FIN 46 is not expected to have any impact on Unilever’s financial position or results of operations.

Documents on display in the United States
Unilever files and furnishes reports and information with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC), and such reports and information can be inspected and copied at the SEC’s public reference facilities in Washington DC, Chicago and New York. Certain of our reports and other information that we file or furnish to the SEC are also available to the public over the internet on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Additional information for US investors 123
   Unilever Group  
   
Financial Statements

Guarantor statements
On 2 October 2000, NV and Unilever Capital Corporation (UCC) filed a US $15 billion Shelf registration, which is unconditionally and fully guaranteed, jointly and severally, by NV, PLC and Unilever United States, Inc. (UNUS). Of the US $15 billion Shelf registration, US $5.75 billion of Notes were outstanding at 31 December 2002 (2001: US $7 billion) with coupons ranging from 5.90% to 7.125%. These Notes are to be repaid between 1 November 2003 and 15 November 2032.

Provided below are the profit and loss accounts, cashflow statements and balance sheets of each of the companies discussed above, together with the profit and loss account, cashflow statement and balance sheet of non-guarantor subsidiaries. These have been prepared under the historical cost convention, and, aside from the basis of accounting for investments at net asset value (equity accounting), comply in all material respects with Netherlands law and with United Kingdom Accounting Standards. Divergences from US GAAP are disclosed on pages 118 to 122. We have not provided reconciliations from the accounting principles used by Unilever to US GAAP for the columns relating to the guarantor entities, as such reconciliations would not materially affect an investor’s understanding of the nature of this guarantee. Thefinancial information in respect of NV, PLC and UNUS has been prepared with all subsidiaries accounted for on an equity basis. Thefinancial information in respect of the non-guarantor subsidiaries has been prepared on a consolidated basis.

  Unilever           Unilever              
  Capital           United              
  Corporation   Unilever N.V.   Unilever PLC   States Inc.   Non-          
  subsidiary   parent issuer/   parent   subsidiary   guarantor          
€ million issuer   guarantor   guarantor   guarantor   subsidiaries   Eliminations   Unilever Group  















Profit and loss account                            
for the year ended 31 December 2002                            
                             
Group turnover         48 270     48 270  
Operating costs   89   (53 ) (34 ) (43 231 )   (43 229 )















Group operating profit   89   (53 ) (34 ) 5 039     5 041  
Share of operating profit of joint ventures         84     84  















Operating profit   89   (53 ) (34 ) 5 123     5 125  
Share of operating profit of associates         34     34  
Dividends   3 779   1 011     (4 790 )    
Other income from fixed investments         (7 )   (7 )
Interest (395 ) (206 ) (83 ) (1 ) (488 )   (1 173 )
Intercompany finance costs 403   450   (3 ) (89 ) (761 )    















Profit on ordinary activities before taxation 8   4 112   872   (124 ) (889 )   3 979  
Taxation (3 ) (41 ) (3 ) 46   (1 537 )   (1 538 )















Profit on ordinary activities after taxation 5   4 071   869   (78 ) (2 426 )   2 441  
Minority interests         (312 )   (312 )
Equity earnings of subsidiaries   (1 942 ) 1 260   136     546    















Net profit 5   2 129   2 129   58   (2 738 ) 546   2 129  















Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

124 Additional information for US investors
  Unilever Group

 

  Unilever           Unilever              
  Capital           United              
  Corporation   Unilever N.V.   Unilever PLC   States Inc.   Non-          
  subsidiary   parent issuer/   parent   subsidiary   guarantor          
€ million issuer   guarantor   guarantor   guarantor   subsidiaries   Eliminations   Unilever Group  















Profit and loss account                            
for the year ended 31 December 2001                            
                             
Group turnover         51 514     51 514  
Operating costs   (27 ) 82   4   (46 399 )    (46 340 ) 















Group operating profit   (27 ) 82   4   5 115     5 174  
Share of operating profit of joint ventures         84     84  















Operating profit   (27 ) 82   4   5 199     5 258  
Dividends   2 202   738     (2 940 )     
Other income from fixed investments         12     12  
Interest (782 ) (444 ) (177 ) 2   (245 )   (1 646 ) 
Intercompany finance costs 1 010   423   72   (424 ) (1 081 )     















Profit on ordinary activities                            
before taxation 228   2 154   715   (418 ) 945     3 624  
Taxation (84 ) (98 ) (24 ) 155   (1 496 )    (1 547 ) 















Profit on ordinary activities                            
after taxation 144   2 056   691   (263 ) (551 )   2 077  
Minority interests         (239 )   (239 ) 
Equity earnings of subsidiaries   (218 ) 1 147   (315 )   (614 )  















Net profit 144   1 838   1 838   (578 ) (790 ) (614 ) 1 838  















                             
                             















Profit and loss account                            
for the year ended 31 December 2000                            
                             
Group turnover         47 582   47 582  
Operating costs   256   8   (19 ) (44 646 )    (44 401 ) 















Group operating profit   256   8   (19 ) 2 936     3 181  
Share of operating profit of joint ventures         57     57  















Operating profit   256   8   (19 ) 2 993     3 238  
Dividends   706   734     (1 440 )     
Other income from fixed investments         (4 )   (4 ) 
Interest (268 ) (218 ) (69 ) 13   (90 )   (632 ) 
Intercompany finance costs 270   375   (6 ) (328 ) (311 )    















Profit on ordinary activities                            
before taxation 2   1 119   667   (334 ) 1 148     2 602  
Taxation (1 ) (63 ) (2 ) 123   (1 339 )    (1 282 ) 















Profit on ordinary activities                            
after taxation 1   1 056   665   (211 ) (191 )   1 320  
Minority interests         (215 )   (215 ) 
Equity earnings of subsidiaries   49   440   (618 )   129    















Net profit 1   1 105   1 105   (829 ) (406 ) 129   1 105  















Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Additional information for US investors 125
Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements

 

  Unilever           Unilever              
  Capital           United              
  Corporation   Unilever N.V.   Unilever PLC   States Inc.   Non-          
  subsidiary   parent issuer/   parent   subsidiary   guarantor          
€ million issuer   guarantor   guarantor   guarantor   subsidiaries   Eliminations   Unilever Group  















Cash flow statement                            
for the year ended 31 December 2002                            
                             
Cash flow from group                            
operating activities 34   222   (52 ) (45 ) 7 724     7 883  
Dividends from joint ventures         83     83  
Returns on investments and servicing of finance 16   155   (105 ) (50 ) (1 402 )   (1 386 )
Taxation   (6 ) 142   (335 ) (1 618 )   (1 817 )
Capital expenditure and                            
financial investment   (554 ) (42 ) 16   (1 126 )   (1 706 )
Acquisitions and disposals         1 755     1 755  
Dividends paid on ordinary share capital   (910 ) (689 )     19   (1 580 )















Cash flow before management                            
of liquid resources and financing 50   (1 093 ) (746 ) (414 ) 5 416   19   3 232  
Management of liquid resources 2   (126 )     (468 )   (592 )
Financing (53 ) 1 547   578   419   (5 082 )   (2 591 )















Increase/(decrease) in cash in the period (1 ) 328   (168 ) 5   (134 ) 19   49  















                             
                             















Cash flow statement                            
for the year ended 31 December 2001                            
                             
Cash flow from group                            
operating activities 24   2   92   66   7 313   7 497  
Dividends from joint ventures         82     82  
Returns on investments and servicing of finance 202   2 092   900   (422 ) (4 659 )    (1 887 ) 
Taxation   (53 ) (154 ) (502 ) (1 496 )    (2 205 ) 
Capital expenditure and financial investment   (369 ) (32 ) 310   (1 267 )    (1 358 ) 
Acquisitions and disposals         3 477     3 477  
Dividends paid on ordinary share capital   (818 ) (614 )     12   (1 420 ) 















Cash flow before management                            
of liquid resources and financing 226   854   192   (548 ) 3 450   12   4 186  
Management of liquid resources 50   428   400     228     1 106  
Financing (273 ) (1 422 )  (592 ) 551   (3 362 )   (5 098 )















Increase/(decrease) in cash in the period 3   (140 )   3   316   12   194  















                             
                             















Cash flow statement                            
for the year ended 31 December 2000                            
                             
Cash flow from group                            
operating activities (80 ) 361   (5 ) (19 ) 6 481     6 738  
Dividends from joint ventures         38     38  
Returns on investments and servicing of finance 103   865   677   (315 ) (2 128 )   (798 )
Taxation   23   128   (301 ) (1 584 )   (1 734 )
Capital expenditure and                            
financial investment   (202 ) 7   (320 ) (546 )   (1 061 )
Acquisitions and disposals         (27 373 )   (27 373 )
Dividends paid on ordinary share capital   (762 ) (611 )     8   (1 365 )















Cash flow before management                            
of liquid resources and financing 23   285   196   (955 ) (25 112 ) 8   (25 555 )
Management of liquid resources 802   1 652   (628 )   638     2 464  
Financing (832 ) (1 642 ) 432   946   23 998     22 902  















Increase/(decrease) in cash in the period (7 ) 295     (9 ) (476 ) 8   (189 )















Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

126 Additional information for US investors
  Unilever Group

 

  Unilever           Unilever              
  Capital           United              
  Corporation   Unilever N.V.   Unilever PLC   States Inc.   Non-          
  subsidiary   parent issuer/   parent   subsidiary   guarantor          
€ million issuer   guarantor   guarantor   guarantor   subsidiaries   Eliminations   Unilever Group  















Balance sheet                            
as at 31 December 2002                            
                             
Goodwill and intangible assets     5     20 269     20 274  
Tangible fixed assets       5   7 431     7 436  
Fixed investments   576     10 296   92   (10 285 )  679  
Net assets of subsidiaries                            
(equity accounted)   9 337   7 827   (9 223 )  (14 344 )  6 403    















Fixed assets   9 913   7 832   1 078   13 448   (3 882 )  28 389  















Stocks         4 500     4 500  
Amounts due from group companies 6 025   20 303   1 107   3 996   (31 431 )     
Debtors due within one year   299   32   1 222   4 322     5 875  
Debtors due after more than one year 43     42   14   2 257     2 356  
Cash and current investments 9   780   51     2 638     3 478  















Current assets 6 077   21 382   1 232   5 232   (17 714 )    16 209  















Borrowings (1 780 )  (4 540 )  (1 407 )  (4 ) (1 780 )    (9 511 ) 
Amounts due to group companies   (14 121 )  (1 156 )    15 277      
Trade and other creditors (64 ) (1 248 )  (619 ) (125 ) (9 035 )    (11 091 ) 















Creditors due within one year (1 844 )  (19 909 )  (3 182 )  (129 ) 4 462     (20 602 ) 















                             















Total assets less current liabilities 4 233   11 386   5 882   6 181   196   (3 882 )  23 996  















Borrowings 4 027   5 257       1 649     10 933  
Trade and other creditors       76   565     641  















Creditors due after more than one year 4 027   5 257     76   2 214     11 574  















Provisions for liabilities and charges   262   15   495   5 155     5 927  
                             
Minority interests         628     628  
                             
Capital and reserves attributable to:                            
PLC   164         (164 )  
NV     5 699       (5 699 )   
Called up share capital   421   222     (1 )    642  
Share premium account   1 399   145     (3 )    1 541  
Other reserves   (1 498 ) (595 ) (365 ) (573 )  938   (2 093 ) 
Profit retained 206   5 381   396   5 975   (7 224 )  1 043   5 777  















Total capital and reserves 206   5 867   5 867   5 610   (7 801 )  (3 882 )  5 867  















                             















Total capital employed 4 233   11 386   5 882   6 181   196   (3 882 )  23 996  















Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Additional information for US investors 127
Unilever Group  
 
Financial Statements

 

  Unilever           Unilever              
  Capital           United              
  Corporation   Unilever N.V.   Unilever PLC   States Inc.   Non-          
  subsidiary   parent issuer/   parent   subsidiary   guarantor          
€ million issuer   guarantor   guarantor   guarantor   subsidiaries   Eliminations   Unilever Group  















Balance sheet                            
as at 31 December 2001                            
                             
Goodwill and intangible assets         24 964     24 964  
Tangible fixed assets       6   9 234     9 240  
Fixed investments   280     10   594     884  
Net assets of subsidiaries                            
(equity accounted)   9 496   9 185   11 432   (10 790 ) (19 323 )  















Fixed assets   9 776   9 185   11 448   24 002   (19 323 ) 35 088  















Stocks         5 343     5 343  
Amounts due from group companies 12 327   19 177   3 156     (34 660 )    
Debtors due within one year   197   70   816   6 102     7 185  
Debtors due after more than one year 88       33   2 728     2 849  
Cash and current investments 14   361   226     1 700     2 301  















Current assets 12 429   19 735   3 452   849   (18 787 )   17 678  















Borrowings (837 ) (5 937 ) (1 707 ) (11 ) (2 787 )   (11 279 )
Amounts due to group companies (5 924 ) (9 443 ) (2 209 ) (4 755 ) 22 331      
Trade and other creditors (65 ) (959 ) (463 ) 96   (10 542 )   (11 933 )















Creditors due within one year (6 826 ) (16 339 ) (4 379 ) (4 670 ) 9 002     (23 212 )















                             















Total assets less current liabilities 5 603   13 172   8 258   7 627   14 217   (19 323 ) 29 554  















Borrowings 5 365   5 883   1 249     1 724     14 221  
Trade and other creditors       77   728     805  















Creditors due after more than one year 5 365   5 883   1 249   77   2 452     15 026  















                             
Provisions for liabilities and charges 84   296   16   95   6 380     6 871  
                             
Minority interests         664     664  
                             
Capital and reserves attributable to:                            
PLC   2 101         (2 101 )  
NV     4 889       (4 889 )  
Called up share capital   421   222     (1 )   642  
Share premium account   1 399   154     (2 )   1 551  
Other reserves   (1 077 ) (540 ) (260 ) (358 ) 618   (1 617 )
Profit retained 154   4 149   2 268   7 715   5 082   (12 951 ) 6 417  















Total capital and reserves 154   6 993   6 993   7 455   4 721   (19 323 ) 6 993  















                             















Total capital employed 5 603   13 172   8 258   7 627   14 217   (19 323 ) 29 554  















 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

128 Principal group companies and fixed investments
  As at 31 December 2002
Unilever Group

 


The companies listed below and on pages 129 to 131 are those which in the opinion of the directors, principally affect the amount of profit and assets shown in the Unilever Group accounts. The directors consider that those companies not listed are not significant in relation to Unilever as a whole.
 
Full information as required by Articles 379 and 414 of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands has been filed by Unilever N.V. with the Commercial Registry in Rotterdam.
 
Particulars of PLC group companies and other significant holdings asrequired by the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985 will be annexed to the next Annual Return of Unilever PLC.
 
The main activities of the companies listed below are indicated according to the following key:

Holding companies H
Foods F
Home & Personal Care P
Other Operations O

Unless otherwise indicated, the companies are incorporated and principally operate in the countries under which they are shown.

The aggregate percentage of equity capital directly or indirectly held by NV or PLC is shown in the margin, except where it is 100%. All these percentages are rounded down to the nearest whole number.

Shares in the companies listed are usually held directly or indirectly by one of NV or PLC. A long standing exception is in the United States where companies are jointly owned by NV (73%) and PLC (27%). As a result of the Bestfoods integration during 2002, the shares of certain Bestfoods and Unilever companies (or their merged successor) are held partly by Unilever United States, Inc. and, as a consequence, both NV and PLC have indirect shareholdings in them. The percentage of Unilever’s shareholdings held either directly or indirectly by NV and PLC are identified in the tables according to the following code:



NV 100% a
PLC 100% b
NV 73%; PLC 27% c
NV 88%; PLC 12% d
NV 21%; PLC 79% e
NV 2%; PLC 98% f




Principal group companies    




% Europe Ownership Activity




  Austria    
  Österreichische Unilever Ges.m.b.H. d FP




  Belgium    
99 Bestfoods Belgium B.V.B.A/S.P.R.L. d F
  Unilever Belgium N.V./S.A. d FP




  Bulgaria    
  Unilever Bulgaria E.O.O.D. a FP




  Croatia    
  Unilever Croatia d.o.o. a FP




  Czech Republic    
  Unilever ČR s.r.o. a FP








% Europe continued Ownership Activity




  Denmark    
  Unilever Bestfoods A/S d F
  Unilever Danmark A/S a FP




  Estonia    
  Unilever Eesti OU a FP




  Finland    
  Suomen Unilever Oy a FP




  France    
99 Amora Maille Société Industrielle S.A.S. d F
99 Bestfoods France Société Industrielle S.A. d F
99 Cogesal-Miko S.A.S. d F
99 FRALIB Sourcing Unit S.A. d F
99 Frigedoc S.A. d F
99 Lever Fabergé France S.A. d P
99 Unilever Bestfoods France S.A. d F
99 Unilever France S.A.S. d H




  Germany    
  Langnese-Iglo GmbH d F
  Lever Fabergé Deutschland GmbH d P
  Monda Beteiligungs GmbH d F
  Monda IPR GmbH & Co. OHG (1) d F
  Monda Vermögensverwaltungs    
    GmbH & Co. OHG (1) d F
  Pfanni GmbH & Co. OHG Stavenhagen (1) d F
  PW Vermietungs GmbH & Co. KG (1) d F
  UBG Vermietungs GmbH & Co. OHG (1) d H
  Unilever Bestfoods Deutschland GmbH d F
  Unilever Beteiligungs GmbH d H
  Unilever Deutschland GmbH d H




  Greece    
67 ‘Elais’ Oleaginous Products S.A. a F
  Unilever Hellas A.E.B.E. a FP




  Hungary    
  Unilever Magyarország Kft a FP




  Ireland    
  Lever Fabergé Ireland Ltd. b P
  Unilever Bestfoods (Ireland) Limited. b F




  Italy    




  Lever Fabergé Italia Srl d P
  Sagit Srl d F
  Unilever Bestfoods Italia Srl d F
  Unilever Italia SpA d H




  Latvia    
  Unilever Baltic LLC a FP




  Lithuania    
  Unilever Lietuva UAB a FP




       
(1) Due to the inclusion of the partnerships in the consolidated group accounts of Unilever, para 264(b) of the German trade law grants an exemption from the duty to prepare individual statutory financial statements and management reports in accordance with the requirements for limited liability companies and to have these audited.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Principal group companies and fixed investments 129
As at 31 December 2002  
Unilever Group
 
Financial Statements
 
Principal group companies continued




% Europe continued Ownership Activity




  The Netherlands    
  Iglo Mora Groep B.V. a F
  Lever Fabergé Nederland B.V. a P
  Mixhold B.V. d H
  Unilever Bestfoods Nederland B.V. d F
  Unilever N.V. (2)   H
  Unilever Nederland B.V. a H




  Norway    
  Unilever Bestfoods A/S a F




  Poland    
99 Unilever Polska S.A. d FP




  Portugal    
74 IgloOlá-Distribuição de Gelados e de    
     Ultracongelados Lda. a F
60 LeverElida-Distribuição de Produtos de    
     Limpeza e Higiene Pessoal Lda. a P
  Unilever Bestfoods Portugal-Produtos    
     Alimentares S.A. d F




  Romania    
99 Unilever South Central Europe S.R.L a FP




  Russia    
  Unilever SNG a FP




  Slovakia    
  Unilever Slovensko spol. sr. o. a FP




  Slovenia    
  Unilever Slovenia d.o.o. a FP




  Spain    
  Unilever España S.A. a HP
  Unilever Foods España S.A. a F




  Sweden    
  GB Glace AB a F
  Lever Fabergé AB a P
  Unilever Bestfoods AB a F




  Switzerland    
  Knorr Nährmittel AG d H
  Lever Fabergé GmbH d P
  Meina Holding AG d H
51 Lusso Foods AG d F
  Sunlight AG a O
  Unilever Bestfoods Schweiz GmbH d F
  Unilever Cosmetics International S.A. a P
  Unilever (Schweiz) AG a O
  Unilever Swiss Holdings AG a H
  Unilever Raw Materials AG a F




  Ukraine    
  Unilever Ukraine LLCM a FP




   
(2) SeeBasis of consolidation on page 66.
(3) A division of Conopco, Inc., a subsidiary of Unilever United States, Inc.

       




% Europe continued Ownership Activity




  United Kingdom    
  Ben & Jerry’s Homemade Ltd. e F
  Birds Eye Wall’ s Ltd. e F
  Lever Fabergé Ltd. b P
  Lipton Ltd. b F
  Slim•Fast Foods Ltd. b F
  Unilever Bestfoods UK Ltd. e F
  Unilever Cosmetics International (UK) Ltd. b P
  Unilever PLC (2)   H
  Unilever UK Central Resources Ltd. b O
  Unilever UK Holdings Ltd. b H
  Unilever UK & CN Holdings Ltd. e H




% North America Ownership Activity




  Canada    
  Bestfoods Canada Inc. e F
  Bestfoods Holdings Inc., Canada e H
  U L Canada Inc. e FP




  United States of America    
  Ben & Jerry’s Homemade Inc. c F
  Good Humor-Breyers Ice Cream (3) c F
  Slim-Fast Foods Company (3) c F
  Unilever Bestfoods (3) c F
  Unilever Bestfoods Foodsolutions (3) c F
  Unilever Capital Corporation c O
  Unilever Cosmetics International (3) c P
  Unilever Home & Personal Care (3) c P
  Unilever Ice Cream (3) c F
  Unilever United States, Inc. c H

% Africa, Middle East and Turkey Ownership Activity




  Algeria    
60 Unilever Algérie SPA a P




  Côte d’ Ivoire    
90 Unilever Côte d’ Ivoire b FPO




  Democratic Republic of Congo    
76 Plantations et Huileries du Congo s.a.r.l. a O




  Dubai    
  Unilever Gulf Free Zone Establishment b FP




  Egypt    
60 Fine Foods Products SAE b F
60 Fine Tea Company SAE b F
60 Lever Egypt SAE b P




  Ethiopia    
72 Unilever Ethiopia Private Limited Company b FP




  Ghana    
67 Unilever Ghana Ltd. b FPO




  Israel    
51 Glidat Strauss Ltd. b F
59 Unilever Bestfoods Israel Ltd. c F
  Lever Israel Ltd. b P




  Kenya    
  Bestfoods Kenya Ltd. b F
88 Brooke Bond Kenya Ltd. b O
  Unilever Kenya Ltd. b FP




  Malawi    
  Lever Brothers (Malawi) Ltd. b FP





Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

130 Principal group companies and fixed investments
  As at 31 December 2002
Unilever Group

 

Principal group companies continued




% Africa, Middle East and Turkey continued Ownership Activity




  Morocco    
  Knorr Bestfoods Morocco S.A. a F
  Unilever Maghreb S.A. a P




  Nigeria    
50 Unilever Nigeria Plc b FP




  Saudi Arabia    
49 Binzagr Lever Ltd.* b FP
49 Lever Arabia Ltd.* b P




  South Africa    
59 Unilever Bestfoods Robertsons (Pty) Limited c F
  Unilever South Africa (Pty) Limited b FP




  Tanzania    
  Brooke Bond Tanzania Ltd. b O




  Tunisia    
99 CODEPAR Tunisia a P
52 Maghreb Alimentation S.A. a F
99 Société de Produits Chimiques et Détergents a P




  Turkey    
 99 Lever Elida Temizlik ve Kişisel Bakim Ürünleri Sanayi ve Ticaret A.Ş. a P
  Unilever Sanayi ve Ticaret Türk A.Ş. a F
  Unilever Tüketim Ürünleri Satiş, Pazarlama ve Ticaret A.Ş. a FP




  Uganda    
  Unilever Uganda Ltd. b FP




  Zambia    
  Lever Brothers Zambia Limited b FP




  Zimbabwe    
  Lever Brothers (Private) Ltd. b FP




% Asia and Pacific Ownership Activity




  Australia    
  Unilever Australia Ltd. b FP




  Bangladesh    
61 Lever Brothers Bangladesh Ltd. b FP




  China    
80 Bestfoods Guangzhou Foods Ltd. c F
  Unilever (China) Ltd. a H
77 Unilever Company Ltd. a P
  Unilever Foods (China) Company Ltd. a F
  Unilever Services (Shanghai) Company Limited a P
  Wall’s (China) Company Ltd. a F




  China S.A.R.    
  Unilever Hong Kong Ltd. a FP




  India    
25 Hindlever Chemicals Ltd. f O
51 Hindustan Lever Ltd. f FPO




  Indonesia    
85 P.T. Unilever Indonesia Tbk a FP




  Japan    
  Nippon Lever KK a FP




       




% Asia Pacific continued Ownership Activity




  Malaysia    
  Pamol Plantations Sdn. Bhd. b O
70 Unilever (Malaysia) Holdings Sdn. Bhd. b FP




  New Zealand    
  Unilever New Zealand Ltd. b FP




  Pakistan    
67 Unilever Pakistan Ltd. b FP




  Philippines    
  Unilever Philippines, Inc. a FP




  Singapore    
  Unilever Singapore Private Ltd. b FP




  South Korea    
  Unilever Korea Chusik Hoesa a FP




  Sri Lanka    
  Unilever Ceylon Ltd. b FPO




  Taiwan    
  Unilever Taiwan Ltd. a FP




  Thailand    
  Unilever Thai Trading Ltd. a FP




  Vietnam    
  Elida P/S a P
66 Lever Vietnam a P
  Unilever Bestfoods Vietnam a F




% Latin America Ownership Activity




  Argentina    
  Refinerias de Maiz S.A.I.C.F. d F
  Unilever de Argentina S.A. d FP




  Bolivia    
  Quimbol Lever S.A. a FP




  Brazil    
  Mavibel Brasil Ltda. d H
  Unilever Brasil Ltda. d FP
  Unilever Bestfoods Brasil Ltda. d F




  Chile    
  Unilever Chile Ltda. d FP




  Colombia    
  Disa S.A. d F
  Unilever Andina Colombia S.A. d FP
60 Varela S.A. d P




  Costa Rica    
  Productos Agroindustriales del Caribe S.A. c F
  Unilever de Centroamerica S.A. a FP




  Dominican Republic    
70 Knorr Alimentaria S.A. a F
  Unilever Dominicana S.A. a P




  Ecuador    
  Unilever Andina – Ecuador S.A. a FP




   
* These companies are consolidated on the basis that Unilever is able to exercise a dominant influence.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Principal group companies and fixed investments
131
As at 31 December 2002  
Unilever Group
 
Financial Statements
 
 

Principal group companies continued





% Latin America continued Ownership Activity




  El Salvador    
  Unilever de Centroamerica S.A. a FP




  Guatemala    
  Unilever de Centroamerica S.A. a FP




  Honduras    
  Unilever de Centroamerica S.A. a FP




  Mexico    
  Circulo Esmeralda S.A. de C.V. d F
  Corporativo Unilever de Mexico S.de R.L. de C.V. d H
  Unilever de Mexico S.A. de C.V. d FP




  Netherlands Antilles    
  Unilever Becumij N.V. a O




  Nicaragua    
  Unilever de Centroamerica S.A. a FP




  Panama    
  Unilever de Centroamerica S.A. a FP




  Paraguay    
  Unilever de Paraguay S.A. a FP




  Peru    
  Apromsa S.A. b F
99 Industrias Pacocha S.A. a FP




  Trinidad & Tobago    
50 Lever Brothers West Indies Ltd. b FP




  Uruguay    
  Bestfoods Uruguay S.A. c F
  Sudy Lever S.A. a FP




  Venezuela    
  Aliven S.A. b F
  Unilever Andina S.A. a FP




Principal fixed investments
Joint ventures
   




% Europe Ownership Activity




  Portugal    
40 FIMA/VG-Distribuição de Produtos    
  Alimentares, Lda. a F




% North America    




  United States of America    
50 The Pepsi/Lipton Partnership c F




% Asia and Pacific    




  China S.A.R.    
50 CPC/AJI (Hong Kong) Ltd. c F




  Malaysia    
50 CPC/AJI (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd. c F




  Philippines    
50 California Manufacturing Company Inc. c F




  Singapore    
50 CPC/AJI (Singapore) Pte Ltd. c F




  Taiwan    
50 CPC/AJI (Taiwan) Ltd. c F




  Thailand    
50 CPC/AJI (Thailand) Ltd. c F




       
Associated companies    




% Europe Ownership Activity




  United Kingdom    
33 Langholm Capital Partners b O




% North America    




  United States of America    
33 JohnsonDiversey Holdings Inc. a P




 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

132
Company accounts
  Unilever N.V.

 

 
Balance sheet as at 31 December        
 
€ million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Fixed assets        
Fixed investments 11 416  
 7 328
 
         
Current assets        
Debtors 20 602   19 374  
Cash at bank and in hand 780   361  
 



         
Total current assets 21 382   19 735  
Creditors due within one year (19 909 ) (16 339 )
Net current assets 1 473   3 396  





Total assets less current liabilities 12 889   10 724  





Creditors due after more than one year 5 257   5 883  
         
Provisions for liabilities and charges 262   296  
         
Capital and reserves 7 370   4 545  
Called up share capital:        
Preferential share capital 21 130   130  
Ordinary share capital 21 291   291  
 



         
  421   421  
Share premium account 1 399   1 399  
Profit retained and other reserves 5 550   2 725  





Total capital employed 12 889   10 724  





         
Profit and loss account for the year ended 31 December        
 
€ million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Income from fixed investments after taxation 3 779   2 202  
Other income and expenses 292   (146 )





Profit for the year 4 071   2 056  





Pages 66 to 112 and 128 to 133 contain the notes to the NV company accounts. For the information required by Article 392 of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, refer to pages 65 and 133.

In accordance with Article 402 of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, the accounts of NV have been included in the consolidated accounts. The profit and loss account mentions only income from fixed investments after taxation as a separate item. The balance sheet includes the proposed profit appropriation.

The Board of Directors
4 March 2003

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Notes to the company accounts
133
Unilever N.V.
 
 
Financial Statements
 
Fixed investments
 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Shares in group companies 11 008   7 201  
Book value of PLC shares held in connection with share options 368   264  
Less NV shares held by group companies (168 ) (153 )
Other unlisted investments 208   16  





  11 416   7 328  





Movements during the year:        
1 January 7 328      
Movement in PLC shares held in connection with share options 104      
Movement in NV shares held by group companies (14 )    
Other unlisted investments 191      
Additions 6 423      
Decrease (2 616 )    





31 December 11 416      





Shares in group companies are stated at cost in accordance with international accounting practice in various countries, in particular the United Kingdom.





         
Debtors        
 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Loans to group companies 19 214   16 607  
Other amounts owed by group companies 1 089   2 570  
Amounts owed by undertakings in which the company has a participating interest 1   1  
Other 298   196  





  20 602   19 374  





Of which due after more than one year 882   9  





         
         
Cash at bank and in hand        
 
€ million
2002
 
€ million
2001
 





This includes amounts for which repayment notice is required of: 187   61  





         
Creditors        
 
million
2002
million
2001





Due within one year:        
Bank loans and overdrafts 4   39  
Bonds and other loans 4 536   5 898  
Loans from group companies 1 817   638  
Other amounts owed to group companies 12 304   8 805  
Taxation and social security 238   79  
Accruals and deferred income 205   264  
Dividends 643   601  
Other 162   15  





  19 909   16 339  





Due after more than one year:        
Bonds and other loans 5 257   5 883  





Provisions for liabilities and charges
 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Pension provisions 131   124  
Deferred taxation and other provisions 131   172  





  262   296  





Of which due within one year 73   68  





Ordinary share capital
Shares numbered 1 to 2 400 are held by a subsidiary of NV and a subsidiary of PLC, each holding 50%. Additionally, 17 711 169 € 0.51 ordinary shares are held by NV and other group companies. Full details are given in note 29 on page 111.

Share premium account
The share premium shown in the balance sheet is not available for the issue of bonus shares or for repayment without incurring withholding tax payable by the company. This is despite the change in the Netherlands tax law, as a result of which dividends received from 2001 onwards by individual shareholders who are Netherlands residents are no longer taxed.

Profit retained and other reserves
 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Profit retained 31 December 6 591   3 508  
Cost of NV shares purchased and held by NV and by its subsidiaries (1 041 ) (783 )





Balance 31 December 5 550   2 725  





Profit retained shown in the company accounts and the notes thereto is greater than the amount shown in the consolidated balance sheet, mainly because of certain inter-company transactions which are eliminated in the consolidated accounts.

Contingent liabilities
These are not expected to give rise to any material loss and include guarantees given for group and other companies, under which amounts outstanding at 31 December were:

 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Group companies 8 878   11 033  





Of the above, guaranteed also by PLC 5 864   6 247  






 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

134
Further statutory information
  Unilever N.V.

 

The rules for profit appropriation in the Articles of Association (summary of Article 41)
The profit for the year is applied firstly to the reserves required by law or by the Equalisation Agreement, secondly to cover losses of previous years, if any, and thirdly to the reserves deemed necessary by the Board of Directors. Dividends due to the holders of the Cumulative Preference Shares, including any arrears in such dividends, are then paid; if the profit is insufficient for this purpose, the amount available is distributed to them in proportion to the dividend percentages of their shares. Any profit remaining thereafter is at the disposal of the General Meeting. Distributions from this remaining profit are made to the holders of the ordinary shares pro rata to the nominal amounts of their holdings. The General Meeting can only decide to make distributions from reserves on the basis of a proposal by the Board and in compliance with the law and the Equalisation Agreement.

 
million
2002
 
million
2001
 





Proposed profit appropriation        
Profit for the year 4 071   2 056  
Preference dividends (42 ) (51 )





Profit at disposal of the Annual General Meeting of shareholders 4 029   2 005  
Ordinary dividends (946 ) (872 )





Profit for the year retained 3 083   1 133  
Profit retained – 1 January 3 508   2 375  





Profit retained – 31 December 6 591   3 508  





Special controlling rights under the Articles of Association
See note 21 on page 97.

Auditors
A resolution will be proposed at the Annual General Meeting on 7 May 2003 for the reappointment of PricewaterhouseCoopers Accountants N.V. as auditors of NV. The present appointment will end at the conclusion of the Annual General Meeting.

Corporate Centre
Unilever N.V.
Weena 455
PO Box 760

3000 DK Rotterdam

J A A van der Bijl
S G Williams
Joint Secretaries of Unilever N.V.
4 March 2003

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002



Back to Contents

Company accounts 135
Unilever PLC  
 
Financial Statements
 

Balance sheet as at 31 December

  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





Fixed assets        
Goodwill and intangible assets 3    
Fixed investments 2 456   2 433  
         
Current assets        
Debtors        
   Debtors due within one year 787   2 007  
   Debtors due after more than one year 27    
Cash and current investments 33   138  





Total current assets 847   2 145  
Creditors due within one year (2 126 ) (2 721 )





Net current assets/(liabilities) (1 279 ) (576 )





Total assets less current liabilities 1 180   1 857  





         
Creditors due after more than one year   763  
         
Capital and reserves 1 180   1 094  
         
Called up share capital 21 41   41  
Share premium account 94   94  
Capital redemption reserve 23 11   11  
Profit retained 1 034   948  
         





Total capital employed 1 180   1 857  





All amounts included in capital and reserves are classified as equity as defined under United Kingdom Financial Reporting Standard 4.

As permitted by Section 230 of the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985, PLC’s profit and loss account does not accompany its balance sheet.

 

On behalf of the Board of Directors

 

 

N W A FitzGerald Chairman
A Burgmans Vice-Chairman

4 March 2003

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

136 Notes to the company accounts
  Unilever PLC
 
 
 
Fixed assets        
         
Goodwill and Intangibles        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





Goodwill    
Intangible assets 3    





  3    





         
         
Fixed investments        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





Shares in group companies 2 237   2 237  
Book value of PLC shares held in        
connection with share options 219   196  





  2 456   2 433  





         
Shares in group companies
Shares in group companies are stated at cost or valuation, less amounts written off.
         
  £ million      
  2002      





Movements during the year:        
1 January 2 237      
Additions 36      
Disposals (36 )    





31 December 2 237      





         
         
Shares held in connection with share options        
  £ million      
  2002      





Movements during the year:        
1 January 196      
Additions 55      
Disposals (30 )    
Valuation adjustments (2 )    





31 December 219      





         
         
Debtors        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





Due within one year:        
Amounts owed by group companies 720   1 928  
Other 67   79  





  787   2 007  





Due after more than one year:        
Other 27    





         
         
Cash and current investments        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





This includes amounts for which        
repayment notice is required 33   138  





Creditors        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





Due within one year:        
Amounts owed to group companies 752   1 349  
Bonds and other loans 915   1 043  
Taxation and social security 135   34  
Dividends 311   284  
Other 9   2  
Accruals and deferred income 4   9  





  2 126   2 721  





Due after more than one year:        
Bonds and other loans   763  





         
         
Profit retained        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





1 January 948   935  
Profit for the year 546   430  
Dividends on ordinary and deferred shares (460 ) (417 )





31 December 1 034   948  





         
         
Contingent liabilities        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





These are not expected to give rise to any material loss and include guarantees given for group companies, under which amounts outstanding at 31 December were:    8 077         8 526     





Of the above, guaranteed also by NV 3 816   3 817  





         
         
Remuneration of auditors        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





Parent company audit fee 1.6   1.4  
Payments by the parent company for non-audit services provided by PricewaterhouseCoopers United Kingdom(a) 9.3   17.3  
         
(a) See also note 2 on page 77.        





         
         
Profit appropriation        
  £ million   £ million  
  2002   2001  





The proposed appropriation of the profit of PLC is as follows:        
Interim and recommended final dividends 460   417  





Profit for the year retained 86   13  






 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Further statutory information and other information 137
   Unilever PLC  
 
Financial Statements
 

Employee involvement and communication
Unilever’s UK companies maintain formal processes to inform, consult and involve employees and their representatives. Most of the United Kingdom sites are accredited to the Investors in People standard. The European Foundation for Quality Management’s model for measuring Business Excellence, with its strong emphasis on maximising the potential of employees, is also widely employed.

A European Works Council, embracing employee and management representatives from 15 countries of Western Europe, has been in existence for several years and provides a forum for discussing issues that extend across national boundaries.

The directors’ reports of the United Kingdom group companies contain more details about how they have communicated with their employees during 2002.

Equal opportunities and diversity
The heads of all operating companies and units in the UK have committed their businesses to achieving greater diversity. Every Unilever company in the United Kingdom has an equal opportunities policy and actively pursues equality of opportunity for all employees.

The Company has committed itself to carrying out an Equal Pay Audit, and Richard Greenhalgh, Chairman of Unilever UK, is an Equal Pay Champion by the UK Government. The Company is also reviewing ways in which diversity in recruitment and selection may be further improved.

A major initiative is underway to increase the take-up of flexible working options where appropriate for business and employee needs.

The Company was delighted to be awarded one of the Government’s first ‘Castle awards’ recognising its achievements in providing equality of opportunity for women.

Charitable and other contributions
During the year UK group companies made a total contribution to the community of £9 million, based on the London Benchmarking Group Model.

No contribution was made for political purposes.

Supplier payment policies
Individual operating companies are responsible for agreeing the terms and conditions under which business transactions with their suppliers are conducted. The directors’ reports of the United Kingdom operating companies give information about their supplier payment policies as required by the United Kingdom Companies Act 1985. PLC, as a holding company, does not itself make any relevant payments in this respect.

Auditors
Following the transfer of the business of the PLC auditors PricewaterhouseCoopers to a Limited Liability Partnership (LLP) from 1 January 2003, PricewaterhouseCoopers resigned on 11 February 2003 and the PLC directors appointed its successor, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as auditors. A resolution will be proposed at the Annual General Meeting on 7 May 2003 for the re-appointment of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as auditors of PLC. The present appointment will end at the conclusion of the Annual General Meeting.

Authority to purchase own shares
At the Annual General Meeting of PLC held on 8 May 2002, authority was given pursuant to Article 64 of the PLC Articles of Association to make market purchases of PLC ordinary shares of 1.4p each, to a maximum of 290 million shares. This authority will expire on 7 May 2003. The Company has not exercised this authority during the year.

Details of shares purchased by employee share trusts and Unilever group companies to satisfy options granted under PLC’s employee share schemes are given in the Remuneration report on page 55 and in note 29 to the consolidated accounts on page 111.

Directors report of PLC
For the purposes of Section 234 of the Companies Act 1985, the Directors Report of Unilever PLC for the year ended 31 December 2002 comprises this page and the information contained in the Report of the Directors on pages 2 to 61, Dividends on page 147 and Principal group companies and fixed investments on pages 128 to 131.

Corporate Centre
Unilever PLC
PO Box 68 Unilever House
Blackfriars
London EC4P 4BQ

Unilever PLC Registered Office
Port Sunlight
Wirral
Merseyside CH62 4UJ

Unilever PLC Registrars
Lloyds TSB Registrars
The Causeway
Worthing
West Sussex BN99 6DA

 

 

 

By Order of the Board

J A A van der Bijl
S G Williams

Joint Secretaries of Unilever PLC
4 March 2003


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

138 Control of Unilever
   

 

Share capital
NV’s issued share capital on 31 December 2002 was made up of:

€291 503 709 split into 571 575 900 ordinary shares of €0.51 each
€1 089 072 split into 2 400 ordinary shares numbered 1 to 2 400, known as special shares
€130 854 115 split into several classes of cumulative preference shares.
   
PLC’s issued share capital on 31 December 2002 was made up of:
   
£40 760 420 split into 2 911 458 580 ordinary shares of 1.4p each
£100 000 of deferred stock.

For NV share capital, the euro amounts quoted in this document are representations in euros on the basis of Article 67c of Book 2 of the Civil Code in the Netherlands, rounded to two decimal places, of underlying amounts in Dutch guilders, which have not been converted into euros in NV’s Articles of Association or in the Equalisation Agreement. Until conversion formally takes place by amendment of the Articles of Association, the entitlements to dividends and voting rights are based on the underlying Dutch guilder amounts.

Unity of management
In order to ensure unity of management, NV and PLC have the same directors. We achieve this through our nomination procedure. Only the holders of NV’s special shares can nominate candidates for election to the NV Board, and only the holders of PLC’s deferred stock can nominate candidates for election to the PLC Board. The current directors, who have agreed to act on the recommendations of the Nomination Committee, can ensure that both NV and PLC shareholders are presented with the same candidates for election as directors, because the joint holders of both the special shares and the deferred stock are NV Elma and United Holdings Limited, which are subsidiaries of NV and PLC.

NV and PLC both act as directors of NV Elma and of United Holdings Limited. The Chairmen of NV and PLC are additional directors of United Holdings Limited.

Equalisation Agreement
To ensure that NV and PLC operate for all practical purposes as a single company, we have an Equalisation Agreement.

Under the Equalisation Agreement NV and PLC adopt the same financial periods and accounting policies. Neither company can issue or reduce capital without the consent of the other. If one company had losses, or was unable to pay its preference dividends, we would make up the loss or shortfall out of:

the current profits of the other company (after it has paid its own preference shareholders)
then its own free reserves
then the free reserves of the other company.

If either company could not pay its ordinary dividends, we would follow the same procedure, except that the current profits of the other company would only be used after it had paid its own ordinary shareholders and if the directors thought it appropriate.

So far NV and PLC have always been able to pay their own dividends, so we have never had to follow this procedure. If we did, the payment from one company to the other would be subject to any United Kingdom and Netherlands tax and exchange control laws applicable at that time. The Equalisation Agreement also makes the position of the shareholders of both companies, as far as possible, the same as if they held shares in a single company. To make this possible we compare the ordinary share capital of the two companies in units: a unit made up of5.445 nominal of NVs ordinary capital carries the same weight as a unit made up of £1 nominal of PLCs ordinary capital. For every unit (5.445) you have of NV you have the same rights and benefits as the owner of a unit (£1) of PLC. NVs ordinary shares currently each have a nominal value of0.51, and PLCs share capital is divided into ordinary shares of 1.4p each. This means that a5.445 unit of NV is made up of 10.7 NV ordinary shares of0.51 each and a £1 unit of PLC is made up of 71.4 PLC ordinary shares of 1.4p each. Consequently, one NV ordinary share equates to 6.67 ordinary shares of PLC.

When we pay ordinary dividends we use this formula. On the same day NV and PLC allocate funds for the dividend from their parts of our current profits and free reserves. We pay the same amount on each NV share as on 6.67 PLC shares calculated at the relevant exchange rate. For interim dividends this exchange rate is the average rate for the quarter before we declare the dividend. For final dividends it is the average rate for the year. In arriving at the equalised amount we include any tax payable by the company in respect of the dividend, but calculate it before any tax deductible by the company from the dividend.

In principle, issues of bonus shares and rights offerings can only be made in ordinary shares. Again we would ensure that shareholders of NV and PLC received shares in equal proportions, using the ratio of5.445 NV nominal share capital to £1 PLC nominal share capital. The subscription price for one new NV share would have to be the same, at the prevailing exchange rate, as the price for 6.67 new PLC shares.

Under the Equalisation Agreement (as amended in 1981) the two companies are permitted to pay different dividends in the following exceptional circumstances:

if the average annual sterling/euro exchange rate changed so substantially from one year to the next that to pay equal dividends at the current exchange rates, either NV or PLC would have to pay a dividend that was unreasonable (ie, substantially larger or smaller in its own currency than the dividend it paid in the previous year).

 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Control of Unilever 139
   
 
Shareholder information
 
the governments of the Netherlands or the United Kingdom could in some circumstances place restrictions on the proportion of a company’s profits which can be paid out as dividends; this could mean that in order to pay equal dividends one company would have to pay out an amount which would breach the limitations in place at the time, or that the other company would have to pay a smaller dividend.

In either of these rare cases, NV and PLC could pay different amounts of dividend if the Boards thought it appropriate. The company paying less than the equalised dividend would put the difference between the dividends into a reserve: an equalisation reserve in the case of exchange rate fluctuations, or a dividend reserve in the case of a government restriction. The reserves would be paid out to its shareholders when it became possible or reasonable to do so, which would ensure that the shareholders of both companies would ultimately be treated the same.

If both companies go into liquidation, NV and PLC will each use any funds available for shareholders to pay the prior claims of their own preference shareholders. Then they will use any surplus to pay each other’s preference shareholders, if necessary. After these claims have been met, they will pay out any equalisation or dividend reserve to their own shareholders before pooling the remaining surplus. This will be distributed to the ordinary shareholders of both companies, once again on the basis that the owner of €5.445 nominal NV ordinary share capital will get the same as the owner of £1 nominal PLC ordinary share capital. If one company goes into liquidation, we will apply the same principles as if both had gone into liquidation simultaneously.

In addition to the Equalisation Agreement, NV and PLC have agreed to follow common policies, to exchange all relevant business information, and to ensure that all group companies act accordingly. They aim to co-operate in all areas, including in the purchase of raw materials and the exchange and use of technical, financial and commercial information, secret or patented processes and trade marks.

More information about our constitutional documents
Under the Articles of Association of NV and the Memorandum and Articles of Association of PLC both companies are required to carry out the Equalisation Agreement with the other. Both documents state that the agreement cannot be changed or terminated without the approval of both sets of shareholders.

For NV the necessary approval is as follows:

at least one half of the total issued ordinary capital must be represented at an ordinary shareholders meeting, where the majority must vote in favour; and
(if they would be disadvantaged or the agreement is to be terminated), at least two thirds of the total issued preference share capital must be represented at a preference shareholders meeting, where at least three quarters must vote in favour.
For PLC, the necessary approval must be given by:
the holders of a majority of all issued shares voting at a general meeting; and
the holders of the ordinary shares, either by three quarters in writing, or by three quarters voting at a general meeting where the majority of the ordinary shares in issue are represented.

The Articles of NV establish that any payment under the Equalisation Agreement will be credited or debited to the profit and loss account for the financial year in question.

The PLC Articles state that the Board must carry out the Equalisation Agreement and that the provisions of the Articles are subject to it.

We are advised by Counsel that these provisions oblige the Boards to carry out the Equalisation Agreement, unless it is amended or terminated with the approval of the shareholders of both companies. If the Boards fail to enforce the agreement shareholders can compel them to do so under Netherlands and United Kingdom law.

General Meetings and voting rights
General Meetings of shareholders of NV and PLC are held at times and places decided by the Boards. NV meetings are held in Rotterdam and PLC meetings are held in London.

To be entitled to attend and vote at NV General Meetings you must be a shareholder on the Record Date, which may be set by the directors and must be not more than 7 days before the meeting. In addition you must, within the time specified in the Notice calling the meeting, either

(if you have registered shares) advise NV in writing that you intend to attend; or
(if you have bearer shares) deposit your share certificates at the place specified in the Notice.

You can vote in person or by proxy, and you can cast one vote for each 0.05 nominal amount you hold of NV preference shares, ordinary shares or New York registry shares. NV Elma and United Holdings Limited, the holders of the special shares, and other group companies of NV which hold preference or ordinary shares, are not permitted to vote, by law.

For information on the rights of Nedamtrust certificate holders see page 141.

To be able to vote by proxy at PLC General Meetings you must lodge your Form of Appointment of Proxy with PLCs Registrars 48 hours before the meeting, either in paper or electronic format. You can cast one vote for each PLC ordinary 1.4p share you hold. United Holdings Limited, which owns half of the deferred stock, is not permitted to vote at General Meetings.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

140 Control of Unilever
   

If you are a holder of NV New York shares or PLC American Depository Receipts of shares, you will receive a proxy form enabling you to authorise and instruct ABN AMRO N.V. or JPMorgan Chase Bank respectively to vote on your behalf at the shareholders meeting of NV or PLC.

Resolutions are usually adopted at NV and PLC shareholder meetings by an absolute majority of votes cast, unless there are other requirements under the law or the NV or PLC Articles. There are special requirements for resolutions relating to the alteration of NV or PLCs Articles of Association or the Equalisation Agreement, or to the liquidation of NV or PLC.

According to NVs Articles, shareholders who together represent at least 10% of the issued capital of NV can propose resolutions for inclusion in the agenda of any General Meeting. They can also requisition Extraordinary General Meetings to deal with specific resolutions. However, following the recommendations of the Committee of Corporate Governance, the board of directors has confirmed that shareholders may propose resolutions if:

they individually or together hold 1% of the issued capital; or
they hold shares or depository receipts worth at least € 226 890.

They must submit the request at least 60 days before the date of the General Meeting, and it will be honoured unless, in the opinion of the Board of Directors, it is against the interests of the company.

Under United Kingdom company law,

shareholders who together hold shares representing at least 5% of the total voting rights of PLC; or
at least 100 shareholders who hold on average £100 each in nominal value of PLC capital

can require PLC to propose a resolution at a General Meeting.

There are no limitations on the right to hold NV and PLC shares.

Directors
The directors of NV are able to vote on transactions in which they are materially interested so long as they are acting in good faith. In general PLC directors cannot vote in respect of contracts in which they know they are materially interested, unless, for example, their interest is shared with other shareholders and employees.

The borrowing powers of NV directors are not limited by the Articles of Association of NV. PLC directors have the power to borrow up to three times the Adjusted Capital and Reserves of PLC without the sanction of an ordinary resolution.

The Articles of Association of NV and PLC do not require directors of NV, or full-time employed directors of PLC, to hold shares in NV or PLC. Directors of PLC who are not employed full-time by NV or PLC must hold either £1 000 in nominal value of PLC ordinary shares, or5 445 in nominal value of NV ordinary shares. The remuneration arrangements applicable to directors as employees contain requirements for the holding and retention of shares (see Remuneration report on page 55).

Mutual guarantee of borrowings
There is a contractual arrangement between NV and PLC under which each will, if asked by the other, guarantee the borrowings of the other. They can also agree jointly to guarantee the borrowings of their subsidiaries. We use this arrangement, as a matter of financial policy, for certain significant public borrowings. The arrangements enable lenders to rely on our combined financial strength.

Combined earnings per share
Because of the Equalisation Agreement and the other arrangements between NV and PLC we calculate combined earnings per share for NV and PLC (see note 7 on pages 79 and 80).

We base the calculation on the average amount of NV and PLCs ordinary capital in issue during the year. For the main calculation we exclude shares which have been purchased to satisfy employee share options. We also calculate a diluted earnings per share figure, where we include these shares, as well as certain PLC shares which may be issued in 2038 under the arrangements for the variation of the Leverhulme Trust (see below).

The process by which we calculate earnings per share is as follows. First we convert the average capital of NV and PLC into units using the formula contained in the Equalisation Agreement: one unit equals 10.7 NV shares or 71.4 PLC shares. We add these together to find the total number of units of combined share capital. Then the amount of net profit in euros which is attributable to ordinary capital is divided by this total number of units to find the amount per combined unit. Finally we convert the combined unit back into NV and PLC ordinary shares, to show the amount per one share of each. The amount per unit is divided by 10.7 to find the amount per0.51 share, and by 71.4 to find the amount per 1.4p share.

Despite the Equalisation Agreement, NV and PLC are independent corporations, and are subject to different laws and regulations governing dividend payments in the Netherlands and the United Kingdom. We assume in our combined earnings per share calculation that both companies will be able to pay their dividends out of their part of our profits. This has always been the case in the past, but if we did have to make a payment from one to the other it could result in additional taxes, and reduce our combined earnings per share.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Control of Unilever 141
   
 
Shareholder information
 

Leverhulme Trust
The first Viscount Leverhulme was the founder of the company which became PLC. When he died in 1925, he left in his will a large number of PLC shares in various trusts. The High Court of Justice in England varied these trusts in 1983, and established two independent charitable trusts:

the Leverhulme Trust, which awards grants for research and education, and
the Leverhulme Trade Charities Trust, for the benefit of members of trades which the first Viscount considered to have particular associations with the business.

The major assets of both these trusts are PLC ordinary shares.

When the will trusts were varied in 1983 the interests of the beneficiaries of his will were also preserved. Four classes of special shares were created in Margarine Union (1930) Limited, a subsidiary of PLC. One of these classes can be converted at the end of the year 2038, into a maximum of 157 500 000 PLC ordinary shares of 1.4p each. These convertible shares replicate the rights which the descendants of the Viscount would have had under his will. This class of the special shares only has a right to dividends in specified circumstances, and no dividends have yet been paid. PLC guarantees the dividend and conversion rights of the special shares.

The first Viscount wanted the trustees of the trusts he established to be directors of PLC. On 28 February 2003 the trustees of both the charitable trusts and the will trust were:

Sir Michael Angusformer Chairman of PLC
Sir Michael Perryformer Chairman of PLC
Mr N W A FitzGeraldChairman of PLC
Dr J I W Andersonformer director
Dr A S Ganguly former director

On 28 February 2003, in their capacity as trustees of the two charitable trusts, they held approximately 5.38% of PLCs issued ordinary capital.

N.V. Nederlandsch Administratie- en Trustkantoor (Nedamtrust)
Nedamtrust is an independent trust company under the Netherlands’ law, which has an agreement with NV to issue depositary receipts against NV shares. We do not control Nedamtrust – it is a wholly owned subsidiary of N.V. Algemeen Nederlands Trustkantoor ANT (ANT). Five Dutch financial institutions hold 45% of ANT’s shares between them – they have between 5% and 10% each, and the rest of its shares are owned by a large number of individual shareholders.

As part of its corporate objects Nedamtrust is able to:
issue depositary receipts;
carry out administration for the shares which underlie depositary receipts it has issued; and
exercise voting rights for these underlying shares.

The depositary receipts issued by Nedamtrust against NV shares are known as Nedamtrust certificates. They are in bearer form, and are traded and quoted on the Euronext Stock Exchange and other European stock exchanges. Nedamtrust has issued certificates for NVs ordinary and 7% cumulative preference shares, and almost all the NV shares traded and quoted in Europe are in the form of these certificates. The exception is that there are no certificates for NVs 4%, 6% and0.05 cumulative preference shares.

If you hold Nedamtrust certificates you can attend or appoint a proxy at NV shareholders meetings. If you wish to vote at a meeting, on your request Nedamtrust will give you a power of attorney to vote. If you hold Nedamtrust certificates with a bank or broker in the Netherlands and have notified the Shareholders Communication Channel (see page 45), you will receive a proxy form enabling you to authorise and instruct Nedamtrust to vote at the NV shareholders meeting on your behalf. Nedamtrust is obliged to follow these instructions.

For shares for which Nedamtrust does not receive instructions, Nedamtrusts Board decides on the best way to vote the NV ordinary and preference shares it holds at shareholders meetings. Trust companies in the Netherlands will not usually vote to influence the operations of companies, and in the past Nedamtrust has always followed this policy. However, if a change to shareholders rights is proposed Nedamtrust will let shareholders know if it intends to vote, at least 14 days in advance if possible. It will do this by advertising in the press, but it will not necessarily say which way it is planning to vote.

As a holder of Nedamtrust certificates you can exchange your Nedamtrust certificate at any time for the underlying ordinary or preference share (or vice versa).

Hitherto the majority of votes cast by ordinary and preference shareholders at NV meetings have been cast by Nedamtrust.

Nedamtrusts NV shareholding fluctuates dailyits holdings on 28 February 2003 were:
   
Ordinary shares of €0.51: 471 163 741 (82.43%)
7% Cumulative Preference Shares of 453.78: 9 820 (33.86%)
6% Cumulative Preference Shares of 453.78: 6 (0.00%)
4% Cumulative Preference Shares of45.38: 23 (0.00%)

Material modifications to the rights of security holders
On 10 May 1999 the share capitals of NV and PLC were each consolidated (see notes to NV and PLC Dividends tables on page 147). Otherwise there have been no material modifications to the rights of security holders.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

142 Analysis of shareholding
   
   
   

Significant shareholders of NV
As far as we are aware the only holders of more than 5% of any class of NV shares (apart from Nedamtrust, see page 141) are Nationale Nederlanden N.V. and Aegon Levensverzekering N.V. The voting rights of such shareholders are the same as for other holders of the class of share indicated. Details of such holdings on 28 February 2003 are as follows:

Nationale Nederlanden N.V.
   
13 709 019 (2.40%) ordinary shares (6 967 387)
20 670 (71.26%) 7% Cumulative Preference Shares (€9 377 595)
120 092 (74.56%) 6% Cumulative Preference Shares (€54 493 740)
504 440 (67.26%) 4% Cumulative Preference Shares (€22 890 489)
21 013 355 (9.94%) 5 euro cents Cumulative Preference Shares (€953 545)
 
Aegon Levensverzekering N.V.
   
458 560 (0.08%) ordinary shares (€233 056)
4 998 (17.23%) 7% Cumulative Preference Shares (€2 266 768)
29 540 (18.34%) 6% Cumulative Preference Shares (€13 404 668)
157 106 (20.95%) 4% Cumulative Preference Shares (€7 129 159)

Some of the above holdings are in the form of depositary receipts against NV shares issued by Nedamtrust (see page 141). There have been no material changes to the holdings of significant shareholders of NV during the three years up to and including 2002.

Significant shareholders of PLC
The following table gives details of shareholders who held more than 3% of PLCs shares or deferred stock on 28 February 2003. The voting rights of such shareholders are the same as for other holders of the class of share indicated. We take this information from the register we hold under section 211 of the UK Companies Act 1985.

    Number of   Approximate  
Title of class Name of holder shares held   % held  






Deferred Stock Naamlooze Vennootschap Elma £50 000   50  
  United Holdings Limited £50 000   50  
Ordinary shares Trustees of the Leverhulme Trust and the        
  Leverhulme Trade Charities Trust 156 815 034   5  
  The Capital Group Companies, Inc. 145 115 954   4  
  Fidelity Management and Research Company 87 795 464   3  






The holding by The Capital Group Companies, Inc. is on behalf of affiliated investment management companies and that of Fidelity Management and Research Company is on behalf of FMR Corp. and its direct and indirect subsidiaries and Fidelity International Limited (FIL) and its direct and indirect subsidiaries. These holdings were first notified to PLC in November 2000 and September 2002 respectively. In September 2002 Brandes Investment Partners, which had held 7% in 2000, 6% in 2001 and a reducing percentage during 2002, ceased to be a significant shareholder of PLC. In May 2000 the Prudential Corporation plc ceased to be a significant shareholder of PLC. Otherwise, there have been no changes to the holdings of significant shareholders of PLC during the three years up to and including 2002.

Analysis of PLC registered holdings
At 31 December 2002 PLC had 95 424 ordinary shareholdings.

The following table analyses the registered holdings of PLCs 1.4p ordinary shares at 31 December 2002:

        Number       Total      
Number of shares   of holdings   %   shares held   %  










1 1 000   34 689   36.35   19 324 029   0.67  
1 001 2 500   27 247   28.55   45 212 563   1.55  
2 501 5 000   16 019   16.79   57 395 093   1.97  
5 001 10 000   9 594   10.05   67 603 418   2.32  
10 001 25 000   4 970   5.21   74 898 667   2.57  
25 001 50 000   1 130   1.18   39 066 620   1.34  
50 001 100 000   597   0.63   43 007 387   1.48  
100 001 1 000 000   863   0.91   275 360 264   9.46  
            Over   1 000 000   315   0.33   2 289 590 539   78.64  












        95 424   100.00   2 911 458 580   100.00  












Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Information about exchange controls 143
   affecting security holders  
   
Shareholder information

 

Unilever N.V.
Under the Dutch External Financial Relations Act of 28 May 1980 the Government, the Minister of Finance and the Central Bank of Netherlands are all authorised to issue regulations relating to financial transactions involving Dutch residents, if a non-Dutch resident is also involved, or if the transactions are conducted in a foreign currency. If regulations are issued in the future, we could be in need of a licence for this type of transaction. To date no regulations of this type have been issued.

 

Unilever PLC
None.






Nature of the trading market         

 

The principal trading markets upon which Unilever shares are listed are the Euronext Stock Exchange for NV ordinary shares and the London Stock Exchange for PLC ordinary shares. NV ordinary shares trade in the form of Nedamtrust Certificates and almost all the shares are in bearer form. PLC ordinary shares are all in registered form.

In the United States, NV ordinary shares in registered form and PLC American Depositary Receipts, representing four PLC ordinary shares, are traded on the New York Stock Exchange. JPMorgan Chase Bank of New York acts for NV and PLC as issuer, transfer agent and, in respect of the American Depositary Receipts, depositary.

The NV ordinary shares are also listed on the stock exchanges in London, France, Germany and Switzerland. These shares were also listed in Belgium until 31 December 2002 and in Luxembourg until 24 January 2003.

At 28 February 2003 there were 7 963 registered holders of NV ordinary shares and 901 registered holders of PLC American Depositary Receipts in the United States. We estimate that approximately 21% of NVs ordinary shareholdings were in the United States (approximately 33% in 2001), based on the distribution of the 2002 interim dividend payments, whilst most holders of PLC ordinary shares are registered in the United Kingdom approximately 99% in both 2002 and 2001.

The high and low trading prices for the separate stock exchange listings are shown in the tables on the following page.

 

NV and PLC are separate companies with separate stock exchange listings and different shareholders. You cannot convert or exchange the shares of one for shares of the other and the relative share prices on the various markets can, and do, fluctuate. This happens for various reasons, including changes in exchange rates. However, over time the prices of NV and PLC shares do stay in close relation to each other, in particular because of our equalisation arrangements.

If you are a shareholder of NV, you have an interest in a Netherlands legal entity, your dividends will be paid in euros (converted into US dollars if you have shares registered in the United States) and you will be subject to Netherlands tax. If you are a shareholder of PLC, your interest is in a United Kingdom legal entity, your dividends will be paid in sterling (converted into US dollars if you have American Depositary Receipts) and you will be subject to United Kingdom tax. Nevertheless, the Equalisation Agreement means that as a shareholder of either company you effectively have an interest in the whole of Unilever. You have largely equal rights over our combined net profit and capital reserves as shown in the consolidated accounts. (See Taxation for US residents on pages 145 and 146 and Equalisation Agreement on pages 138 and 139.)






Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

144 Nature of the trading market
   
   
   

Share prices at 31 December 2002:
The share price of the ordinary shares at the end of the year was for NV58.55 and $61.71 and for PLC 591p and $38.25.

Monthly high and low prices for the last six months of 2002:

      July   August   September   October   November   December  















NV per €0.51 ordinary share in Amsterdam (in €)                          
  High   67   62   62   65   64   59  
  Low   50   57   58   60   59   56  















NV per €0.51 ordinary share in New York (in $)                          
  High   66   61   60   64   65   62  
  Low   50   56   56   59   58   58  















PLC per 1.4p ordinary share in London (in pence)                          
  High   610   616   599   632   633   593  
  Low   473   555   568   578   573   562  















PLC per American Share in New York (in $)                           
  High   37   38   37   39   39   38  
  Low   30   34   35   36   36   35  















                             
Quarterly high and low prices for 2002 and 2001:                          
          2002   1st   2nd   3rd   4th  















NV per €0.51 ordinary share in Amsterdam (in €)       High   68   72   67   65  
          Low    62   63   50   56  















NV per €0.51 ordinary share in New York (in $)       High   60   67   66   65  
          Low    54   57   50   58  















PLC per 1.4p ordinary share in London (in pence)       High   592   659   616   633  
          Low    545   554   473   562  















PLC per American Share in New York (in $)         High   35   39   38   39  
          Low    32   32   30   35  















          2001   1st   2nd   3rd   4th  















NV per €0.51 ordinary share in Amsterdam (in €)       High   68   71   71   66  
          Low    56   59   55   56  















NV per €0.51 ordinary share in New York (in $)       High   65   60   63   58  
          Low    50   52   52   50  















PLC per 1.4p ordinary share in London (in pence)       High   574   605   610   573  
          Low    478   497   480   485  















PLC per American Share in New York (in $)         High   35   35   35   34  
          Low    28   29   28   28  















                             
Annual high and low prices for 2000, 1999 and 1998:                        
                  2000   1999   1998  















NV per €0.51 ordinary share in Amsterdam (in € (a))       High       71   74   77  
          Low        42   49   49  















NV per €0.51 ordinary share in New York (in $)       High       64   88   89  
          Low        40   50   59  















PLC per 1.4p (1998: 1.25p) ordinary share in         High       584   695   702  
London (in pence)         Low        335   401   457  















PLC per American Share in New York (in $)         High       35   47   46  
          Low        22   27   32  















                             
(a)  Amounts previously reported in guilders have been restated and are now reported in euros using the fixed conversion rate of €1.00 = Fl. 2.20371 that became effective on 1 January 1999.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Taxation for US residents
145
   
   
Shareholder information


The following notes are provided for guidance. US residents should consult their local tax advisers, particularly in connection with potential liability to pay US taxes on disposal, lifetime gift or bequest of their shares:

Netherlands

Taxation on dividends
Dividends of companies in the Netherlands are subject to dividend withholding tax of 25%. Where a shareholder is entitled to the benefits of the current Income Tax Convention (the Convention) concluded on 18 December 1992 between the United States and the Netherlands, when dividends are paid by NV to:

   a United States resident;
   a corporation organised under the laws of the United States (or any territory of it) having no permanent establishment in the Netherlands of which such shares form a part of the business property;
   or any other legal person subject to United States Federal income tax with respect to its worldwide income, having no permanent establishment in the Netherlands of which such shares form a part of the business property;

these dividends qualify for a reduction of Netherlands withholding tax on dividends from 25% to 15% (to 5% if the beneficial owner is a company which directly holds at least 10% of the voting power of NV shares and to 0% if the beneficial owner is a qualified Exempt Organisation as defined in Article 36 of the Convention).

The entire dividend (including the withheld amount) will be dividend income to the United States shareholder not eligible for the dividends received deduction allowed to corporations. However, the Netherlands withholding tax will be treated as a foreign income tax that is eligible for credit against the shareholders United States income taxes.

Where a United States resident or corporation has a permanent establishment in the Netherlands, which has shares in NV forming part of its business property, dividends it receives on those shares are included in that establishments profit. They are subject to the Netherlands income tax or corporation tax, as appropriate, and the Netherlands tax on dividends will generally be applied at the full rate of 25%. This tax will be treated as foreign income tax eligible for credit against the shareholders United States income taxes.

Under a provision of the Netherlands Dividend Tax Act NV is entitled to a credit (up to a maximum of 3% of the gross dividend from which dividend tax is withheld) against the amount of dividend tax withheld before remittance to the Netherlands tax authorities. For dividends paid on or after 1 January 1995, the United States tax authority may take the position that the Netherlands withholding tax eligible for credit should be limited accordingly.


Under the Convention, qualifying United States organisations that are generally exempt from United States taxes and that are constituted and operated exclusively to administer or provide pension, retirement or other employee benefits may be exempt at source from withholding tax on dividends received from a Netherlands corporation. An agreement published by the US Internal Revenue Service on 20 April 2000 in release IR-INT-2000-9 between the United States and the Netherlands tax authorities describes the eligibility of these US organisations for benefits under the Convention.

A United States trust, company or organisation that is operated exclusively for religious, charitable, scientific, educational or public purposes, is now subject to an initial 25% withholding tax rate. Such an exempt organisation is entitled to reclaim from the Netherlands Tax Authorities a refund of the Netherlands dividend tax, if and to the extent that it is exempt from United States Federal Income Tax and it would be exempt from tax in the Netherlands if it were organised and carried on all its activities there.

If you are a Unilever shareholder resident in any country other than the United States or the Netherlands, any exemption from, or reduction or refund of, the Netherlands dividend withholding tax may be governed by the Tax Regulation for the Kingdom of the Netherlands or by the tax convention, if any, between the Netherlands and your country of residence.

Taxation on capital gains
Under the Convention, if you are a United States resident or corporation and you have capital gains on the sale of shares of a Netherlands company, these are generally not subject to taxation by the Netherlands. An exception to this rule generally applies if you have a permanent establishment in the Netherlands and the capital gain is derived from the sale of shares which form part of that permanent establishments business property.

Succession duty and gift taxes
Under the Estate and Inheritance Tax Convention between the United States and the Netherlands of 15 July 1969, United States individual residents who are not Dutch citizens who have shares will generally not be subject to succession duty in the Netherlands on the individuals death, unless the shares are part of the business property of a permanent establishment situated in the Netherlands.

A gift of shares of a Netherlands company by a person who is not a resident or a deemed resident of the Netherlands is generally not subject to Netherlands gift tax. A non-resident Netherlands citizen, however, is still treated as a resident of the Netherlands for gift tax purposes for ten years and any other non-resident person for one year after leaving the Netherlands.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

146 Taxation for US residents
   
   
   

United Kingdom

Taxation on dividends
Under United Kingdom law income tax is not withheld from dividends paid by United Kingdom companies. Shareholders, whether resident in the United Kingdom or not, receive the full amount of the dividend actually declared.

If you are a shareholder resident in the United Kingdom you are entitled to a tax credit against your liability for United Kingdom income tax, equal to 10% of the aggregate amount of the dividend plus tax credit (or one-ninth of the dividend). For example, a dividend payment of £9.00 will carry a tax credit of £1.00.

If you are a shareholder resident in the US, the dividend actually declared is taxable in the US as ordinary income and is not eligible for the dividends received deduction allowable to corporations. The dividend is foreign source income for US foreign tax credit purposes.

In addition, under the current income tax Convention between the US and the UK (the Convention), a US shareholder eligible for the benefits of the Convention may elect to be treated for US tax purposes only as having received an additional taxable dividend. The additional deemed dividend is equal to one-ninth of the actual cash dividend received (an additional dividend of £1 in the above example). The shareholder will be eligible to claim a US foreign tax credit in the amount of the additional deemed dividend. The tax credit may, subject to certain limitations and restrictions, reduce the shareholders US Federal income tax liability. The procedure for making this election is described in IRS Revenue Procedure 2000-13.

On 24 July 2001, the US and the UK signed a new income tax Convention (the New Convention). Under the New Convention, US shareholders would not be entitled to make the election described in the preceding paragraph. These provisions of the New Convention will apply to US shareholders beginning on the first day of the second month following the date on which the New Convention is ratified by the US and the UK.

However, US shareholders may elect to remain subject to all the provisions of the current Convention for a period of 12 months after the date on which the New Convention would otherwise be applicable. It is uncertain when the New Convention will be ratified.

Taxation on capital gains
Under United Kingdom law, when you sell shares you may be liable to pay capital gains tax. However, if you are either:

   an individual who is neither resident nor ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom; or
   a company which is not resident in the United Kingdom;

you will not be liable to United Kingdom tax on any capital gains made on disposal of your shares.

The exception is if the shares are held in connection with a trade or business which is conducted in the United Kingdom through a branch or an agency.

Inheritance tax
Under the current estate and gift tax convention between the United States and the United Kingdom, ordinary shares held by an individual shareholder who is:

   domiciled for the purposes of the convention in the United States; and
   is not for the purposes of the convention a national of the United Kingdom;
 
will not be subject to United Kingdom inheritance tax on:
   
   the individuals death; or
   on a gift of the shares during the individuals lifetime.

The exception is if the shares are part of the business property of a permanent establishment of the individual in the United Kingdom or, in the case of a shareholder who performs independent personal services, pertain to a fixed base situated in the United Kingdom.


 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Dividends
147
   
   
Shareholder information

Our interim ordinary dividends are normally announced in November and paid in December. Final ordinary dividends are normally proposed in February and, if approved by shareholders at the Annual General Meetings, paid in May or June.

The following tables show the dividends paid by NV and PLC for the last five years. NV dividends are per 0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) ordinary share and PLC dividends are per 1.4p (1998: 1.25p) ordinary share and per depositary receipt of 5.6p (1998: 5p). Dividends for NV have been translated into US dollars at the exchange rates prevailing on the dates of declaration. Dividends for PLC up to and including the interim dividend for 2001 have been translated into US dollars at the exchange rates prevailing on the date of payment of the sterling dividends. Following a change in practice, starting with the final dividend for 2001, PLC dividends have been translated into US dollars at the rate prevailing on the date of declaration of the dividend.

The interim dividend is normally 35% of the previous years total normal dividend per share, based on the stronger of our two parent currencies over the first nine months of the year. Equalisation of the interim dividend in the other currency takes place at the average exchange rate of the third quarter. Equalisation of the final dividend takes place at the average exchange rate for the full year.

The dividend timetable for 2003 is shown on page 150.

NV Dividends                  
  2002   2001   2000   1999   1998










Interim dividend per €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) €0.55   €0.50   €0.48   Fl. 0.88   Fl. 0.81
Exchange rate Fl. to $             2.1173   1.8717
Exchange rate € to $ 0.9820   0.9097   0.8646        
Interim dividend per €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) (US registry) $0.540100   $0.454850   $0.415008   $0.415624   $0.432762
                   
Normal final dividend per €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) €1.15   €1.06   €0.95   Fl. 1.91   Fl. 1.70
Special final dividend per Fl. 1                 Fl. 14.50
                   
Final exchange rate Fl. to $             2.4725   2.0861
Final exchange rate € to $ 1.0735   0.9088   0.8827        
                   
Normal final dividend per €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) (US registry) $1.234525   $0.963328   $0.838565   $0.772497   $0.814918
Special final dividend per Fl. 1 (US registry)                 $6.950769










Note 1: For the purposes of illustration, the US dollar dividends shown above are those paid on the €0.51 (1998: Fl. 1) ordinary shares of NV registered in New York. The above exchange rates were those ruling on the dates of declaration of the dividend.

Note 2: The final euro dividend for 2002 is payable on 9 June 2003. The dollar dividend will be calculated with reference to the exchange rates prevailing on 7 May 2003.

Note 3: On 10 May 1999 the share capital was consolidated on the basis of 100 new ordinary shares with a nominal value of Fl. 1.12 (now €0.51) for every 112 existing ordinary shares with a nominal value of Fl. 1.

PLC Dividends                    
  2002   2001   2000   1999   1998  











Interim dividend per 1.4p (1998: 1.25p) 5.21p   4.65p   4.40p   3.93p   2.95p  
Exchange rate $ to £1 1.5580   1.4527   1.4622   1.6002   1.6745  
Interim dividend per 5.6p (1998: 5p) $0.3247   $0.2702   $0.2573   $0.2515   $0.1976  
                     
Normal final dividend per 1.4p (1998: 1.25p) 10.83p   9.89p   8.67p   8.57p   7.75p  
Special final dividend per 1.25p                 66.13p  
                     
Normal final exchange rate $ to £1 1.6173   1.4591   1.4355   1.4732   1.5921  
Special final exchange rate $ to £1                 1.5984  
                     
Normal final dividend per 5.6p (1998: 5p) $0.7006   $0.5772   $0.4978   $0.5050   $0.4935  
Special final dividend per 5p                 $4.2280  











 
Note 1: If you are a United States resident and received dividends before 6 April 1999, under the Anglo-United States taxation treaty, you received an amount equal to the total of the declared dividend, plus the United Kingdom tax credit less withholding tax. If you are a United States resident and received dividends after 5 April 1999, you simply received the declared dividend; see Taxation for US residents on pages 145 and 146.
 

Note 2: The final sterling dividend for 2002 is payable on 9 June 2003. The dollar dividend will be calculated with reference to the exchange rates prevailing on 7 May 2003.

 

Note 3: It is not possible to make a direct comparison between PLC dividends paid before and after 6 April 1999 because of the abolition of United Kingdom ACT (Advance Corporation Tax) from that date (see note 1 above).

 

Note 4: On 10 May 1999 the share capital was consolidated on the basis of 100 new ordinary shares with a nominal value of 1.4p for every 112 existing ordinary shares with a nominal value of 1.25p.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

148 Cross reference to Form 20-F
   

 

PART I  
       
1   Identity of directors, senior management  
    and advisers n/a
       
2   Offer statistics and expected timetable n/a
       
3   Key information  
3A   Selected financial data 97, 113-117, 147
3B   Capitalization and indebtedness n/a
3C   Reasons for the offer and use of proceeds n/a
3D   Risk factors 39-40
       
4   Information on the company  
4A   History and development of the company 2, 16-17, 37, 42, 102, 148, 150
4B   Business overview 9-14, 18-34, 39
4C   Organisational structure 42, 128-131
4D   Property, plants and equipment 14
       
5   Operating and financial review and prospects  
5A   Operating results 15-39
5B   Liquidity and capital resources 37-38, 63
5C   Research and development, patents and licences, etc. 10, 13-14
5D   Trend information 5-6, 15-34
       
6   Directors, senior management and employees  
6A   Directors and senior management 42, 46-48
6B   Compensation 49-60, 87-93
6C   Board practices 42-44, 46-48, 54
6D   Employees 13
6E   Share ownership 55-60, 103-111
       
7   Major shareholders and related party transactions  
7A   Major shareholders 141-142
7B   Related party transactions 13
7C   Interests of experts and counsel n/a
       
8   Financial information  
8A   Consolidated statements and other financial information 14, 69-112, 134, 147
8B   Significant changes 41
       
9   The offer and listing  
9A   Offer and listing details 144
9B   Plan of distribution n/a
9C   Markets 2, 143
9D   Selling shareholders n/a
9E   Dilution n/a
9F   Expenses of the issue n/a
       
10   Additional information  
10A   Share capital n/a
10B   Memorandum and articles of association
Inside front cover, 42, 97, 134, 138-140
10C   Material contracts 138-139
10D   Exchange controls 143
10E   Taxation 145-146
10F   Dividends and paying agents n/a
10G   Statement by experts n/a
10H   Documents on display 122
10I   Subsidiary information n/a
       
11   Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk 38-39
       
12   Description of securities other than equity securities n/a
       
PART II  
       
13   Defaults, dividend arrearages and delinquencies
n/a
       
14   Material modifications to the rights of security holders and use of proceeds
141
       
15   Disclosure control and procedures 63
       
16   Reserved  
       
PART III  
       
17   Financial statements
n/a
       
18   Financial statements 65-137
       
19   Exhibits *
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       

* Filed with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.

Unilever’s agent in the United States is Mr R Soiefer, Vice-President, Secretary and General Counsel, Unilever United States, Inc., 390 Park Avenue, New York, NY 10022-4698.


Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Glossary
149
   
Shareholder information

The following is intended to provide a general guide, particularly for United States readers, as to the meanings of various terms which may be used in this report. Please refer also to page 115 for definitions of specific accounting measures as they are applied by Unilever.

Term used in this report US equivalent or brief description

Accounts Financial statements

Associate A business which is not a subsidiary or a joint venture, but in which the Group has a shareholding and exercises significant influence

Called up share capital Ordinary shares, issued and fully paid

Creditors Accounts payable/Payables

Creditors: amounts due after more than one year Long-term accounts payable

Creditors: amounts due within one year Current accounts payable

Debtors Accounts receivable/Receivables

Finance lease Capital lease

Freehold Ownership with absolute rights in perpetuity

Gearing Leverage

Group, or consolidated accounts Consolidated financial statements

Interest payable Interest expense

Interest receivable Interest income

Joint venture A business which is jointly controlled by the Group and one or more external partners

Nominal value Par value

Operating profit Net operating income

Profit Income (or earnings)

Profit and loss account Income statement

Profit attributable to ordinary shareholders Net income attributable to ordinary shareholders

Profit retained Retained earnings

Provisions Long-term liabilities other than debt and specific accounts payable

Reconciliation of movements in shareholders’ funds Statement of changes in stockholders’ equity

Reserves Stockholders’ equity other than paid-up capital

Share capital Capital stock or common stock

Share option Stock option

Share premium account Additional paid-in capital relating to proceeds of sale of stock in excess of par value or paid-in surplus

Shareholders’ funds Stockholders’ equity

Shares in issue Shares outstanding

Statement of total recognised gains and losses Comprehensive income

Stocks Inventories

Tangible fixed assets Property, plant and equipment

Turnover Sales revenues

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

150 Financial calendar and addresses

 

 

 

Annual General Meetings        

NV
 
10:30 am Wednesday 7 May 2003 Rotterdam
 

PLC
 
11:00 am Wednesday 7 May 2003 London
 

         
Announcements of results        

First Quarter
First Half Year
2 May 2003
30 July 2003
Third Quarter
Final for Year (provisional)
29 October 2003
12 February 2004
 
 

         
Dividends on ordinary capital      

Final for 2002 – announced 13 February 2003 and to be declared 7 May 2003    
  Ex-dividend
date
Record
date
Payment
date

NV   9 May 2003 8 May 2003 9 June 2003
PLC   14 May 2003 16 May 2003 9 June 2003
NV – New York Shares   14 May 2003 16 May 2003 9 June 2003
PLC – ADRs   14 May 2003 16 May 2003 9 June 2003

         
Interim for 2003 – to be announced 29 October 2003    
  Ex-dividend
date
Record
date
Payment
date

NV   30 October 2003 29 October 2003
1 December 2003
PLC   5 November 2003 7 November 2003
1 December 2003
NV – New York Shares   5 November 2003 7 November 2003
1 December 2003
PLC – ADRs   5 November 2003 7 November 2003
1 December 2003

 
Preferential dividends

NV  

4% Cumulative Preference
Paid 1 January
6% Cumulative Preference
Paid 1 October
7% Cumulative Preference
Paid 1 October
€0.05 Cumulative Preference Paid 9 June and 9 December

 
 
 
 
 
Contact details    
Rotterdam
London
New York

Unilever N.V. Unilever PLC Unilever United States, Inc.
Corporate Relations Department Corporate Relations Department Corporate Relations Department
Weena 455, PO Box 760 PO Box 68, Unilever House 390 Park Avenue, New York
3000 DK Rotterdam Blackfriars, London EC4P 4BQ NY 10022-4698
     
Telephone +31 (0)10 217 4000 Telephone +44 (0)20 7822 5252 Telephone + 1 212 906 4240
Telefax +31 (0)10 217 4798 Telefax +44 (0)20 7822 6907 Telefax + 1 212 906 4666
e-mail: e-mail: e-mail:
corporate.relations-rotterdam corporate.relations-london corporate.relations-newyork
@unilever.com @unilever.com @unilever.com

 

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Back to Contents

Website
Share registration
151

 

Shareholder information

 

Shareholders are encouraged to visit our website www.unilever.com, which has a wealth of information about the Unilever Group.

There is a section designed specifically for investors at www.unilever.com/investorcentre. It includes detailed coverage of the Unilever share price, our quarterly and annual results, performance charts, financial news and analyst communications. It also includes transcripts of our investor relations speeches and copies of Unilever results presentations.

You can also view this years and prior years Annual Review and Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F documents at www.unilever.com/investorcentre/financialreports.

PLC shareholders can elect not to receive paper copies of the Annual Review, the Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F, and other shareholder documents by registering at www.shareview.co.uk if they prefer to view these on our website.

Netherlands    
N.V. Algemeen Nederlands Trustkantoor ANT
PO Box 11063
1001 GB Amsterdam
     
Telephone
Telefax
e-mail:
+31 (0)20 522 2555
+31 (0)20 522 2500
registers@ant-trust.nl
 
     
UK    
Lloyds TSB Registrars
The Causeway
Worthing

West Sussex BN99 6DA
     

Telephone
Telefax
Website

+44 (0)870 600 3977
+44 (0)870 600 3980
www.lloydstsb-registrars.co.uk
   
     
USA    
JPMorgan Service Centre
PO Box 43013

Providence RI 02940-3013
     
Telephone
Telefax

Website
+ 1 781 575 4328
+ 1 781 575 4082

www.adr.com
 


Publications

Copies of the following publications can be obtained without charge from Unilevers Corporate Relations Departments.

Unilever Annual Review 2002
Including Summary Financial Statement. Available in English or Dutch, with financial information in euros, sterling and US dollars.

Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and
Form 20-F 2002

Available in English or Dutch, with
figures in euros. It includes the Form 20-F that is filed with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.

Quarterly Results Announcements
Available in English or Dutch, with figures in euros; supplements in English, with sterling or US dollar figures, are available.



Unilever Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F 2002


Unilever N.V.   Unilever PLC
Weena 455, PO Box 760   PO Box 68, Unilever House
3000 DK Rotterdam   Blackfriars, London EC4P 4BQ
T +31 (0) 10 217 4000   T +44 (0)20 7822 5252
F +31 (0) 10 217 4798   F +44 (0)20 7822 5951

 


SIGNATURES

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorised the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on its behalf.

   
Unilever N.V.  

 
(Registrant)  
   
   
/s/ J A A van der Bijl  

 
(Signature)
J A A van der Bijl, Joint Secretary
 

Date: 27 March 2003

 


Back to Contents

Section 302 Certification

CERTIFICATIONS

Each of the undersigned officers of the Company certify that:

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of Unilever N.V.;

2. Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this annual report;

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this annual report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the issuer as of, and for, the periods presented in this annual report;

4. The issuer’s other certifying officers and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a- 14 and 15d-14) for the issuer and have:

(a) designed such disclosure controls and procedures to ensure that material information relating to the issuer, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared;
(b) evaluated the effectiveness of the issuer’s disclosure controls and procedures as of a date within 90 days prior to the filing date of this annual report (the “Evaluation Date”); and
(c) presented in this annual report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures based on our evaluation as of the Evaluation Date;

5. The issuer’s other certifying officers and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation, to the issuer’s auditors and the audit committee of issuer’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent function):

(a) all significant deficiencies in the design or operation of internal controls which could adversely affect the issuer’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial data and have identified for the issuer’s auditors any material weaknesses in internal controls; and
(b) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the issuer’s internal controls; and

6. The issuer’s other certifying officers and I have indicated in this annual report whether or not there were significant changes in internal controls or in other factors that could significantly affect internal controls subsequent to the date of our most recent evaluation, including any corrective actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material weaknesses.

Date: 27 March 2003


Back to Contents

   
/s/ Antony Burgmans  

 
Antony Burgmans
Chairman and Joint Chief Executive
 
   
   
/s/ Niall William Arthur FitzGerald  

 
Niall William Arthur FitzGerald KBE
Vice-Chairman and Joint Chief Executive
 
   
   
/s/ Rudolph Harold Peter Markham  

 
Rudolph Harold Peter Markham
Financial Director/Chief Financial Officer
 
   
   
/s/ Alan Clive Butler  

 
Alan Clive Butler
Corporate Development Director
 
   
   
/s/ Patrick Jean-Pierre Cescau  

 
Patrick Jean-Pierre Cescau
Foods Director
 
   
/s/ Keki Bomi Dadiseth  

 
Keki Bomi Dadiseth
Home and Pesonal Care Director
 
   
   
/s/ André René baron van Heemstra  

 
André René baron van Heemstra
Personnel Director
 
   
   
/s/ Charles Bernhard Strauss  

 
Charles Bernhard Strauss
Director/Chairman North America Committee
 
   
   

 


Back to Contents

Item 19. Exhibits

Exhibit Number   Description of Exhibit  
1.1   Memorandum and Articles of Association of Unilever N.V., as amended1  

2.1

  Indenture dated as of August 1, 2000, among Unilever Capital Corporation, Unilever N.V., Unilever PLC, Unilever United States, Inc. and The Bank of New York, as Trustee, relating to Guaranteed Debt Securities2  
2.2
  Trust Deed dated as of July 22, 1994, among Unilever N.V., Unilever PLC, Unilever Capital Corporation, Unilever United States, Inc. and The Law Debenture Trust Corporation p.l.c., relating to Guaranteed Debt Securities3  
4.1   Equalisation Agreement between Unilever N.V. and Unilever PLC  
4.2   Service Contracts of the Directors of Unilever N.V.4  
4.3   Letters regarding compensation of Directors of Unilever N.V.  
4.4   Unilever North America 2002 Omnibus Equity Compensation Plan5  
4.5   The Unilever N.V. International 1997 Executive Share Option Scheme6  
4.6   The Unilever Long Term Incentive Plan7  
7.1   Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges, Net Interest Cover and Net Interest Cover Based on EBITDA (Before Exceptional Items)8  
8.1   List of Subsidiaries9  
10.1 Consent of PriceWaterhouseCoopers N.V. and PriceWaterhouseCoopers LLP

Certain instruments which define rights of holders of long-term debt of the Company and its subsidiaries are not being filed because the total amount of securities authorized under each such instrument does not exceed 10% of the total consolidated assets of the Company and its subsidiaries. The Company and its subsidiaries hereby agree to furnish a copy of each such instrument to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request.


1

Incorporated by reference to the Form 6-K furnished to the SEC on June 15, 2001.

2

Incorporated by reference to the Form 6-K furnished to the SEC on October 23, 2000.

3

Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 of Form 20-F filed with the SEC on March 28, 2002.

4

Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of Form 20-F filed with the SEC on March 28, 2002.

5

Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of Form S-8 filed with the SEC on February 27, 2003.

6

Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 of Form 20-F filed with the SEC on March 28, 2002.

7

Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7 of Form 20-F filed with the SEC on March 28, 2002.

8

The required information is set forth on page 115 of the Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F.

9

The required information is set forth on pages 128-131 of the Annual Report & Accounts and Form 20-F.